Introduce this macro to print debug statements in the infrun.c file,
same idea as what was done in 9327494e0e ("gdb: add
linux_nat_debug_printf macro").
Although in this case, there are places outside infrun.c that print
debug statements if debug_infrun is set. So the macro has to be
declared in the header file, so that it can be used in these other
files.
Note one special case. In stop_all_threads, I've used an explicit
if (debug_infrun)
infrun_debug_printf_1 ("stop_all_threads", "done");
for the message in the SCOPE_EXIT. Otherwise, the message appears like
this:
[infrun] operator(): done
Until we find a better solution for extracting a meaningful function
name for lambda functions, I think it's fine to handle these special
cases manually, they are quite rare.
Some tests need to be updated, because they rely on some infrun debug
statements.
gdb/ChangeLog:
* infrun.h (infrun_debug_printf_1): New function declaration.
(infrun_debug_printf): New macro.
* infrun.c (infrun_debug_printf_1): Use infrun_debug_printf
throughout.
(infrun_debug_printf): New function.
* breakpoint.c (should_be_inserted): Use infrun_debug_printf.
(handle_jit_event): Likewise.
gdb/testsuite/ChangeLog:
* gdb.base/gdb-sigterm.exp (do_test): Update expected regexp.
* gdb.threads/signal-while-stepping-over-bp-other-thread.exp:
Likewise.
* gdb.threads/stepi-random-signal.exp: Likewise.
Change-Id: I66433c8a9caa64c8525ab57c593022b9d1956d5c
16001 lines
461 KiB
C
16001 lines
461 KiB
C
/* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB.
|
|
|
|
Copyright (C) 1986-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
|
|
|
This file is part of GDB.
|
|
|
|
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
|
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
|
the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
|
|
(at your option) any later version.
|
|
|
|
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
|
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
|
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
|
GNU General Public License for more details.
|
|
|
|
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
|
along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
|
|
|
|
#include "defs.h"
|
|
#include "arch-utils.h"
|
|
#include <ctype.h>
|
|
#include "hashtab.h"
|
|
#include "symtab.h"
|
|
#include "frame.h"
|
|
#include "breakpoint.h"
|
|
#include "tracepoint.h"
|
|
#include "gdbtypes.h"
|
|
#include "expression.h"
|
|
#include "gdbcore.h"
|
|
#include "gdbcmd.h"
|
|
#include "value.h"
|
|
#include "command.h"
|
|
#include "inferior.h"
|
|
#include "infrun.h"
|
|
#include "gdbthread.h"
|
|
#include "target.h"
|
|
#include "language.h"
|
|
#include "gdb-demangle.h"
|
|
#include "filenames.h"
|
|
#include "annotate.h"
|
|
#include "symfile.h"
|
|
#include "objfiles.h"
|
|
#include "source.h"
|
|
#include "linespec.h"
|
|
#include "completer.h"
|
|
#include "ui-out.h"
|
|
#include "cli/cli-script.h"
|
|
#include "block.h"
|
|
#include "solib.h"
|
|
#include "solist.h"
|
|
#include "observable.h"
|
|
#include "memattr.h"
|
|
#include "ada-lang.h"
|
|
#include "top.h"
|
|
#include "valprint.h"
|
|
#include "jit.h"
|
|
#include "parser-defs.h"
|
|
#include "gdb_regex.h"
|
|
#include "probe.h"
|
|
#include "cli/cli-utils.h"
|
|
#include "stack.h"
|
|
#include "ax-gdb.h"
|
|
#include "dummy-frame.h"
|
|
#include "interps.h"
|
|
#include "gdbsupport/format.h"
|
|
#include "thread-fsm.h"
|
|
#include "tid-parse.h"
|
|
#include "cli/cli-style.h"
|
|
|
|
/* readline include files */
|
|
#include "readline/tilde.h"
|
|
|
|
/* readline defines this. */
|
|
#undef savestring
|
|
|
|
#include "mi/mi-common.h"
|
|
#include "extension.h"
|
|
#include <algorithm>
|
|
#include "progspace-and-thread.h"
|
|
#include "gdbsupport/array-view.h"
|
|
#include "gdbsupport/gdb_optional.h"
|
|
|
|
/* Prototypes for local functions. */
|
|
|
|
static void map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *,
|
|
gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)>);
|
|
|
|
static void breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *);
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
create_sals_from_location_default (const struct event_location *location,
|
|
struct linespec_result *canonical,
|
|
enum bptype type_wanted);
|
|
|
|
static void create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *,
|
|
struct linespec_result *,
|
|
gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>,
|
|
gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>,
|
|
enum bptype,
|
|
enum bpdisp, int, int,
|
|
int,
|
|
const struct breakpoint_ops *,
|
|
int, int, int, unsigned);
|
|
|
|
static std::vector<symtab_and_line> decode_location_default
|
|
(struct breakpoint *b, const struct event_location *location,
|
|
struct program_space *search_pspace);
|
|
|
|
static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint
|
|
(const std::vector<value_ref_ptr> &vals);
|
|
|
|
static void mention (struct breakpoint *);
|
|
|
|
static struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *,
|
|
enum bptype,
|
|
const struct breakpoint_ops *);
|
|
static struct bp_location *add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *,
|
|
const struct symtab_and_line *);
|
|
|
|
/* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made
|
|
static. */
|
|
struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
|
|
struct symtab_and_line,
|
|
enum bptype,
|
|
const struct breakpoint_ops *);
|
|
|
|
static struct breakpoint *
|
|
momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
|
|
enum bptype type,
|
|
const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
|
|
int loc_enabled);
|
|
|
|
static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, int);
|
|
|
|
static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
|
|
CORE_ADDR bpaddr,
|
|
enum bptype bptype);
|
|
|
|
static void describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *,
|
|
struct program_space *, CORE_ADDR,
|
|
struct obj_section *, int);
|
|
|
|
static int watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
|
|
struct bp_location *loc2);
|
|
|
|
static int breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
|
|
struct bp_location *loc2,
|
|
bool sw_hw_bps_match = false);
|
|
|
|
static int breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
|
|
const struct address_space *aspace,
|
|
CORE_ADDR addr);
|
|
|
|
static int breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *,
|
|
const address_space *,
|
|
CORE_ADDR, int);
|
|
|
|
static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *);
|
|
static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, enum remove_bp_reason);
|
|
|
|
static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs);
|
|
|
|
static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void);
|
|
|
|
static int hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *);
|
|
|
|
static int hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
|
|
enum bptype type,
|
|
int *other_type_used);
|
|
|
|
static void enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp,
|
|
int count);
|
|
|
|
static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
|
|
static void incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
|
|
static void decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **loc);
|
|
|
|
static struct bp_location *allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt);
|
|
|
|
/* update_global_location_list's modes of operation wrt to whether to
|
|
insert locations now. */
|
|
enum ugll_insert_mode
|
|
{
|
|
/* Don't insert any breakpoint locations into the inferior, only
|
|
remove already-inserted locations that no longer should be
|
|
inserted. Functions that delete a breakpoint or breakpoints
|
|
should specify this mode, so that deleting a breakpoint doesn't
|
|
have the side effect of inserting the locations of other
|
|
breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted
|
|
returns true on them.
|
|
|
|
This behavior is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g.,
|
|
after an exec, while the target still has execution, but
|
|
breakpoint shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT*
|
|
be restored to the new image; or before detaching, where the
|
|
target still has execution and wants to delete breakpoints from
|
|
GDB's lists, and all breakpoints had already been removed from
|
|
the inferior. */
|
|
UGLL_DONT_INSERT,
|
|
|
|
/* May insert breakpoints iff breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now
|
|
claims breakpoints should be inserted now. */
|
|
UGLL_MAY_INSERT,
|
|
|
|
/* Insert locations now, irrespective of
|
|
breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now. E.g., say all threads are
|
|
stopped right now, and the user did "continue". We need to
|
|
insert breakpoints _before_ resuming the target, but
|
|
UGLL_MAY_INSERT wouldn't insert them, because
|
|
breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now returns false at that point,
|
|
as no thread is running yet. */
|
|
UGLL_INSERT
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
static void update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode);
|
|
|
|
static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode);
|
|
|
|
static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void);
|
|
|
|
static void trace_pass_command (const char *, int);
|
|
|
|
static void set_tracepoint_count (int num);
|
|
|
|
static bool is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b);
|
|
|
|
static struct bp_location **get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address);
|
|
|
|
/* Return 1 if B refers to a static tracepoint set by marker ("-m"), zero
|
|
otherwise. */
|
|
|
|
static int strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b);
|
|
|
|
/* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherited by all breakpoint_ops
|
|
that are implemented on top of software or hardware breakpoints
|
|
(user breakpoints, internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
|
|
static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
|
|
/* Internal breakpoints class type. */
|
|
static struct breakpoint_ops internal_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
|
|
/* Momentary breakpoints class type. */
|
|
static struct breakpoint_ops momentary_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
|
|
/* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular user created
|
|
breakpoints. */
|
|
struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
|
|
/* Breakpoints set on probes. */
|
|
static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
|
|
/* Tracepoints set on probes. */
|
|
static struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
|
|
/* Dynamic printf class type. */
|
|
struct breakpoint_ops dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
|
|
/* The style in which to perform a dynamic printf. This is a user
|
|
option because different output options have different tradeoffs;
|
|
if GDB does the printing, there is better error handling if there
|
|
is a problem with any of the arguments, but using an inferior
|
|
function lets you have special-purpose printers and sending of
|
|
output to the same place as compiled-in print functions. */
|
|
|
|
static const char dprintf_style_gdb[] = "gdb";
|
|
static const char dprintf_style_call[] = "call";
|
|
static const char dprintf_style_agent[] = "agent";
|
|
static const char *const dprintf_style_enums[] = {
|
|
dprintf_style_gdb,
|
|
dprintf_style_call,
|
|
dprintf_style_agent,
|
|
NULL
|
|
};
|
|
static const char *dprintf_style = dprintf_style_gdb;
|
|
|
|
/* The function to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
|
|
call into the inferior. The value is simply a string that is
|
|
copied into the command, so it can be anything that GDB can
|
|
evaluate to a callable address, not necessarily a function name. */
|
|
|
|
static char *dprintf_function;
|
|
|
|
/* The channel to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
|
|
call into the inferior; if a nonempty string, it will be passed to
|
|
the call as the first argument, with the format string as the
|
|
second. As with the dprintf function, this can be anything that
|
|
GDB knows how to evaluate, so in addition to common choices like
|
|
"stderr", this could be an app-specific expression like
|
|
"mystreams[curlogger]". */
|
|
|
|
static char *dprintf_channel;
|
|
|
|
/* True if dprintf commands should continue to operate even if GDB
|
|
has disconnected. */
|
|
static bool disconnected_dprintf = true;
|
|
|
|
struct command_line *
|
|
breakpoint_commands (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
return b->commands ? b->commands.get () : NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the
|
|
current breakpoint. */
|
|
|
|
static bool breakpoint_proceeded;
|
|
|
|
const char *
|
|
bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp)
|
|
{
|
|
/* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and
|
|
represent values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at
|
|
a breakpoint. */
|
|
static const char * const bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"};
|
|
|
|
return bpdisps[(int) disp];
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Prototypes for exported functions. */
|
|
/* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even
|
|
if such is available. */
|
|
static int can_use_hw_watchpoints;
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
|
|
struct cmd_list_element *c,
|
|
const char *value)
|
|
{
|
|
fprintf_filtered (file,
|
|
_("Debugger's willingness to use "
|
|
"watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"),
|
|
value);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints.
|
|
If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints
|
|
for unrecognized breakpoint locations.
|
|
If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized. */
|
|
static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support;
|
|
static void
|
|
show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
|
|
struct cmd_list_element *c,
|
|
const char *value)
|
|
{
|
|
fprintf_filtered (file,
|
|
_("Debugger's behavior regarding "
|
|
"pending breakpoints is %s.\n"),
|
|
value);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If true, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints
|
|
set with "break" but falling in read-only memory.
|
|
If false, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically
|
|
use hardware breakpoints. */
|
|
static bool automatic_hardware_breakpoints;
|
|
static void
|
|
show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
|
|
struct cmd_list_element *c,
|
|
const char *value)
|
|
{
|
|
fprintf_filtered (file,
|
|
_("Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"),
|
|
value);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If on, GDB keeps breakpoints inserted even if the inferior is
|
|
stopped, and immediately inserts any new breakpoints as soon as
|
|
they're created. If off (default), GDB keeps breakpoints off of
|
|
the target as long as possible. That is, it delays inserting
|
|
breakpoints until the next resume, and removes them again when the
|
|
target fully stops. This is a bit safer in case GDB crashes while
|
|
processing user input. */
|
|
static bool always_inserted_mode = false;
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
|
|
struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
|
|
{
|
|
fprintf_filtered (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"),
|
|
value);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* See breakpoint.h. */
|
|
|
|
int
|
|
breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now (void)
|
|
{
|
|
if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
|
|
{
|
|
/* If breakpoints are global, they should be inserted even if no
|
|
thread under gdb's control is running, or even if there are
|
|
no threads under GDB's control yet. */
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
if (always_inserted_mode)
|
|
{
|
|
/* The user wants breakpoints inserted even if all threads
|
|
are stopped. */
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
for (inferior *inf : all_inferiors ())
|
|
if (inf->has_execution ()
|
|
&& threads_are_executing (inf->process_target ()))
|
|
return 1;
|
|
|
|
/* Don't remove breakpoints yet if, even though all threads are
|
|
stopped, we still have events to process. */
|
|
for (thread_info *tp : all_non_exited_threads ())
|
|
if (tp->resumed
|
|
&& tp->suspend.waitstatus_pending_p)
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static const char condition_evaluation_both[] = "host or target";
|
|
|
|
/* Modes for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
|
|
static const char condition_evaluation_auto[] = "auto";
|
|
static const char condition_evaluation_host[] = "host";
|
|
static const char condition_evaluation_target[] = "target";
|
|
static const char *const condition_evaluation_enums[] = {
|
|
condition_evaluation_auto,
|
|
condition_evaluation_host,
|
|
condition_evaluation_target,
|
|
NULL
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* Global that holds the current mode for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
|
|
static const char *condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_auto;
|
|
|
|
/* Global that we use to display information to the user (gets its value from
|
|
condition_evaluation_mode_1. */
|
|
static const char *condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_auto;
|
|
|
|
/* Translate a condition evaluation mode MODE into either "host"
|
|
or "target". This is used mostly to translate from "auto" to the
|
|
real setting that is being used. It returns the translated
|
|
evaluation mode. */
|
|
|
|
static const char *
|
|
translate_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *mode)
|
|
{
|
|
if (mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
|
|
{
|
|
if (target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
|
|
return condition_evaluation_target;
|
|
else
|
|
return condition_evaluation_host;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
return mode;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Discovers what condition_evaluation_auto translates to. */
|
|
|
|
static const char *
|
|
breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode (void)
|
|
{
|
|
return translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Return true if GDB should evaluate breakpoint conditions or false
|
|
otherwise. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p (void)
|
|
{
|
|
const char *mode = breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ();
|
|
|
|
return (mode == condition_evaluation_host);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Are we executing breakpoint commands? */
|
|
static int executing_breakpoint_commands;
|
|
|
|
/* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */
|
|
static int overlay_events_enabled;
|
|
|
|
/* See description in breakpoint.h. */
|
|
bool target_exact_watchpoints = false;
|
|
|
|
/* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints.
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statement deletes the
|
|
current breakpoint. */
|
|
|
|
#define ALL_BREAKPOINTS(B) for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next)
|
|
|
|
#define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP) \
|
|
for (B = breakpoint_chain; \
|
|
B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0; \
|
|
B = TMP)
|
|
|
|
/* Similar iterator for the low-level breakpoints. SAFE variant is
|
|
not provided so update_global_location_list must not be called
|
|
while executing the block of ALL_BP_LOCATIONS. */
|
|
|
|
#define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS(B,BP_TMP) \
|
|
for (BP_TMP = bp_locations; \
|
|
BP_TMP < bp_locations + bp_locations_count && (B = *BP_TMP);\
|
|
BP_TMP++)
|
|
|
|
/* Iterates through locations with address ADDRESS for the currently selected
|
|
program space. BP_LOCP_TMP points to each object. BP_LOCP_START points
|
|
to where the loop should start from.
|
|
If BP_LOCP_START is a NULL pointer, the macro automatically seeks the
|
|
appropriate location to start with. */
|
|
|
|
#define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR(BP_LOCP_TMP, BP_LOCP_START, ADDRESS) \
|
|
for (BP_LOCP_START = BP_LOCP_START == NULL ? get_first_locp_gte_addr (ADDRESS) : BP_LOCP_START, \
|
|
BP_LOCP_TMP = BP_LOCP_START; \
|
|
BP_LOCP_START \
|
|
&& (BP_LOCP_TMP < bp_locations + bp_locations_count \
|
|
&& (*BP_LOCP_TMP)->address == ADDRESS); \
|
|
BP_LOCP_TMP++)
|
|
|
|
/* Iterator for tracepoints only. */
|
|
|
|
#define ALL_TRACEPOINTS(B) \
|
|
for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next) \
|
|
if (is_tracepoint (B))
|
|
|
|
/* Chains of all breakpoints defined. */
|
|
|
|
static struct breakpoint *breakpoint_chain;
|
|
|
|
/* Array is sorted by bp_location_is_less_than - primarily by the ADDRESS. */
|
|
|
|
static struct bp_location **bp_locations;
|
|
|
|
/* Number of elements of BP_LOCATIONS. */
|
|
|
|
static unsigned bp_locations_count;
|
|
|
|
/* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and
|
|
ADDRESS for the current elements of BP_LOCATIONS which get a valid
|
|
result from bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly
|
|
limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATIONS to scan for shadow bytes for
|
|
an address you need to read. */
|
|
|
|
static CORE_ADDR bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max;
|
|
|
|
/* Maximum offset plus alignment between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS
|
|
+ bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for the current elements of
|
|
BP_LOCATIONS which get a valid result from bp_location_has_shadow.
|
|
You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATIONS to
|
|
scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
|
|
|
|
static CORE_ADDR bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max;
|
|
|
|
/* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint, unlinked
|
|
from the bp_locations array, but for which a hit may still be
|
|
reported by a target. */
|
|
static std::vector<bp_location *> moribund_locations;
|
|
|
|
/* Number of last breakpoint made. */
|
|
|
|
static int breakpoint_count;
|
|
|
|
/* The value of `breakpoint_count' before the last command that
|
|
created breakpoints. If the last (break-like) command created more
|
|
than one breakpoint, then the difference between BREAKPOINT_COUNT
|
|
and PREV_BREAKPOINT_COUNT is more than one. */
|
|
static int prev_breakpoint_count;
|
|
|
|
/* Number of last tracepoint made. */
|
|
|
|
static int tracepoint_count;
|
|
|
|
static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist;
|
|
static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist;
|
|
struct cmd_list_element *save_cmdlist;
|
|
|
|
/* See declaration at breakpoint.h. */
|
|
|
|
struct breakpoint *
|
|
breakpoint_find_if (int (*func) (struct breakpoint *b, void *d),
|
|
void *user_data)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
|
|
{
|
|
if (func (b, user_data) != 0)
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return b;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint. */
|
|
static int
|
|
breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Set breakpoint count to NUM. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
set_breakpoint_count (int num)
|
|
{
|
|
prev_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
|
|
breakpoint_count = num;
|
|
set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Used by `start_rbreak_breakpoints' below, to record the current
|
|
breakpoint count before "rbreak" creates any breakpoint. */
|
|
static int rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
|
|
|
|
/* Called at the start an "rbreak" command to record the first
|
|
breakpoint made. */
|
|
|
|
scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::scoped_rbreak_breakpoints ()
|
|
{
|
|
rbreak_start_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Called at the end of an "rbreak" command to record the last
|
|
breakpoint made. */
|
|
|
|
scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::~scoped_rbreak_breakpoints ()
|
|
{
|
|
prev_breakpoint_count = rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
|
|
b->hit_count = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL
|
|
if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint. */
|
|
|
|
struct breakpoint *
|
|
get_breakpoint (int num)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
|
|
if (b->number == num)
|
|
return b;
|
|
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Mark locations as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
|
|
evaluating conditions on its side. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
mark_breakpoint_modified (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *loc;
|
|
|
|
/* This is only meaningful if the target is
|
|
evaluating conditions and if the user has
|
|
opted for condition evaluation on the target's
|
|
side. */
|
|
if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
|
|
|| !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
if (!is_breakpoint (b))
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
|
|
loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Mark location as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
|
|
evaluating conditions on its side. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
mark_breakpoint_location_modified (struct bp_location *loc)
|
|
{
|
|
/* This is only meaningful if the target is
|
|
evaluating conditions and if the user has
|
|
opted for condition evaluation on the target's
|
|
side. */
|
|
if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
|
|
|| !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner))
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Sets the condition-evaluation mode using the static global
|
|
condition_evaluation_mode. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
set_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *args, int from_tty,
|
|
struct cmd_list_element *c)
|
|
{
|
|
const char *old_mode, *new_mode;
|
|
|
|
if ((condition_evaluation_mode_1 == condition_evaluation_target)
|
|
&& !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
|
|
{
|
|
condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_mode;
|
|
warning (_("Target does not support breakpoint condition evaluation.\n"
|
|
"Using host evaluation mode instead."));
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
new_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode_1);
|
|
old_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
|
|
|
|
/* Flip the switch. Flip it even if OLD_MODE == NEW_MODE as one of the
|
|
settings was "auto". */
|
|
condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_mode_1;
|
|
|
|
/* Only update the mode if the user picked a different one. */
|
|
if (new_mode != old_mode)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *loc, **loc_tmp;
|
|
/* If the user switched to a different evaluation mode, we
|
|
need to synch the changes with the target as follows:
|
|
|
|
"host" -> "target": Send all (valid) conditions to the target.
|
|
"target" -> "host": Remove all the conditions from the target.
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
if (new_mode == condition_evaluation_target)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Mark everything modified and synch conditions with the
|
|
target. */
|
|
ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
|
|
mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* Manually mark non-duplicate locations to synch conditions
|
|
with the target. We do this to remove all the conditions the
|
|
target knows about. */
|
|
ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
|
|
if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->inserted)
|
|
loc->needs_update = 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Do the update. */
|
|
update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Shows the current mode of breakpoint condition evaluation. Explicitly shows
|
|
what "auto" is translating to. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
show_condition_evaluation_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
|
|
struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
|
|
{
|
|
if (condition_evaluation_mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
|
|
fprintf_filtered (file,
|
|
_("Breakpoint condition evaluation "
|
|
"mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
|
|
value,
|
|
breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ());
|
|
else
|
|
fprintf_filtered (file, _("Breakpoint condition evaluation mode is %s.\n"),
|
|
value);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP that is used by
|
|
bsearch. This comparison function only cares about addresses, unlike
|
|
the more general bp_location_is_less_than function. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
bp_locations_compare_addrs (const void *ap, const void *bp)
|
|
{
|
|
const struct bp_location *a = *(const struct bp_location **) ap;
|
|
const struct bp_location *b = *(const struct bp_location **) bp;
|
|
|
|
if (a->address == b->address)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
else
|
|
return ((a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Helper function to skip all bp_locations with addresses
|
|
less than ADDRESS. It returns the first bp_location that
|
|
is greater than or equal to ADDRESS. If none is found, just
|
|
return NULL. */
|
|
|
|
static struct bp_location **
|
|
get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location dummy_loc;
|
|
struct bp_location *dummy_locp = &dummy_loc;
|
|
struct bp_location **locp_found = NULL;
|
|
|
|
/* Initialize the dummy location's address field. */
|
|
dummy_loc.address = address;
|
|
|
|
/* Find a close match to the first location at ADDRESS. */
|
|
locp_found = ((struct bp_location **)
|
|
bsearch (&dummy_locp, bp_locations, bp_locations_count,
|
|
sizeof (struct bp_location **),
|
|
bp_locations_compare_addrs));
|
|
|
|
/* Nothing was found, nothing left to do. */
|
|
if (locp_found == NULL)
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
|
|
/* We may have found a location that is at ADDRESS but is not the first in the
|
|
location's list. Go backwards (if possible) and locate the first one. */
|
|
while ((locp_found - 1) >= bp_locations
|
|
&& (*(locp_found - 1))->address == address)
|
|
locp_found--;
|
|
|
|
return locp_found;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
set_breakpoint_condition (struct breakpoint *b, const char *exp,
|
|
int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
if (*exp == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
xfree (b->cond_string);
|
|
b->cond_string = nullptr;
|
|
|
|
if (is_watchpoint (b))
|
|
static_cast<watchpoint *> (b)->cond_exp.reset ();
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
for (bp_location *loc = b->loc; loc != nullptr; loc = loc->next)
|
|
{
|
|
loc->cond.reset ();
|
|
|
|
/* No need to free the condition agent expression
|
|
bytecode (if we have one). We will handle this
|
|
when we go through update_global_location_list. */
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (from_tty)
|
|
printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), b->number);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
if (is_watchpoint (b))
|
|
{
|
|
innermost_block_tracker tracker;
|
|
const char *arg = exp;
|
|
expression_up new_exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0, &tracker);
|
|
if (*arg != 0)
|
|
error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
|
|
watchpoint *w = static_cast<watchpoint *> (b);
|
|
w->cond_exp = std::move (new_exp);
|
|
w->cond_exp_valid_block = tracker.block ();
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* Parse and set condition expressions. We make two passes.
|
|
In the first, we parse the condition string to see if it
|
|
is valid in all locations. If so, the condition would be
|
|
accepted. So we go ahead and set the locations'
|
|
conditions. In case a failing case is found, we throw
|
|
the error and the condition string will be rejected.
|
|
This two-pass approach is taken to avoid setting the
|
|
state of locations in case of a reject. */
|
|
for (bp_location *loc = b->loc; loc != nullptr; loc = loc->next)
|
|
{
|
|
const char *arg = exp;
|
|
parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
|
|
block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
|
|
if (*arg != 0)
|
|
error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If we reach here, the condition is valid at all locations. */
|
|
for (bp_location *loc = b->loc; loc != nullptr; loc = loc->next)
|
|
{
|
|
const char *arg = exp;
|
|
loc->cond =
|
|
parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
|
|
block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* We know that the new condition parsed successfully. The
|
|
condition string of the breakpoint can be safely updated. */
|
|
xfree (b->cond_string);
|
|
b->cond_string = xstrdup (exp);
|
|
b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
mark_breakpoint_modified (b);
|
|
|
|
gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Completion for the "condition" command. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
condition_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
|
|
completion_tracker &tracker,
|
|
const char *text, const char *word)
|
|
{
|
|
const char *space;
|
|
|
|
text = skip_spaces (text);
|
|
space = skip_to_space (text);
|
|
if (*space == '\0')
|
|
{
|
|
int len;
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
|
|
if (text[0] == '$')
|
|
{
|
|
/* We don't support completion of history indices. */
|
|
if (!isdigit (text[1]))
|
|
complete_internalvar (tracker, &text[1]);
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* We're completing the breakpoint number. */
|
|
len = strlen (text);
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
|
|
{
|
|
char number[50];
|
|
|
|
xsnprintf (number, sizeof (number), "%d", b->number);
|
|
|
|
if (strncmp (number, text, len) == 0)
|
|
tracker.add_completion (make_unique_xstrdup (number));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* We're completing the expression part. */
|
|
text = skip_spaces (space);
|
|
expression_completer (cmd, tracker, text, word);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
condition_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
const char *p;
|
|
int bnum;
|
|
|
|
if (arg == 0)
|
|
error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number"));
|
|
|
|
p = arg;
|
|
bnum = get_number (&p);
|
|
if (bnum == 0)
|
|
error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg);
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
|
|
if (b->number == bnum)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Check if this breakpoint has a "stop" method implemented in an
|
|
extension language. This method and conditions entered into GDB
|
|
from the CLI are mutually exclusive. */
|
|
const struct extension_language_defn *extlang
|
|
= get_breakpoint_cond_ext_lang (b, EXT_LANG_NONE);
|
|
|
|
if (extlang != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
error (_("Only one stop condition allowed. There is currently"
|
|
" a %s stop condition defined for this breakpoint."),
|
|
ext_lang_capitalized_name (extlang));
|
|
}
|
|
set_breakpoint_condition (b, p, from_tty);
|
|
|
|
if (is_breakpoint (b))
|
|
update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Check that COMMAND do not contain commands that are suitable
|
|
only for tracepoints and not suitable for ordinary breakpoints.
|
|
Throw if any such commands is found. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
check_no_tracepoint_commands (struct command_line *commands)
|
|
{
|
|
struct command_line *c;
|
|
|
|
for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
|
|
{
|
|
if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
|
|
error (_("The 'while-stepping' command can "
|
|
"only be used for tracepoints"));
|
|
|
|
check_no_tracepoint_commands (c->body_list_0.get ());
|
|
check_no_tracepoint_commands (c->body_list_1.get ());
|
|
|
|
/* Not that command parsing removes leading whitespace and comment
|
|
lines and also empty lines. So, we only need to check for
|
|
command directly. */
|
|
if (strstr (c->line, "collect ") == c->line)
|
|
error (_("The 'collect' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
|
|
|
|
if (strstr (c->line, "teval ") == c->line)
|
|
error (_("The 'teval' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
struct longjmp_breakpoint : public breakpoint
|
|
{
|
|
~longjmp_breakpoint () override;
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* Encapsulate tests for different types of tracepoints. */
|
|
|
|
static bool
|
|
is_tracepoint_type (bptype type)
|
|
{
|
|
return (type == bp_tracepoint
|
|
|| type == bp_fast_tracepoint
|
|
|| type == bp_static_tracepoint);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static bool
|
|
is_longjmp_type (bptype type)
|
|
{
|
|
return type == bp_longjmp || type == bp_exception;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* See breakpoint.h. */
|
|
|
|
bool
|
|
is_tracepoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
return is_tracepoint_type (b->type);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Factory function to create an appropriate instance of breakpoint given
|
|
TYPE. */
|
|
|
|
static std::unique_ptr<breakpoint>
|
|
new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype type)
|
|
{
|
|
breakpoint *b;
|
|
|
|
if (is_tracepoint_type (type))
|
|
b = new tracepoint ();
|
|
else if (is_longjmp_type (type))
|
|
b = new longjmp_breakpoint ();
|
|
else
|
|
b = new breakpoint ();
|
|
|
|
return std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> (b);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* A helper function that validates that COMMANDS are valid for a
|
|
breakpoint. This function will throw an exception if a problem is
|
|
found. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
validate_commands_for_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
|
|
struct command_line *commands)
|
|
{
|
|
if (is_tracepoint (b))
|
|
{
|
|
struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
|
|
struct command_line *c;
|
|
struct command_line *while_stepping = 0;
|
|
|
|
/* Reset the while-stepping step count. The previous commands
|
|
might have included a while-stepping action, while the new
|
|
ones might not. */
|
|
t->step_count = 0;
|
|
|
|
/* We need to verify that each top-level element of commands is
|
|
valid for tracepoints, that there's at most one
|
|
while-stepping element, and that the while-stepping's body
|
|
has valid tracing commands excluding nested while-stepping.
|
|
We also need to validate the tracepoint action line in the
|
|
context of the tracepoint --- validate_actionline actually
|
|
has side effects, like setting the tracepoint's
|
|
while-stepping STEP_COUNT, in addition to checking if the
|
|
collect/teval actions parse and make sense in the
|
|
tracepoint's context. */
|
|
for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
|
|
{
|
|
if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
|
|
{
|
|
if (b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
|
|
error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
|
|
"cannot be used for fast tracepoint"));
|
|
else if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
|
|
error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
|
|
"cannot be used for static tracepoint"));
|
|
|
|
if (while_stepping)
|
|
error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
|
|
"can be used only once"));
|
|
else
|
|
while_stepping = c;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
validate_actionline (c->line, b);
|
|
}
|
|
if (while_stepping)
|
|
{
|
|
struct command_line *c2;
|
|
|
|
gdb_assert (while_stepping->body_list_1 == nullptr);
|
|
c2 = while_stepping->body_list_0.get ();
|
|
for (; c2; c2 = c2->next)
|
|
{
|
|
if (c2->control_type == while_stepping_control)
|
|
error (_("The 'while-stepping' command cannot be nested"));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
check_no_tracepoint_commands (commands);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Return a vector of all the static tracepoints set at ADDR. The
|
|
caller is responsible for releasing the vector. */
|
|
|
|
std::vector<breakpoint *>
|
|
static_tracepoints_here (CORE_ADDR addr)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
std::vector<breakpoint *> found;
|
|
struct bp_location *loc;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
|
|
if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
|
|
{
|
|
for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
|
|
if (loc->address == addr)
|
|
found.push_back (b);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return found;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS. If breakpoint is tracepoint,
|
|
validate that only allowed commands are included. */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b,
|
|
counted_command_line &&commands)
|
|
{
|
|
validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, commands.get ());
|
|
|
|
b->commands = std::move (commands);
|
|
gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Set the internal `silent' flag on the breakpoint. Note that this
|
|
is not the same as the "silent" that may appear in the breakpoint's
|
|
commands. */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
breakpoint_set_silent (struct breakpoint *b, int silent)
|
|
{
|
|
int old_silent = b->silent;
|
|
|
|
b->silent = silent;
|
|
if (old_silent != silent)
|
|
gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Set the thread for this breakpoint. If THREAD is -1, make the
|
|
breakpoint work for any thread. */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
breakpoint_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b, int thread)
|
|
{
|
|
int old_thread = b->thread;
|
|
|
|
b->thread = thread;
|
|
if (old_thread != thread)
|
|
gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Set the task for this breakpoint. If TASK is 0, make the
|
|
breakpoint work for any task. */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
breakpoint_set_task (struct breakpoint *b, int task)
|
|
{
|
|
int old_task = b->task;
|
|
|
|
b->task = task;
|
|
if (old_task != task)
|
|
gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
commands_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
|
|
struct command_line *control)
|
|
{
|
|
counted_command_line cmd;
|
|
/* cmd_read will be true once we have read cmd. Note that cmd might still be
|
|
NULL after the call to read_command_lines if the user provides an empty
|
|
list of command by just typing "end". */
|
|
bool cmd_read = false;
|
|
|
|
std::string new_arg;
|
|
|
|
if (arg == NULL || !*arg)
|
|
{
|
|
if (breakpoint_count - prev_breakpoint_count > 1)
|
|
new_arg = string_printf ("%d-%d", prev_breakpoint_count + 1,
|
|
breakpoint_count);
|
|
else if (breakpoint_count > 0)
|
|
new_arg = string_printf ("%d", breakpoint_count);
|
|
arg = new_arg.c_str ();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
map_breakpoint_numbers
|
|
(arg, [&] (breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!cmd_read)
|
|
{
|
|
gdb_assert (cmd == NULL);
|
|
if (control != NULL)
|
|
cmd = control->body_list_0;
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
std::string str
|
|
= string_printf (_("Type commands for breakpoint(s) "
|
|
"%s, one per line."),
|
|
arg);
|
|
|
|
auto do_validate = [=] (const char *line)
|
|
{
|
|
validate_actionline (line, b);
|
|
};
|
|
gdb::function_view<void (const char *)> validator;
|
|
if (is_tracepoint (b))
|
|
validator = do_validate;
|
|
|
|
cmd = read_command_lines (str.c_str (), from_tty, 1, validator);
|
|
}
|
|
cmd_read = true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If a breakpoint was on the list more than once, we don't need to
|
|
do anything. */
|
|
if (b->commands != cmd)
|
|
{
|
|
validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, cmd.get ());
|
|
b->commands = cmd;
|
|
gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
|
|
}
|
|
});
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
commands_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
commands_command_1 (arg, from_tty, NULL);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from
|
|
input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure.
|
|
|
|
This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands
|
|
that are part of if and while bodies. */
|
|
enum command_control_type
|
|
commands_from_control_command (const char *arg, struct command_line *cmd)
|
|
{
|
|
commands_command_1 (arg, 0, cmd);
|
|
return simple_control;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl)
|
|
{
|
|
if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
if (!bl->inserted)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0)
|
|
/* BL isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory. */
|
|
return 0;
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address
|
|
MEMADDR, by replacing a memory breakpoint with its shadowed
|
|
contents.
|
|
|
|
If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with the of
|
|
the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffer. Otherwise, a
|
|
failed assertion internal error will be raised. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
|
|
const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
|
|
ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len,
|
|
struct bp_target_info *target_info,
|
|
struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
|
|
CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
|
|
int bp_size = 0;
|
|
int bptoffset = 0;
|
|
|
|
if (!breakpoint_address_match (target_info->placed_address_space, 0,
|
|
current_program_space->aspace, 0))
|
|
{
|
|
/* The breakpoint is inserted in a different address space. */
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that
|
|
we need to copy. */
|
|
bp_addr = target_info->placed_address;
|
|
bp_size = target_info->shadow_len;
|
|
|
|
if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr)
|
|
{
|
|
/* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we are
|
|
reading. */
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len)
|
|
{
|
|
/* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are
|
|
reading. */
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Offset within shadow_contents. */
|
|
if (bp_addr < memaddr)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint. */
|
|
bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr;
|
|
bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr;
|
|
bp_addr = memaddr;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint. */
|
|
bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (readbuf != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Verify that the readbuf buffer does not overlap with the
|
|
shadow_contents buffer. */
|
|
gdb_assert (target_info->shadow_contents >= readbuf + len
|
|
|| readbuf >= (target_info->shadow_contents
|
|
+ target_info->shadow_len));
|
|
|
|
/* Update the read buffer with this inserted breakpoint's
|
|
shadow. */
|
|
memcpy (readbuf + bp_addr - memaddr,
|
|
target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
const unsigned char *bp;
|
|
CORE_ADDR addr = target_info->reqstd_address;
|
|
int placed_size;
|
|
|
|
/* Update the shadow with what we want to write to memory. */
|
|
memcpy (target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset,
|
|
writebuf_org + bp_addr - memaddr, bp_size);
|
|
|
|
/* Determine appropriate breakpoint contents and size for this
|
|
address. */
|
|
bp = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &addr, &placed_size);
|
|
|
|
/* Update the final write buffer with this inserted
|
|
breakpoint's INSN. */
|
|
memcpy (writebuf + bp_addr - memaddr, bp + bptoffset, bp_size);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR,
|
|
by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents.
|
|
|
|
If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with any of
|
|
the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffers. Otherwise,
|
|
a failed assertion internal error will be raised.
|
|
|
|
The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is:
|
|
bl->address - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max
|
|
up to bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
|
|
The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is:
|
|
memaddr ... memaddr + len
|
|
Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are
|
|
memaddr + len <= (bl->address
|
|
- bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max)
|
|
and:
|
|
bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
|
|
const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
|
|
ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary
|
|
search. */
|
|
unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc;
|
|
|
|
/* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF
|
|
content. It is safe to report lower value but a failure to
|
|
report higher one. */
|
|
|
|
bc_l = 0;
|
|
bc_r = bp_locations_count;
|
|
while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *bl;
|
|
|
|
bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2;
|
|
bl = bp_locations[bc];
|
|
|
|
/* Check first BL->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added
|
|
constant. Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure
|
|
the BC element can in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR
|
|
to MEMADDR + LEN range).
|
|
|
|
Use the BP_LOCATIONS_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety
|
|
offset so that we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow
|
|
range tail still reaching MEMADDR. */
|
|
|
|
if ((bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
|
|
>= bl->address)
|
|
&& (bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
|
|
<= memaddr))
|
|
bc_l = bc;
|
|
else
|
|
bc_r = bc;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Due to the binary search above, we need to make sure we pick the
|
|
first location that's at BC_L's address. E.g., if there are
|
|
multiple locations at the same address, BC_L may end up pointing
|
|
at a duplicate location, and miss the "master"/"inserted"
|
|
location. Say, given locations L1, L2 and L3 at addresses A and
|
|
B:
|
|
|
|
L1@A, L2@A, L3@B, ...
|
|
|
|
BC_L could end up pointing at location L2, while the "master"
|
|
location could be L1. Since the `loc->inserted' flag is only set
|
|
on "master" locations, we'd forget to restore the shadow of L1
|
|
and L2. */
|
|
while (bc_l > 0
|
|
&& bp_locations[bc_l]->address == bp_locations[bc_l - 1]->address)
|
|
bc_l--;
|
|
|
|
/* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
|
|
|
|
for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_locations_count; bc++)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *bl = bp_locations[bc];
|
|
|
|
/* bp_location array has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
|
|
if (bl->owner->type == bp_none)
|
|
warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
|
|
bl->owner->number);
|
|
|
|
/* Performance optimization: any further element can no longer affect BUF
|
|
content. */
|
|
|
|
if (bl->address >= bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max
|
|
&& memaddr + len <= (bl->address
|
|
- bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max))
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (readbuf, writebuf, writebuf_org,
|
|
memaddr, len, &bl->target_info, bl->gdbarch);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* See breakpoint.h. */
|
|
|
|
bool
|
|
is_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
|
|
{
|
|
return (bpt->type == bp_breakpoint
|
|
|| bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
|
|
|| bpt->type == bp_dprintf);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Return true if BPT is of any hardware watchpoint kind. */
|
|
|
|
static bool
|
|
is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
|
|
{
|
|
return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
|
|
|| bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
|
|
|| bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* See breakpoint.h. */
|
|
|
|
bool
|
|
is_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
|
|
{
|
|
return (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt)
|
|
|| bpt->type == bp_watchpoint);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Returns true if the current thread and its running state are safe
|
|
to evaluate or update watchpoint B. Watchpoints on local
|
|
expressions need to be evaluated in the context of the thread that
|
|
was current when the watchpoint was created, and, that thread needs
|
|
to be stopped to be able to select the correct frame context.
|
|
Watchpoints on global expressions can be evaluated on any thread,
|
|
and in any state. It is presently left to the target allowing
|
|
memory accesses when threads are running. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct watchpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
return (b->pspace == current_program_space
|
|
&& (b->watchpoint_thread == null_ptid
|
|
|| (inferior_ptid == b->watchpoint_thread
|
|
&& !inferior_thread ()->executing)));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Set watchpoint B to disp_del_at_next_stop, even including its possible
|
|
associated bp_watchpoint_scope breakpoint. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (struct watchpoint *w)
|
|
{
|
|
if (w->related_breakpoint != w)
|
|
{
|
|
gdb_assert (w->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope);
|
|
gdb_assert (w->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint == w);
|
|
w->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
|
|
w->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = w->related_breakpoint;
|
|
w->related_breakpoint = w;
|
|
}
|
|
w->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Extract a bitfield value from value VAL using the bit parameters contained in
|
|
watchpoint W. */
|
|
|
|
static struct value *
|
|
extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (struct watchpoint *w, struct value *val)
|
|
{
|
|
struct value *bit_val;
|
|
|
|
if (val == NULL)
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
|
|
bit_val = allocate_value (value_type (val));
|
|
|
|
unpack_value_bitfield (bit_val,
|
|
w->val_bitpos,
|
|
w->val_bitsize,
|
|
value_contents_for_printing (val),
|
|
value_offset (val),
|
|
val);
|
|
|
|
return bit_val;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Allocate a dummy location and add it to B, which must be a software
|
|
watchpoint. This is required because even if a software watchpoint
|
|
is not watching any memory, bpstat_stop_status requires a location
|
|
to be able to report stops. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
software_watchpoint_add_no_memory_location (struct breakpoint *b,
|
|
struct program_space *pspace)
|
|
{
|
|
gdb_assert (b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc == NULL);
|
|
|
|
b->loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
|
|
b->loc->pspace = pspace;
|
|
b->loc->address = -1;
|
|
b->loc->length = -1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Returns true if B is a software watchpoint that is not watching any
|
|
memory (e.g., "watch $pc"). */
|
|
|
|
static bool
|
|
is_no_memory_software_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
return (b->type == bp_watchpoint
|
|
&& b->loc != NULL
|
|
&& b->loc->next == NULL
|
|
&& b->loc->address == -1
|
|
&& b->loc->length == -1);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Assuming that B is a watchpoint:
|
|
- Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero
|
|
- Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val
|
|
- Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result
|
|
in b->loc->cond.
|
|
- Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc.
|
|
|
|
If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do
|
|
nothing. If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete
|
|
it.
|
|
|
|
Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are
|
|
removed + inserted on each stop here. Normal breakpoints must
|
|
never be removed because they might be missed by a running thread
|
|
when debugging in non-stop mode. On the other hand, hardware
|
|
watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint; processed here) are specific
|
|
to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's hardware debug
|
|
registers. Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in order to
|
|
be able to modify its hardware watchpoints.
|
|
|
|
Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being
|
|
presented to the user. It cannot be done sooner, because it would
|
|
reset the data used to present the watchpoint hit to the user. And
|
|
it must not be done later because it could display the same single
|
|
watchpoint hit during multiple GDB stops. Note that the latter is
|
|
relevant only to the hardware watchpoint types bp_read_watchpoint
|
|
and bp_access_watchpoint. False hit by bp_hardware_watchpoint is
|
|
not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the memory content has
|
|
not changed.
|
|
|
|
The following constraints influence the location where we can reset
|
|
hardware watchpoints:
|
|
|
|
* target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are
|
|
called several times when GDB stops.
|
|
|
|
[linux]
|
|
* Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time,
|
|
causing GDB to stop. GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint
|
|
hit at a time as the reason for stopping, and all the other hits
|
|
are presented later, one after the other, each time the user
|
|
requests the execution to be resumed. Execution is not resumed
|
|
for the threads still having pending hit event stored in
|
|
LWP_INFO->STATUS. While the watchpoint is already removed from
|
|
the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being
|
|
reported from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address
|
|
until the real thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets
|
|
presented and thus its LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset.
|
|
|
|
Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the
|
|
watchpoint removal from inferior. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
update_watchpoint (struct watchpoint *b, int reparse)
|
|
{
|
|
int within_current_scope;
|
|
struct frame_id saved_frame_id;
|
|
int frame_saved;
|
|
|
|
/* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
|
|
watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
|
|
that was used to create the watchpoint. */
|
|
if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
frame_saved = 0;
|
|
|
|
/* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope. */
|
|
if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
|
|
within_current_scope = 1;
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
struct frame_info *fi = get_current_frame ();
|
|
struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (fi);
|
|
CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (fi);
|
|
|
|
/* If we're at a point where the stack has been destroyed
|
|
(e.g. in a function epilogue), unwinding may not work
|
|
properly. Do not attempt to recreate locations at this
|
|
point. See similar comments in watchpoint_check. */
|
|
if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
/* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after
|
|
evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame. */
|
|
/* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression
|
|
took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the
|
|
selected frame. */
|
|
frame_saved = 1;
|
|
saved_frame_id = get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL));
|
|
|
|
fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
|
|
within_current_scope = (fi != NULL);
|
|
if (within_current_scope)
|
|
select_frame (fi);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* We don't free locations. They are stored in the bp_location array
|
|
and update_global_location_list will eventually delete them and
|
|
remove breakpoints if needed. */
|
|
b->loc = NULL;
|
|
|
|
if (within_current_scope && reparse)
|
|
{
|
|
const char *s;
|
|
|
|
b->exp.reset ();
|
|
s = b->exp_string_reparse ? b->exp_string_reparse : b->exp_string;
|
|
b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
|
|
/* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is
|
|
no longer relevant. We don't want to report a watchpoint hit
|
|
to the user when the old value and the new value may actually
|
|
be completely different objects. */
|
|
b->val = NULL;
|
|
b->val_valid = false;
|
|
|
|
/* Note that unlike with breakpoints, the watchpoint's condition
|
|
expression is stored in the breakpoint object, not in the
|
|
locations (re)created below. */
|
|
if (b->cond_string != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
b->cond_exp.reset ();
|
|
|
|
s = b->cond_string;
|
|
b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->cond_exp_valid_block, 0);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because
|
|
it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library,
|
|
don't try to insert watchpoint. We don't automatically delete
|
|
such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression
|
|
is different from out-of-scope watchpoint. */
|
|
if (!target_has_execution)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Without execution, memory can't change. No use to try and
|
|
set watchpoint locations. The watchpoint will be reset when
|
|
the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set. */
|
|
if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
|
|
{
|
|
if (b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b))
|
|
b->type = bp_watchpoint;
|
|
else
|
|
error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
|
|
"hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else if (within_current_scope && b->exp)
|
|
{
|
|
int pc = 0;
|
|
std::vector<value_ref_ptr> val_chain;
|
|
struct value *v, *result;
|
|
struct program_space *frame_pspace;
|
|
|
|
fetch_subexp_value (b->exp.get (), &pc, &v, &result, &val_chain, 0);
|
|
|
|
/* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set. The meaning of
|
|
b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update
|
|
it only if we reported that last value to user. As it
|
|
happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly.
|
|
We don't keep track of the memory value for masked
|
|
watchpoints. */
|
|
if (!b->val_valid && !is_masked_watchpoint (b))
|
|
{
|
|
if (b->val_bitsize != 0)
|
|
v = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, v);
|
|
b->val = release_value (v);
|
|
b->val_valid = true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
frame_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL));
|
|
|
|
/* Look at each value on the value chain. */
|
|
gdb_assert (!val_chain.empty ());
|
|
for (const value_ref_ptr &iter : val_chain)
|
|
{
|
|
v = iter.get ();
|
|
|
|
/* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed
|
|
its contents to evaluate the expression, then we
|
|
must watch it. If the first value returned is
|
|
still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it;
|
|
watch it anyway in case it becomes readable. */
|
|
if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory
|
|
&& (v == val_chain[0] || ! value_lazy (v)))
|
|
{
|
|
struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
|
|
|
|
/* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked
|
|
for it explicitly, never if they just happen to
|
|
appear in the middle of some value chain. */
|
|
if (v == result
|
|
|| (vtype->code () != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
|
|
&& vtype->code () != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
|
|
{
|
|
CORE_ADDR addr;
|
|
enum target_hw_bp_type type;
|
|
struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
|
|
int bitpos = 0, bitsize = 0;
|
|
|
|
if (value_bitsize (v) != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Extract the bit parameters out from the bitfield
|
|
sub-expression. */
|
|
bitpos = value_bitpos (v);
|
|
bitsize = value_bitsize (v);
|
|
}
|
|
else if (v == result && b->val_bitsize != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
/* If VAL_BITSIZE != 0 then RESULT is actually a bitfield
|
|
lvalue whose bit parameters are saved in the fields
|
|
VAL_BITPOS and VAL_BITSIZE. */
|
|
bitpos = b->val_bitpos;
|
|
bitsize = b->val_bitsize;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
addr = value_address (v);
|
|
if (bitsize != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Skip the bytes that don't contain the bitfield. */
|
|
addr += bitpos / 8;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type = hw_write;
|
|
if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
|
|
type = hw_read;
|
|
else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
|
|
type = hw_access;
|
|
|
|
loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
|
|
for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
|
|
;
|
|
*tmp = loc;
|
|
loc->gdbarch = get_type_arch (value_type (v));
|
|
|
|
loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
|
|
loc->address = address_significant (loc->gdbarch, addr);
|
|
|
|
if (bitsize != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Just cover the bytes that make up the bitfield. */
|
|
loc->length = ((bitpos % 8) + bitsize + 7) / 8;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
loc->length = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
|
|
|
|
loc->watchpoint_type = type;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or
|
|
an ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support
|
|
and free hardware slots. REPARSE is set when the inferior
|
|
is started. */
|
|
if (reparse)
|
|
{
|
|
int reg_cnt;
|
|
enum bp_loc_type loc_type;
|
|
struct bp_location *bl;
|
|
|
|
reg_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain);
|
|
|
|
if (reg_cnt)
|
|
{
|
|
int i, target_resources_ok, other_type_used;
|
|
enum bptype type;
|
|
|
|
/* Use an exact watchpoint when there's only one memory region to be
|
|
watched, and only one debug register is needed to watch it. */
|
|
b->exact = target_exact_watchpoints && reg_cnt == 1;
|
|
|
|
/* We need to determine how many resources are already
|
|
used for all other hardware watchpoints plus this one
|
|
to see if we still have enough resources to also fit
|
|
this watchpoint in as well. */
|
|
|
|
/* If this is a software watchpoint, we try to turn it
|
|
to a hardware one -- count resources as if B was of
|
|
hardware watchpoint type. */
|
|
type = b->type;
|
|
if (type == bp_watchpoint)
|
|
type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
|
|
|
|
/* This watchpoint may or may not have been placed on
|
|
the list yet at this point (it won't be in the list
|
|
if we're trying to create it for the first time,
|
|
through watch_command), so always account for it
|
|
manually. */
|
|
|
|
/* Count resources used by all watchpoints except B. */
|
|
i = hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (b, type, &other_type_used);
|
|
|
|
/* Add in the resources needed for B. */
|
|
i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b);
|
|
|
|
target_resources_ok
|
|
= target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (type, i, other_type_used);
|
|
if (target_resources_ok <= 0)
|
|
{
|
|
int sw_mode = b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b);
|
|
|
|
if (target_resources_ok == 0 && !sw_mode)
|
|
error (_("Target does not support this type of "
|
|
"hardware watchpoint."));
|
|
else if (target_resources_ok < 0 && !sw_mode)
|
|
error (_("There are not enough available hardware "
|
|
"resources for this watchpoint."));
|
|
|
|
/* Downgrade to software watchpoint. */
|
|
b->type = bp_watchpoint;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* If this was a software watchpoint, we've just
|
|
found we have enough resources to turn it to a
|
|
hardware watchpoint. Otherwise, this is a
|
|
nop. */
|
|
b->type = type;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else if (!b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b))
|
|
{
|
|
if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
|
|
error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
|
|
"hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
|
|
else
|
|
error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with "
|
|
"read/access watchpoint."));
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
b->type = bp_watchpoint;
|
|
|
|
loc_type = (b->type == bp_watchpoint? bp_loc_other
|
|
: bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint);
|
|
for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
|
|
bl->loc_type = loc_type;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If a software watchpoint is not watching any memory, then the
|
|
above left it without any location set up. But,
|
|
bpstat_stop_status requires a location to be able to report
|
|
stops, so make sure there's at least a dummy one. */
|
|
if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc == NULL)
|
|
software_watchpoint_add_no_memory_location (b, frame_pspace);
|
|
}
|
|
else if (!within_current_scope)
|
|
{
|
|
printf_filtered (_("\
|
|
Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block\n\
|
|
in which its expression is valid.\n"),
|
|
b->number);
|
|
watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Restore the selected frame. */
|
|
if (frame_saved)
|
|
select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be
|
|
inserted in the inferior. We don't differentiate the type of BL's owner
|
|
(breakpoint vs. tracepoint), although insert_location in tracepoint's
|
|
breakpoint_ops is not defined, because in insert_bp_location,
|
|
tracepoint's insert_location will not be called. */
|
|
static int
|
|
should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
|
|
{
|
|
if (bl->owner == NULL || !breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner))
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
if (bl->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled || bl->duplicate)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
if (user_breakpoint_p (bl->owner) && bl->pspace->executing_startup)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
/* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a
|
|
vfork, and have detached from the child. The child is running
|
|
free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the
|
|
OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports
|
|
that the vfork is done). Until the child is done with the shared
|
|
memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise
|
|
the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints. Since
|
|
the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint. */
|
|
if (bl->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
/* Don't insert a breakpoint if we're trying to step past its
|
|
location, except if the breakpoint is a single-step breakpoint,
|
|
and the breakpoint's thread is the thread which is stepping past
|
|
a breakpoint. */
|
|
if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
|
|
|| bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
|
|
&& stepping_past_instruction_at (bl->pspace->aspace,
|
|
bl->address)
|
|
/* The single-step breakpoint may be inserted at the location
|
|
we're trying to step if the instruction branches to itself.
|
|
However, the instruction won't be executed at all and it may
|
|
break the semantics of the instruction, for example, the
|
|
instruction is a conditional branch or updates some flags.
|
|
We can't fix it unless GDB is able to emulate the instruction
|
|
or switch to displaced stepping. */
|
|
&& !(bl->owner->type == bp_single_step
|
|
&& thread_is_stepping_over_breakpoint (bl->owner->thread)))
|
|
{
|
|
infrun_debug_printf ("skipping breakpoint: stepping past insn at: %s",
|
|
paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Don't insert watchpoints if we're trying to step past the
|
|
instruction that triggered one. */
|
|
if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
|
|
&& stepping_past_nonsteppable_watchpoint ())
|
|
{
|
|
infrun_debug_printf ("stepping past non-steppable watchpoint. "
|
|
"skipping watchpoint at %s:%d\n",
|
|
paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address), bl->length);
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Same as should_be_inserted but does the check assuming
|
|
that the location is not duplicated. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
unduplicated_should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
|
|
{
|
|
int result;
|
|
const int save_duplicate = bl->duplicate;
|
|
|
|
bl->duplicate = 0;
|
|
result = should_be_inserted (bl);
|
|
bl->duplicate = save_duplicate;
|
|
return result;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Parses a conditional described by an expression COND into an
|
|
agent expression bytecode suitable for evaluation
|
|
by the bytecode interpreter. Return NULL if there was
|
|
any error during parsing. */
|
|
|
|
static agent_expr_up
|
|
parse_cond_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, struct expression *cond)
|
|
{
|
|
if (cond == NULL)
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
|
|
agent_expr_up aexpr;
|
|
|
|
/* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
|
|
that may show up. */
|
|
try
|
|
{
|
|
aexpr = gen_eval_for_expr (scope, cond);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
catch (const gdb_exception_error &ex)
|
|
{
|
|
/* If we got here, it means the condition could not be parsed to a valid
|
|
bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
|
|
It's no use iterating through the conditions. */
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* We have a valid agent expression. */
|
|
return aexpr;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint conditions to be
|
|
passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with different
|
|
conditions, we will add such conditions to the list. The idea is that the
|
|
target will evaluate the list of conditions and will only notify GDB when
|
|
one of them is true. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
build_target_condition_list (struct bp_location *bl)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
|
|
int null_condition_or_parse_error = 0;
|
|
int modified = bl->needs_update;
|
|
struct bp_location *loc;
|
|
|
|
/* Release conditions left over from a previous insert. */
|
|
bl->target_info.conditions.clear ();
|
|
|
|
/* This is only meaningful if the target is
|
|
evaluating conditions and if the user has
|
|
opted for condition evaluation on the target's
|
|
side. */
|
|
if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
|
|
|| !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
/* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
|
|
conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent
|
|
expression bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to
|
|
send conditions to the target since this location will always
|
|
trigger and generate a response back to GDB. Note we consider
|
|
all locations at the same address irrespective of type, i.e.,
|
|
even if the locations aren't considered duplicates (e.g.,
|
|
software breakpoint and hardware breakpoint at the same
|
|
address). */
|
|
ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
|
|
{
|
|
loc = (*loc2p);
|
|
if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
|
|
{
|
|
if (modified)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Re-parse the conditions since something changed. In that
|
|
case we already freed the condition bytecodes (see
|
|
force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
|
|
need to parse the condition to bytecodes again. */
|
|
loc->cond_bytecode = parse_cond_to_aexpr (bl->address,
|
|
loc->cond.get ());
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
|
|
went wrong or we have a null condition expression. */
|
|
if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
|
|
{
|
|
null_condition_or_parse_error = 1;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If any of these happened, it means we will have to evaluate the conditions
|
|
for the location's address on gdb's side. It is no use keeping bytecodes
|
|
for all the other duplicate locations, thus we free all of them here.
|
|
|
|
This is so we have a finer control over which locations' conditions are
|
|
being evaluated by GDB or the remote stub. */
|
|
if (null_condition_or_parse_error)
|
|
{
|
|
ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
|
|
{
|
|
loc = (*loc2p);
|
|
if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
|
|
located. */
|
|
if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
loc->cond_bytecode.reset ();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* No NULL conditions or failed bytecode generation. Build a
|
|
condition list for this location's address. If we have software
|
|
and hardware locations at the same address, they aren't
|
|
considered duplicates, but we still marge all the conditions
|
|
anyway, as it's simpler, and doesn't really make a practical
|
|
difference. */
|
|
ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
|
|
{
|
|
loc = (*loc2p);
|
|
if (loc->cond
|
|
&& is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
|
|
&& loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
|
|
&& loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
|
|
&& loc->enabled)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Add the condition to the vector. This will be used later
|
|
to send the conditions to the target. */
|
|
bl->target_info.conditions.push_back (loc->cond_bytecode.get ());
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Parses a command described by string CMD into an agent expression
|
|
bytecode suitable for evaluation by the bytecode interpreter.
|
|
Return NULL if there was any error during parsing. */
|
|
|
|
static agent_expr_up
|
|
parse_cmd_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, char *cmd)
|
|
{
|
|
const char *cmdrest;
|
|
const char *format_start, *format_end;
|
|
struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
|
|
|
|
if (cmd == NULL)
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
|
|
cmdrest = cmd;
|
|
|
|
if (*cmdrest == ',')
|
|
++cmdrest;
|
|
cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
|
|
|
|
if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
|
|
error (_("No format string following the location"));
|
|
|
|
format_start = cmdrest;
|
|
|
|
format_pieces fpieces (&cmdrest);
|
|
|
|
format_end = cmdrest;
|
|
|
|
if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
|
|
error (_("Bad format string, non-terminated '\"'."));
|
|
|
|
cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
|
|
|
|
if (!(*cmdrest == ',' || *cmdrest == '\0'))
|
|
error (_("Invalid argument syntax"));
|
|
|
|
if (*cmdrest == ',')
|
|
cmdrest++;
|
|
cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
|
|
|
|
/* For each argument, make an expression. */
|
|
|
|
std::vector<struct expression *> argvec;
|
|
while (*cmdrest != '\0')
|
|
{
|
|
const char *cmd1;
|
|
|
|
cmd1 = cmdrest;
|
|
expression_up expr = parse_exp_1 (&cmd1, scope, block_for_pc (scope), 1);
|
|
argvec.push_back (expr.release ());
|
|
cmdrest = cmd1;
|
|
if (*cmdrest == ',')
|
|
++cmdrest;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
agent_expr_up aexpr;
|
|
|
|
/* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
|
|
that may show up. */
|
|
try
|
|
{
|
|
aexpr = gen_printf (scope, gdbarch, 0, 0,
|
|
format_start, format_end - format_start,
|
|
argvec.size (), argvec.data ());
|
|
}
|
|
catch (const gdb_exception_error &ex)
|
|
{
|
|
/* If we got here, it means the command could not be parsed to a valid
|
|
bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
|
|
It's no use iterating through the other commands. */
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* We have a valid agent expression, return it. */
|
|
return aexpr;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint commands to be
|
|
passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with
|
|
different commands, we will add any such to the list. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
build_target_command_list (struct bp_location *bl)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
|
|
int null_command_or_parse_error = 0;
|
|
int modified = bl->needs_update;
|
|
struct bp_location *loc;
|
|
|
|
/* Clear commands left over from a previous insert. */
|
|
bl->target_info.tcommands.clear ();
|
|
|
|
if (!target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
/* For now, limit to agent-style dprintf breakpoints. */
|
|
if (dprintf_style != dprintf_style_agent)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
/* For now, if we have any location at the same address that isn't a
|
|
dprintf, don't install the target-side commands, as that would
|
|
make the breakpoint not be reported to the core, and we'd lose
|
|
control. */
|
|
ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
|
|
{
|
|
loc = (*loc2p);
|
|
if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
|
|
&& loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
|
|
&& loc->owner->type != bp_dprintf)
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
|
|
conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression
|
|
bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions
|
|
to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a
|
|
response back to GDB. */
|
|
ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
|
|
{
|
|
loc = (*loc2p);
|
|
if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
|
|
{
|
|
if (modified)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Re-parse the commands since something changed. In that
|
|
case we already freed the command bytecodes (see
|
|
force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
|
|
need to parse the command to bytecodes again. */
|
|
loc->cmd_bytecode
|
|
= parse_cmd_to_aexpr (bl->address,
|
|
loc->owner->extra_string);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
|
|
went wrong or we have a null command expression. */
|
|
if (!loc->cmd_bytecode)
|
|
{
|
|
null_command_or_parse_error = 1;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If anything failed, then we're not doing target-side commands,
|
|
and so clean up. */
|
|
if (null_command_or_parse_error)
|
|
{
|
|
ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
|
|
{
|
|
loc = (*loc2p);
|
|
if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
|
|
&& loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
|
|
located. */
|
|
if (loc->cmd_bytecode == NULL)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
loc->cmd_bytecode.reset ();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* No NULL commands or failed bytecode generation. Build a command
|
|
list for all duplicate locations at this location's address.
|
|
Note that here we must care for whether the breakpoint location
|
|
types are considered duplicates, otherwise, say, if we have a
|
|
software and hardware location at the same address, the target
|
|
could end up running the commands twice. For the moment, we only
|
|
support targets-side commands with dprintf, but it doesn't hurt
|
|
to be pedantically correct in case that changes. */
|
|
ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
|
|
{
|
|
loc = (*loc2p);
|
|
if (breakpoint_locations_match (bl, loc)
|
|
&& loc->owner->extra_string
|
|
&& is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
|
|
&& loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
|
|
&& loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
|
|
&& loc->enabled)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Add the command to the vector. This will be used later
|
|
to send the commands to the target. */
|
|
bl->target_info.tcommands.push_back (loc->cmd_bytecode.get ());
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bl->target_info.persist = 0;
|
|
/* Maybe flag this location as persistent. */
|
|
if (bl->owner->type == bp_dprintf && disconnected_dprintf)
|
|
bl->target_info.persist = 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Return the kind of breakpoint on address *ADDR. Get the kind
|
|
of breakpoint according to ADDR except single-step breakpoint.
|
|
Get the kind of single-step breakpoint according to the current
|
|
registers state. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
breakpoint_kind (struct bp_location *bl, CORE_ADDR *addr)
|
|
{
|
|
if (bl->owner->type == bp_single_step)
|
|
{
|
|
struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (bl->owner->thread);
|
|
struct regcache *regcache;
|
|
|
|
regcache = get_thread_regcache (thr);
|
|
|
|
return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_current_state (bl->gdbarch,
|
|
regcache, addr);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_pc (bl->gdbarch, addr);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type. BL is the breakpoint
|
|
location. Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and
|
|
DISABLED_BREAKS, and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems.
|
|
Returns 0 for success, 1 if the bp_location type is not supported or
|
|
-1 for failure.
|
|
|
|
NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an
|
|
object-style method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type. */
|
|
static int
|
|
insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl,
|
|
struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream,
|
|
int *disabled_breaks,
|
|
int *hw_breakpoint_error,
|
|
int *hw_bp_error_explained_already)
|
|
{
|
|
gdb_exception bp_excpt;
|
|
|
|
if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
/* Note we don't initialize bl->target_info, as that wipes out
|
|
the breakpoint location's shadow_contents if the breakpoint
|
|
is still inserted at that location. This in turn breaks
|
|
target_read_memory which depends on these buffers when
|
|
a memory read is requested at the breakpoint location:
|
|
Once the target_info has been wiped, we fail to see that
|
|
we have a breakpoint inserted at that address and thus
|
|
read the breakpoint instead of returning the data saved in
|
|
the breakpoint location's shadow contents. */
|
|
bl->target_info.reqstd_address = bl->address;
|
|
bl->target_info.placed_address_space = bl->pspace->aspace;
|
|
bl->target_info.length = bl->length;
|
|
|
|
/* When working with target-side conditions, we must pass all the conditions
|
|
for the same breakpoint address down to the target since GDB will not
|
|
insert those locations. With a list of breakpoint conditions, the target
|
|
can decide when to stop and notify GDB. */
|
|
|
|
if (is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
|
|
{
|
|
build_target_condition_list (bl);
|
|
build_target_command_list (bl);
|
|
/* Reset the modification marker. */
|
|
bl->needs_update = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If "set breakpoint auto-hw" is "on" and a software breakpoint was
|
|
set at a read-only address, then a breakpoint location will have
|
|
been changed to hardware breakpoint before we get here. If it is
|
|
"off" however, error out before actually trying to insert the
|
|
breakpoint, with a nicer error message. */
|
|
if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
|
|
&& !automatic_hardware_breakpoints)
|
|
{
|
|
mem_region *mr = lookup_mem_region (bl->address);
|
|
|
|
if (mr != nullptr && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
|
|
{
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
|
|
_("Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
|
|
"Cannot set software breakpoint "
|
|
"at read-only address %s\n"),
|
|
bl->owner->number,
|
|
paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
|
|
|| bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
|
|
{
|
|
/* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
|
|
if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
|
|
|| bl->section == NULL
|
|
|| !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
|
|
{
|
|
/* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
|
|
try
|
|
{
|
|
int val;
|
|
|
|
val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
|
|
if (val)
|
|
bp_excpt = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR};
|
|
}
|
|
catch (gdb_exception &e)
|
|
{
|
|
bp_excpt = std::move (e);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
|
|
Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
|
|
if (!overlay_events_enabled)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Yes -- overlay event support is not active,
|
|
so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA.
|
|
This will not work for a hardware breakpoint. */
|
|
if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
|
|
warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"),
|
|
bl->owner->number);
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bl->address,
|
|
bl->section);
|
|
/* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA. */
|
|
bl->overlay_target_info = bl->target_info;
|
|
bl->overlay_target_info.reqstd_address = addr;
|
|
|
|
/* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
|
|
try
|
|
{
|
|
int val;
|
|
|
|
bl->overlay_target_info.kind
|
|
= breakpoint_kind (bl, &addr);
|
|
bl->overlay_target_info.placed_address = addr;
|
|
val = target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
|
|
&bl->overlay_target_info);
|
|
if (val)
|
|
bp_excpt
|
|
= gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR};
|
|
}
|
|
catch (gdb_exception &e)
|
|
{
|
|
bp_excpt = std::move (e);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (bp_excpt.reason != 0)
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
|
|
"Overlay breakpoint %d "
|
|
"failed: in ROM?\n",
|
|
bl->owner->number);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
/* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */
|
|
if (section_is_mapped (bl->section))
|
|
{
|
|
/* Yes. This overlay section is mapped into memory. */
|
|
try
|
|
{
|
|
int val;
|
|
|
|
val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
|
|
if (val)
|
|
bp_excpt = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR};
|
|
}
|
|
catch (gdb_exception &e)
|
|
{
|
|
bp_excpt = std::move (e);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* No. This breakpoint will not be inserted.
|
|
No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'. */
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (bp_excpt.reason != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Can't set the breakpoint. */
|
|
|
|
/* In some cases, we might not be able to insert a
|
|
breakpoint in a shared library that has already been
|
|
removed, but we have not yet processed the shlib unload
|
|
event. Unfortunately, some targets that implement
|
|
breakpoint insertion themselves can't tell why the
|
|
breakpoint insertion failed (e.g., the remote target
|
|
doesn't define error codes), so we must treat generic
|
|
errors as memory errors. */
|
|
if (bp_excpt.reason == RETURN_ERROR
|
|
&& (bp_excpt.error == GENERIC_ERROR
|
|
|| bp_excpt.error == MEMORY_ERROR)
|
|
&& bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
|
|
&& (solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
|
|
|| shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
|
|
bl->address)))
|
|
{
|
|
/* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs. */
|
|
bl->shlib_disabled = 1;
|
|
gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (bl->owner);
|
|
if (!*disabled_breaks)
|
|
{
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
|
|
"Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
|
|
bl->owner->number);
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
|
|
"Temporarily disabling shared "
|
|
"library breakpoints:\n");
|
|
}
|
|
*disabled_breaks = 1;
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
|
|
"breakpoint #%d\n", bl->owner->number);
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
|
|
{
|
|
*hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
|
|
*hw_bp_error_explained_already = bp_excpt.message != NULL;
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
|
|
"Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d%s",
|
|
bl->owner->number,
|
|
bp_excpt.message ? ":" : ".\n");
|
|
if (bp_excpt.message != NULL)
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "%s.\n",
|
|
bp_excpt.what ());
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
if (bp_excpt.message == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
std::string message
|
|
= memory_error_message (TARGET_XFER_E_IO,
|
|
bl->gdbarch, bl->address);
|
|
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
|
|
"Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
|
|
"%s\n",
|
|
bl->owner->number, message.c_str ());
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
|
|
"Cannot insert breakpoint %d: %s\n",
|
|
bl->owner->number,
|
|
bp_excpt.what ());
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
return 1;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
bl->inserted = 1;
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
|
|
/* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing
|
|
watchpoints. It's not clear that it's necessary... */
|
|
&& bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
|
|
{
|
|
int val;
|
|
|
|
gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
|
|
&& bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
|
|
|
|
val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
|
|
|
|
/* If trying to set a read-watchpoint, and it turns out it's not
|
|
supported, try emulating one with an access watchpoint. */
|
|
if (val == 1 && bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
|
|
|
|
/* But don't try to insert it, if there's already another
|
|
hw_access location that would be considered a duplicate
|
|
of this one. */
|
|
ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
|
|
if (loc != bl
|
|
&& loc->watchpoint_type == hw_access
|
|
&& watchpoint_locations_match (bl, loc))
|
|
{
|
|
bl->duplicate = 1;
|
|
bl->inserted = 1;
|
|
bl->target_info = loc->target_info;
|
|
bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
|
|
val = 0;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (val == 1)
|
|
{
|
|
bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
|
|
val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
|
|
|
|
if (val)
|
|
/* Back to the original value. */
|
|
bl->watchpoint_type = hw_read;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bl->inserted = (val == 0);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint)
|
|
{
|
|
int val;
|
|
|
|
gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
|
|
&& bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
|
|
|
|
val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
|
|
if (val)
|
|
{
|
|
bl->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled;
|
|
|
|
if (val == 1)
|
|
warning (_("\
|
|
Error inserting catchpoint %d: Your system does not support this type\n\
|
|
of catchpoint."), bl->owner->number);
|
|
else
|
|
warning (_("Error inserting catchpoint %d."), bl->owner->number);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bl->inserted = (val == 0);
|
|
|
|
/* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem
|
|
inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint,
|
|
so just return success. */
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be
|
|
deleted. It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference
|
|
PSPACE anymore. */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b, *b_temp;
|
|
struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
|
|
|
|
/* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space. */
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_temp)
|
|
{
|
|
if (b->pspace == pspace)
|
|
delete_breakpoint (b);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations
|
|
bound to PSPACE as well. Remove those. */
|
|
ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *tmp;
|
|
|
|
if (loc->pspace == pspace)
|
|
{
|
|
/* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
|
|
if (loc->owner->loc == loc)
|
|
loc->owner->loc = loc->next;
|
|
else
|
|
for (tmp = loc->owner->loc; tmp->next != NULL; tmp = tmp->next)
|
|
if (tmp->next == loc)
|
|
{
|
|
tmp->next = loc->next;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the
|
|
removed locations above. */
|
|
update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior.
|
|
Throws exception on any error.
|
|
A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted
|
|
again, so calling this function twice is safe. */
|
|
void
|
|
insert_breakpoints (void)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *bpt;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
|
|
if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
|
|
{
|
|
struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
|
|
|
|
update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Updating watchpoints creates new locations, so update the global
|
|
location list. Explicitly tell ugll to insert locations and
|
|
ignore breakpoints_always_inserted_mode. Also,
|
|
update_global_location_list tries to "upgrade" software
|
|
breakpoints to hardware breakpoints to handle "set breakpoint
|
|
auto-hw", so we need to call it even if we don't have new
|
|
locations. */
|
|
update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Invoke CALLBACK for each of bp_location. */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
iterate_over_bp_locations (walk_bp_location_callback callback)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *loc, **loc_tmp;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
|
|
{
|
|
callback (loc, NULL);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* This is used when we need to synch breakpoint conditions between GDB and the
|
|
target. It is the case with deleting and disabling of breakpoints when using
|
|
always-inserted mode. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
update_inserted_breakpoint_locations (void)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
|
|
int error_flag = 0;
|
|
int val = 0;
|
|
int disabled_breaks = 0;
|
|
int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
|
|
int hw_bp_details_reported = 0;
|
|
|
|
string_file tmp_error_stream;
|
|
|
|
/* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
|
|
there was an error. */
|
|
tmp_error_stream.puts ("Warning:\n");
|
|
|
|
scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
|
|
{
|
|
/* We only want to update software breakpoints and hardware
|
|
breakpoints. */
|
|
if (!is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* We only want to update locations that are already inserted
|
|
and need updating. This is to avoid unwanted insertion during
|
|
deletion of breakpoints. */
|
|
if (!bl->inserted || !bl->needs_update)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
|
|
|
|
/* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
|
|
to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
|
|
if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
|
|
insert breakpoints. */
|
|
if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
|
|
&& (inferior_ptid == null_ptid || !target_has_execution))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
val = insert_bp_location (bl, &tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
|
|
&hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_details_reported);
|
|
if (val)
|
|
error_flag = val;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (error_flag)
|
|
{
|
|
target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
|
|
error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Used when starting or continuing the program. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
insert_breakpoint_locations (void)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *bpt;
|
|
struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
|
|
int error_flag = 0;
|
|
int val = 0;
|
|
int disabled_breaks = 0;
|
|
int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
|
|
int hw_bp_error_explained_already = 0;
|
|
|
|
string_file tmp_error_stream;
|
|
|
|
/* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
|
|
there was an error. */
|
|
tmp_error_stream.puts ("Warning:\n");
|
|
|
|
scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if
|
|
the thread no longer exists. ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location
|
|
has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
|
|
if (bl->owner->thread != -1
|
|
&& !valid_global_thread_id (bl->owner->thread))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
|
|
|
|
/* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
|
|
to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
|
|
if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
|
|
insert breakpoints. */
|
|
if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
|
|
&& (inferior_ptid == null_ptid || !target_has_execution))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
val = insert_bp_location (bl, &tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
|
|
&hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_error_explained_already);
|
|
if (val)
|
|
error_flag = val;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint, remove
|
|
them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use. */
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
|
|
{
|
|
int some_failed = 0;
|
|
struct bp_location *loc;
|
|
|
|
if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if (bpt->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
|
|
if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
|
|
{
|
|
some_failed = 1;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
if (some_failed)
|
|
{
|
|
for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
|
|
if (loc->inserted)
|
|
remove_breakpoint (loc);
|
|
|
|
hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
|
|
tmp_error_stream.printf ("Could not insert "
|
|
"hardware watchpoint %d.\n",
|
|
bpt->number);
|
|
error_flag = -1;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (error_flag)
|
|
{
|
|
/* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a
|
|
message about possibly exhausted resources. */
|
|
if (hw_breakpoint_error && !hw_bp_error_explained_already)
|
|
{
|
|
tmp_error_stream.printf ("Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\
|
|
You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n");
|
|
}
|
|
target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
|
|
error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Used when the program stops.
|
|
Returns zero if successful, or non-zero if there was a problem
|
|
removing a breakpoint location. */
|
|
|
|
int
|
|
remove_breakpoints (void)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
|
|
int val = 0;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
|
|
{
|
|
if (bl->inserted && !is_tracepoint (bl->owner))
|
|
val |= remove_breakpoint (bl);
|
|
}
|
|
return val;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* When a thread exits, remove breakpoints that are related to
|
|
that thread. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
remove_threaded_breakpoints (struct thread_info *tp, int silent)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
|
|
{
|
|
if (b->thread == tp->global_num && user_breakpoint_p (b))
|
|
{
|
|
b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
|
|
|
|
printf_filtered (_("\
|
|
Thread-specific breakpoint %d deleted - thread %s no longer in the thread list.\n"),
|
|
b->number, print_thread_id (tp));
|
|
|
|
/* Hide it from the user. */
|
|
b->number = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* See breakpoint.h. */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
remove_breakpoints_inf (inferior *inf)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
|
|
int val;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
|
|
{
|
|
if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if (bl->inserted && !bl->target_info.persist)
|
|
{
|
|
val = remove_breakpoint (bl);
|
|
if (val != 0)
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1;
|
|
|
|
/* Set the breakpoint number of B, depending on the value of INTERNAL.
|
|
If INTERNAL is non-zero, the breakpoint number will be populated
|
|
from internal_breakpoint_number and that variable decremented.
|
|
Otherwise the breakpoint number will be populated from
|
|
breakpoint_count and that value incremented. Internal breakpoints
|
|
do not set the internal var bpnum. */
|
|
static void
|
|
set_breakpoint_number (int internal, struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
if (internal)
|
|
b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
|
|
b->number = breakpoint_count;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static struct breakpoint *
|
|
create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
|
|
CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type,
|
|
const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
|
|
{
|
|
symtab_and_line sal;
|
|
sal.pc = address;
|
|
sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
|
|
sal.pspace = current_program_space;
|
|
|
|
breakpoint *b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
|
|
b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
|
|
b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
|
|
|
|
return b;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static const char *const longjmp_names[] =
|
|
{
|
|
"longjmp", "_longjmp", "siglongjmp", "_siglongjmp"
|
|
};
|
|
#define NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES ARRAY_SIZE(longjmp_names)
|
|
|
|
/* Per-objfile data private to breakpoint.c. */
|
|
struct breakpoint_objfile_data
|
|
{
|
|
/* Minimal symbol for "_ovly_debug_event" (if any). */
|
|
struct bound_minimal_symbol overlay_msym {};
|
|
|
|
/* Minimal symbol(s) for "longjmp", "siglongjmp", etc. (if any). */
|
|
struct bound_minimal_symbol longjmp_msym[NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES] {};
|
|
|
|
/* True if we have looked for longjmp probes. */
|
|
int longjmp_searched = 0;
|
|
|
|
/* SystemTap probe points for longjmp (if any). These are non-owning
|
|
references. */
|
|
std::vector<probe *> longjmp_probes;
|
|
|
|
/* Minimal symbol for "std::terminate()" (if any). */
|
|
struct bound_minimal_symbol terminate_msym {};
|
|
|
|
/* Minimal symbol for "_Unwind_DebugHook" (if any). */
|
|
struct bound_minimal_symbol exception_msym {};
|
|
|
|
/* True if we have looked for exception probes. */
|
|
int exception_searched = 0;
|
|
|
|
/* SystemTap probe points for unwinding (if any). These are non-owning
|
|
references. */
|
|
std::vector<probe *> exception_probes;
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
static const struct objfile_key<breakpoint_objfile_data>
|
|
breakpoint_objfile_key;
|
|
|
|
/* Minimal symbol not found sentinel. */
|
|
static struct minimal_symbol msym_not_found;
|
|
|
|
/* Returns TRUE if MSYM point to the "not found" sentinel. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
msym_not_found_p (const struct minimal_symbol *msym)
|
|
{
|
|
return msym == &msym_not_found;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Return per-objfile data needed by breakpoint.c.
|
|
Allocate the data if necessary. */
|
|
|
|
static struct breakpoint_objfile_data *
|
|
get_breakpoint_objfile_data (struct objfile *objfile)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
|
|
|
|
bp_objfile_data = breakpoint_objfile_key.get (objfile);
|
|
if (bp_objfile_data == NULL)
|
|
bp_objfile_data = breakpoint_objfile_key.emplace (objfile);
|
|
return bp_objfile_data;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
create_overlay_event_breakpoint (void)
|
|
{
|
|
const char *const func_name = "_ovly_debug_event";
|
|
|
|
for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
|
|
CORE_ADDR addr;
|
|
struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
|
|
|
|
bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
|
|
|
|
if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
|
|
|
|
m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
|
|
if (m.minsym == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Avoid future lookups in this objfile. */
|
|
bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym = m;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym);
|
|
b = create_internal_breakpoint (objfile->arch (), addr,
|
|
bp_overlay_event,
|
|
&internal_breakpoint_ops);
|
|
initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
|
|
explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
|
|
b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
|
|
|
|
if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto)
|
|
{
|
|
b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
|
|
overlay_events_enabled = 1;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
|
|
overlay_events_enabled = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (void)
|
|
{
|
|
scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
|
|
|
|
for (struct program_space *pspace : program_spaces)
|
|
{
|
|
set_current_program_space (pspace);
|
|
|
|
for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
|
|
{
|
|
int i;
|
|
struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
|
|
struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
|
|
|
|
gdbarch = objfile->arch ();
|
|
|
|
bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
|
|
|
|
if (!bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched)
|
|
{
|
|
std::vector<probe *> ret
|
|
= find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libc", "longjmp");
|
|
|
|
if (!ret.empty ())
|
|
{
|
|
/* We are only interested in checking one element. */
|
|
probe *p = ret[0];
|
|
|
|
if (!p->can_evaluate_arguments ())
|
|
{
|
|
/* We cannot use the probe interface here,
|
|
because it does not know how to evaluate
|
|
arguments. */
|
|
ret.clear ();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes = ret;
|
|
bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched = 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes.empty ())
|
|
{
|
|
for (probe *p : bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
|
|
b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
|
|
p->get_relocated_address (objfile),
|
|
bp_longjmp_master,
|
|
&internal_breakpoint_ops);
|
|
b->location = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libc:longjmp");
|
|
b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (gdbarch))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
for (i = 0; i < NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
const char *func_name;
|
|
CORE_ADDR addr;
|
|
struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
|
|
|
|
if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
func_name = longjmp_names[i];
|
|
if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
|
|
|
|
m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
|
|
if (m.minsym == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
|
|
bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym = &msym_not_found;
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i] = m;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i]);
|
|
b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_longjmp_master,
|
|
&internal_breakpoint_ops);
|
|
initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
|
|
explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
|
|
b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
|
|
b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Create a master std::terminate breakpoint. */
|
|
static void
|
|
create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint (void)
|
|
{
|
|
const char *const func_name = "std::terminate()";
|
|
|
|
scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
|
|
|
|
for (struct program_space *pspace : program_spaces)
|
|
{
|
|
CORE_ADDR addr;
|
|
|
|
set_current_program_space (pspace);
|
|
|
|
for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
|
|
struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
|
|
|
|
bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
|
|
|
|
if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
|
|
|
|
m = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
|
|
if (m.minsym == NULL || (MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_text
|
|
&& MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_file_text))
|
|
{
|
|
/* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
|
|
bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym = m;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym);
|
|
b = create_internal_breakpoint (objfile->arch (), addr,
|
|
bp_std_terminate_master,
|
|
&internal_breakpoint_ops);
|
|
initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
|
|
explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
|
|
b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
|
|
b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
create_exception_master_breakpoint (void)
|
|
{
|
|
const char *const func_name = "_Unwind_DebugHook";
|
|
|
|
for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
|
|
struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
|
|
CORE_ADDR addr;
|
|
struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
|
|
|
|
bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
|
|
|
|
/* We prefer the SystemTap probe point if it exists. */
|
|
if (!bp_objfile_data->exception_searched)
|
|
{
|
|
std::vector<probe *> ret
|
|
= find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libgcc", "unwind");
|
|
|
|
if (!ret.empty ())
|
|
{
|
|
/* We are only interested in checking one element. */
|
|
probe *p = ret[0];
|
|
|
|
if (!p->can_evaluate_arguments ())
|
|
{
|
|
/* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does
|
|
not know how to evaluate arguments. */
|
|
ret.clear ();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
bp_objfile_data->exception_probes = ret;
|
|
bp_objfile_data->exception_searched = 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!bp_objfile_data->exception_probes.empty ())
|
|
{
|
|
gdbarch = objfile->arch ();
|
|
|
|
for (probe *p : bp_objfile_data->exception_probes)
|
|
{
|
|
b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
|
|
p->get_relocated_address (objfile),
|
|
bp_exception_master,
|
|
&internal_breakpoint_ops);
|
|
b->location = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libgcc:unwind");
|
|
b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Otherwise, try the hook function. */
|
|
|
|
if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
gdbarch = objfile->arch ();
|
|
|
|
if (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bound_minimal_symbol debug_hook;
|
|
|
|
debug_hook = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
|
|
if (debug_hook.minsym == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bp_objfile_data->exception_msym = debug_hook;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym);
|
|
addr = gdbarch_convert_from_func_ptr_addr (gdbarch, addr,
|
|
current_top_target ());
|
|
b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_exception_master,
|
|
&internal_breakpoint_ops);
|
|
initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
|
|
explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
|
|
b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
|
|
b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Does B have a location spec? */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (const struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
return b->location != NULL && event_location_empty_p (b->location.get ());
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
update_breakpoints_after_exec (void)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
|
|
struct bp_location *bploc, **bplocp_tmp;
|
|
|
|
/* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists. If the
|
|
INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by
|
|
writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory. The
|
|
"shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not
|
|
do that. Instead, the target is responsible from marking
|
|
breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec. We don't do that
|
|
here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete
|
|
breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here. */
|
|
ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bploc, bplocp_tmp)
|
|
if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space)
|
|
gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted);
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
|
|
{
|
|
if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
|
|
if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
|
|
{
|
|
delete_breakpoint (b);
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
|
|
if (b->type == bp_jit_event)
|
|
{
|
|
delete_breakpoint (b);
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(),
|
|
as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints. */
|
|
if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
|
|
|| b->type == bp_longjmp_master || b->type == bp_std_terminate_master
|
|
|| b->type == bp_exception_master)
|
|
{
|
|
delete_breakpoint (b);
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */
|
|
if (b->type == bp_step_resume || b->type == bp_hp_step_resume)
|
|
{
|
|
delete_breakpoint (b);
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Just like single-step breakpoints. */
|
|
if (b->type == bp_single_step)
|
|
{
|
|
delete_breakpoint (b);
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless
|
|
after an exec. */
|
|
if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_longjmp_resume
|
|
|| b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy
|
|
|| b->type == bp_exception || b->type == bp_exception_resume)
|
|
{
|
|
delete_breakpoint (b);
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
|
|
{
|
|
/* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to
|
|
do anything at this point. In the future, if some of
|
|
the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add
|
|
a new method, and call this method from here. */
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* bp_finish is a special case. The only way we ought to be able
|
|
to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user
|
|
caught a vfork, and then said "finish". Ordinarily a finish just
|
|
carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting
|
|
a temporary bp there and resuming. But in this case, the finish
|
|
will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec.
|
|
|
|
We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now. But
|
|
we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to
|
|
the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it. There's a
|
|
chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish
|
|
here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command
|
|
gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint.
|
|
We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish.
|
|
|
|
In the absence of a general solution for the "how do we know
|
|
it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?"
|
|
problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and
|
|
let finish_command delete it.
|
|
|
|
(We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's
|
|
momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees
|
|
the inferior stopped. So it doesn't matter that the bp's
|
|
address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the
|
|
solib breakpoints.) */
|
|
|
|
if (b->type == bp_finish)
|
|
{
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the
|
|
pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec()
|
|
a.out. */
|
|
if (breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (b))
|
|
{
|
|
delete_breakpoint (b);
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
int
|
|
detach_breakpoints (ptid_t ptid)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
|
|
int val = 0;
|
|
scoped_restore save_inferior_ptid = make_scoped_restore (&inferior_ptid);
|
|
struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
|
|
|
|
if (ptid.pid () == inferior_ptid.pid ())
|
|
error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid"));
|
|
|
|
/* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global. */
|
|
inferior_ptid = ptid;
|
|
ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
|
|
{
|
|
if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* This function must physically remove breakpoints locations
|
|
from the specified ptid, without modifying the breakpoint
|
|
package's state. Locations of type bp_loc_other are only
|
|
maintained at GDB side. So, there is no need to remove
|
|
these bp_loc_other locations. Moreover, removing these
|
|
would modify the breakpoint package's state. */
|
|
if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_other)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if (bl->inserted)
|
|
val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return val;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Remove the breakpoint location BL from the current address space.
|
|
Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork.
|
|
When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither
|
|
do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should
|
|
*not* look at bl->pspace->aspace here. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
|
|
{
|
|
int val;
|
|
|
|
/* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
|
|
gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
|
|
|
|
/* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
|
|
This should not ever happen. */
|
|
gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
|
|
|
|
if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
|
|
|| bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
|
|
{
|
|
/* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard
|
|
trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a
|
|
bp_hardware_breakpoint. */
|
|
|
|
/* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
|
|
if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
|
|
|| bl->section == NULL
|
|
|| !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
|
|
{
|
|
/* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint. */
|
|
|
|
/* If we're trying to uninsert a memory breakpoint that we
|
|
know is set in a dynamic object that is marked
|
|
shlib_disabled, then either the dynamic object was
|
|
removed with "remove-symbol-file" or with
|
|
"nosharedlibrary". In the former case, we don't know
|
|
whether another dynamic object might have loaded over the
|
|
breakpoint's address -- the user might well let us know
|
|
about it next with add-symbol-file (the whole point of
|
|
add-symbol-file is letting the user manually maintain a
|
|
list of dynamically loaded objects). If we have the
|
|
breakpoint's shadow memory, that is, this is a software
|
|
breakpoint managed by GDB, check whether the breakpoint
|
|
is still inserted in memory, to avoid overwriting wrong
|
|
code with stale saved shadow contents. Note that HW
|
|
breakpoints don't have shadow memory, as they're
|
|
implemented using a mechanism that is not dependent on
|
|
being able to modify the target's memory, and as such
|
|
they should always be removed. */
|
|
if (bl->shlib_disabled
|
|
&& bl->target_info.shadow_len != 0
|
|
&& !memory_validate_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info))
|
|
val = 0;
|
|
else
|
|
val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
|
|
Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
|
|
if (!overlay_events_enabled)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we
|
|
should have set a breakpoint at the LMA. Remove it.
|
|
*/
|
|
/* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will
|
|
have already warned when we failed to insert it. */
|
|
if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
|
|
target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
|
|
&bl->overlay_target_info);
|
|
else
|
|
target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
|
|
&bl->overlay_target_info,
|
|
reason);
|
|
}
|
|
/* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA?
|
|
If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'. */
|
|
if (bl->inserted)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Yes -- remove it. Previously we did not bother to
|
|
remove the breakpoint if the section had been
|
|
unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe. We
|
|
don't know what the overlay manager might do. */
|
|
|
|
/* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only
|
|
if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite
|
|
wrong code with the saved shadow contents. */
|
|
if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
|
|
|| section_is_mapped (bl->section))
|
|
val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
|
|
else
|
|
val = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove. No error. */
|
|
val = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint in
|
|
a shared library that has already been removed, but we have
|
|
not yet processed the shlib unload event. Similarly for an
|
|
unloaded add-symbol-file object - the user might not yet have
|
|
had the chance to remove-symbol-file it. shlib_disabled will
|
|
be set if the library/object has already been removed, but
|
|
the breakpoint hasn't been uninserted yet, e.g., after
|
|
"nosharedlibrary" or "remove-symbol-file" with breakpoints
|
|
always-inserted mode. */
|
|
if (val
|
|
&& (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
|
|
&& (bl->shlib_disabled
|
|
|| solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
|
|
|| shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
|
|
bl->address))))
|
|
val = 0;
|
|
|
|
if (val)
|
|
return val;
|
|
bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
|
|
}
|
|
else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
|
|
{
|
|
gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
|
|
&& bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
|
|
|
|
bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
|
|
bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
|
|
|
|
/* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here. */
|
|
if (reason == REMOVE_BREAKPOINT && bl->inserted)
|
|
warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."),
|
|
bl->owner->number);
|
|
}
|
|
else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint
|
|
&& breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
|
|
&& !bl->duplicate)
|
|
{
|
|
gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
|
|
&& bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
|
|
|
|
val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
|
|
if (val)
|
|
return val;
|
|
|
|
bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
|
|
{
|
|
/* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
|
|
gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
|
|
|
|
/* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
|
|
This should not ever happen. */
|
|
gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
|
|
|
|
scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
|
|
|
|
switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
|
|
|
|
return remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, REMOVE_BREAKPOINT);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints. */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
mark_breakpoints_out (void)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
|
|
if (bl->pspace == current_program_space)
|
|
bl->inserted = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any
|
|
breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program.
|
|
|
|
Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints
|
|
between runs.
|
|
|
|
Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by
|
|
generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by
|
|
init_wait_for_inferior). */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
|
|
struct program_space *pspace = current_program_space;
|
|
|
|
/* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's
|
|
nothing to do. */
|
|
if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
mark_breakpoints_out ();
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
|
|
{
|
|
if (b->loc && b->loc->pspace != pspace)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
switch (b->type)
|
|
{
|
|
case bp_call_dummy:
|
|
case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
|
|
|
|
/* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will
|
|
cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better get
|
|
rid of it. */
|
|
|
|
case bp_watchpoint_scope:
|
|
|
|
/* Also get rid of scope breakpoints. */
|
|
|
|
case bp_shlib_event:
|
|
|
|
/* Also remove solib event breakpoints. Their addresses may
|
|
have changed since the last time we ran the program.
|
|
Actually we may now be debugging against different target;
|
|
and so the solib backend that installed this breakpoint may
|
|
not be used in by the target. E.g.,
|
|
|
|
(gdb) file prog-linux
|
|
(gdb) run # native linux target
|
|
...
|
|
(gdb) kill
|
|
(gdb) file prog-win.exe
|
|
(gdb) tar rem :9999 # remote Windows gdbserver.
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
case bp_step_resume:
|
|
|
|
/* Also remove step-resume breakpoints. */
|
|
|
|
case bp_single_step:
|
|
|
|
/* Also remove single-step breakpoints. */
|
|
|
|
delete_breakpoint (b);
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case bp_watchpoint:
|
|
case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
|
|
case bp_read_watchpoint:
|
|
case bp_access_watchpoint:
|
|
{
|
|
struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
|
|
|
|
/* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions. */
|
|
if (w->exp_valid_block != NULL)
|
|
delete_breakpoint (b);
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* Get rid of existing locations, which are no longer
|
|
valid. New ones will be created in
|
|
update_watchpoint, when the inferior is restarted.
|
|
The next update_global_location_list call will
|
|
garbage collect them. */
|
|
b->loc = NULL;
|
|
|
|
if (context == inf_starting)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Reset val field to force reread of starting value in
|
|
insert_breakpoints. */
|
|
w->val.reset (nullptr);
|
|
w->val_valid = false;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
default:
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Get rid of the moribund locations. */
|
|
for (bp_location *bl : moribund_locations)
|
|
decref_bp_location (&bl);
|
|
moribund_locations.clear ();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the
|
|
target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if
|
|
we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space
|
|
match, not program space. */
|
|
|
|
/* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint
|
|
exists at PC. It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an
|
|
ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a
|
|
permanent breakpoint.
|
|
- When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we
|
|
actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints.
|
|
- When continuing from a location with a permanent breakpoint, we
|
|
need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by
|
|
the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint. */
|
|
|
|
enum breakpoint_here
|
|
breakpoint_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
|
|
int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
|
|
{
|
|
if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
|
|
&& bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
|
|
if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
|
|
|| bl->permanent)
|
|
&& breakpoint_location_address_match (bl, aspace, pc))
|
|
{
|
|
if (overlay_debugging
|
|
&& section_is_overlay (bl->section)
|
|
&& !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
|
|
continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
|
|
else if (bl->permanent)
|
|
return permanent_breakpoint_here;
|
|
else
|
|
any_breakpoint_here = 1;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : no_breakpoint_here;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* See breakpoint.h. */
|
|
|
|
int
|
|
breakpoint_in_range_p (const address_space *aspace,
|
|
CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
|
|
{
|
|
if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
|
|
&& bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
|
|
|| bl->permanent)
|
|
&& breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (bl, aspace,
|
|
addr, len))
|
|
{
|
|
if (overlay_debugging
|
|
&& section_is_overlay (bl->section)
|
|
&& !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
|
|
{
|
|
/* Unmapped overlay -- can't be a match. */
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC. */
|
|
|
|
int
|
|
moribund_breakpoint_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
|
|
{
|
|
for (bp_location *loc : moribund_locations)
|
|
if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
|
|
return 1;
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Returns non-zero iff BL is inserted at PC, in address space
|
|
ASPACE. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
bp_location_inserted_here_p (struct bp_location *bl,
|
|
const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
|
|
{
|
|
if (bl->inserted
|
|
&& breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
|
|
aspace, pc))
|
|
{
|
|
if (overlay_debugging
|
|
&& section_is_overlay (bl->section)
|
|
&& !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
|
|
return 0; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
|
|
else
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Returns non-zero iff there's a breakpoint inserted at PC. */
|
|
|
|
int
|
|
breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
|
|
|
|
if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
|
|
&& bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint
|
|
inserted at PC. */
|
|
|
|
int
|
|
software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
|
|
CORE_ADDR pc)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
|
|
|
|
if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* See breakpoint.h. */
|
|
|
|
int
|
|
hardware_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
|
|
CORE_ADDR pc)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
|
|
|
|
if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
int
|
|
hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (const address_space *aspace,
|
|
CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *bpt;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *loc;
|
|
|
|
if (bpt->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
|
|
&& bpt->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
|
|
if (loc->pspace->aspace == aspace && loc->inserted)
|
|
{
|
|
CORE_ADDR l, h;
|
|
|
|
/* Check for intersection. */
|
|
l = std::max<CORE_ADDR> (loc->address, addr);
|
|
h = std::min<CORE_ADDR> (loc->address + loc->length, addr + len);
|
|
if (l < h)
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* See breakpoint.h. */
|
|
|
|
bool
|
|
is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
return (b->type == bp_catchpoint);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Frees any storage that is part of a bpstat. Does not walk the
|
|
'next' chain. */
|
|
|
|
bpstats::~bpstats ()
|
|
{
|
|
if (bp_location_at != NULL)
|
|
decref_bp_location (&bp_location_at);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint.
|
|
Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat. */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
bpstat_clear (bpstat *bsp)
|
|
{
|
|
bpstat p;
|
|
bpstat q;
|
|
|
|
if (bsp == 0)
|
|
return;
|
|
p = *bsp;
|
|
while (p != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
q = p->next;
|
|
delete p;
|
|
p = q;
|
|
}
|
|
*bsp = NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bpstats::bpstats (const bpstats &other)
|
|
: next (NULL),
|
|
bp_location_at (other.bp_location_at),
|
|
breakpoint_at (other.breakpoint_at),
|
|
commands (other.commands),
|
|
print (other.print),
|
|
stop (other.stop),
|
|
print_it (other.print_it)
|
|
{
|
|
if (other.old_val != NULL)
|
|
old_val = release_value (value_copy (other.old_val.get ()));
|
|
incref_bp_location (bp_location_at);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Return a copy of a bpstat. Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that
|
|
is part of the bpstat is copied as well. */
|
|
|
|
bpstat
|
|
bpstat_copy (bpstat bs)
|
|
{
|
|
bpstat p = NULL;
|
|
bpstat tmp;
|
|
bpstat retval = NULL;
|
|
|
|
if (bs == NULL)
|
|
return bs;
|
|
|
|
for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
|
|
{
|
|
tmp = new bpstats (*bs);
|
|
|
|
if (p == NULL)
|
|
/* This is the first thing in the chain. */
|
|
retval = tmp;
|
|
else
|
|
p->next = tmp;
|
|
p = tmp;
|
|
}
|
|
p->next = NULL;
|
|
return retval;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint. */
|
|
|
|
bpstat
|
|
bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint)
|
|
{
|
|
if (bsp == NULL)
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
|
|
for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
|
|
{
|
|
if (bsp->breakpoint_at == breakpoint)
|
|
return bsp;
|
|
}
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* See breakpoint.h. */
|
|
|
|
bool
|
|
bpstat_explains_signal (bpstat bsp, enum gdb_signal sig)
|
|
{
|
|
for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
|
|
{
|
|
if (bsp->breakpoint_at == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
/* A moribund location can never explain a signal other than
|
|
GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
|
|
if (sig == GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
if (bsp->breakpoint_at->ops->explains_signal (bsp->breakpoint_at,
|
|
sig))
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are
|
|
stopped at. *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the
|
|
remaining breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be
|
|
good for anything but further calls to bpstat_num).
|
|
|
|
Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints.
|
|
Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since
|
|
we set it.
|
|
Return 1 otherwise. */
|
|
|
|
int
|
|
bpstat_num (bpstat *bsp, int *num)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
|
|
if ((*bsp) == NULL)
|
|
return 0; /* No more breakpoint values */
|
|
|
|
/* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that correspond to a
|
|
single breakpoint -- otherwise, this function might return the
|
|
same number more than once and this will look ugly. */
|
|
b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at;
|
|
*bsp = (*bsp)->next;
|
|
if (b == NULL)
|
|
return -1; /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */
|
|
|
|
*num = b->number; /* We have its number */
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* See breakpoint.h. */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
bpstat_clear_actions (void)
|
|
{
|
|
bpstat bs;
|
|
|
|
if (inferior_ptid == null_ptid)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
|
|
for (bs = tp->control.stop_bpstat; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
|
|
{
|
|
bs->commands = NULL;
|
|
bs->old_val.reset (nullptr);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void)
|
|
{
|
|
if (inferior_ptid != null_ptid)
|
|
{
|
|
struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
|
|
|
|
/* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not
|
|
interrupt the command list. When the call finishes
|
|
successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same
|
|
breakpoint as if nothing happened. */
|
|
if (tp->control.in_infcall)
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
breakpoint_proceeded = 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Return non-zero iff CMD as the first line of a command sequence is `silent'
|
|
or its equivalent. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
command_line_is_silent (struct command_line *cmd)
|
|
{
|
|
return cmd && (strcmp ("silent", cmd->line) == 0);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at
|
|
this location. Any of these commands could cause the process to
|
|
proceed beyond this point, etc. We look out for such changes by
|
|
checking the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command.
|
|
|
|
Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior. In that
|
|
case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the
|
|
bpstat of the current thread. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat *bsp)
|
|
{
|
|
bpstat bs;
|
|
int again = 0;
|
|
|
|
/* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained
|
|
in bs->commands. */
|
|
if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
scoped_restore save_executing
|
|
= make_scoped_restore (&executing_breakpoint_commands, 1);
|
|
|
|
scoped_restore preventer = prevent_dont_repeat ();
|
|
|
|
/* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */
|
|
bs = *bsp;
|
|
|
|
breakpoint_proceeded = 0;
|
|
for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
|
|
{
|
|
struct command_line *cmd = NULL;
|
|
|
|
/* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one.
|
|
|
|
The command tree could legitimately contain commands like
|
|
'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which
|
|
frees stop_bpstat's command tree. To make sure this doesn't
|
|
free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to
|
|
take ownership of the tree ourselves. Since a given bpstat's
|
|
commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we
|
|
can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free
|
|
the tree when we're done. */
|
|
counted_command_line ccmd = bs->commands;
|
|
bs->commands = NULL;
|
|
if (ccmd != NULL)
|
|
cmd = ccmd.get ();
|
|
if (command_line_is_silent (cmd))
|
|
{
|
|
/* The action has been already done by bpstat_stop_status. */
|
|
cmd = cmd->next;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
while (cmd != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
execute_control_command (cmd);
|
|
|
|
if (breakpoint_proceeded)
|
|
break;
|
|
else
|
|
cmd = cmd->next;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (breakpoint_proceeded)
|
|
{
|
|
if (current_ui->async)
|
|
/* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still
|
|
running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for
|
|
us to do here -- just return to the event loop. */
|
|
;
|
|
else
|
|
/* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns
|
|
we're already standing on the next breakpoint.
|
|
Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since
|
|
execute_command does not run breakpoint commands --
|
|
only command_line_handler does, but that one is not
|
|
involved in execution of breakpoint commands. So, we
|
|
can now execute breakpoint commands. It should be
|
|
noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is
|
|
not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive
|
|
invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a
|
|
command, and can easily blow up GDB stack. Instead, we
|
|
return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us
|
|
with the new stop_bpstat. */
|
|
again = 1;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
return again;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Helper for bpstat_do_actions. Get the current thread, if there's
|
|
one, is alive and has execution. Return NULL otherwise. */
|
|
|
|
static thread_info *
|
|
get_bpstat_thread ()
|
|
{
|
|
if (inferior_ptid == null_ptid || !target_has_execution)
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
|
|
thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
|
|
if (tp->state == THREAD_EXITED || tp->executing)
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
return tp;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
bpstat_do_actions (void)
|
|
{
|
|
auto cleanup_if_error = make_scope_exit (bpstat_clear_actions);
|
|
thread_info *tp;
|
|
|
|
/* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at. */
|
|
while ((tp = get_bpstat_thread ()) != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the
|
|
inferior, and only return when it is stopped at the next
|
|
breakpoint, we keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns
|
|
false to indicate the inferior was not resumed. */
|
|
if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&tp->control.stop_bpstat))
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
cleanup_if_error.release ();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream)
|
|
{
|
|
if (val == NULL)
|
|
fprintf_styled (stream, metadata_style.style (), _("<unreadable>"));
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
struct value_print_options opts;
|
|
get_user_print_options (&opts);
|
|
value_print (val, stream, &opts);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Print the "Thread ID hit" part of "Thread ID hit Breakpoint N" if
|
|
debugging multiple threads. */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (struct ui_out *uiout)
|
|
{
|
|
if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
uiout->text ("\n");
|
|
|
|
if (show_thread_that_caused_stop ())
|
|
{
|
|
const char *name;
|
|
struct thread_info *thr = inferior_thread ();
|
|
|
|
uiout->text ("Thread ");
|
|
uiout->field_string ("thread-id", print_thread_id (thr));
|
|
|
|
name = thr->name != NULL ? thr->name : target_thread_name (thr);
|
|
if (name != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
uiout->text (" \"");
|
|
uiout->field_string ("name", name);
|
|
uiout->text ("\"");
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
uiout->text (" hit ");
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we
|
|
stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value
|
|
'print_it' in the bpstat structure. Under some circumstances we
|
|
may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to
|
|
normal_stop(). */
|
|
|
|
static enum print_stop_action
|
|
print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs)
|
|
{
|
|
switch (bs->print_it)
|
|
{
|
|
case print_it_noop:
|
|
/* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */
|
|
return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case print_it_done:
|
|
/* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the
|
|
relevant messages. */
|
|
return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case print_it_normal:
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
|
|
|
|
/* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint
|
|
which has since been deleted. */
|
|
if (b == NULL)
|
|
return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
|
|
|
|
/* Normal case. Call the breakpoint's print_it method. */
|
|
return b->ops->print_it (bs);
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
|
|
_("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value"));
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* A helper function that prints a shared library stopped event. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
print_solib_event (int is_catchpoint)
|
|
{
|
|
bool any_deleted = !current_program_space->deleted_solibs.empty ();
|
|
bool any_added = !current_program_space->added_solibs.empty ();
|
|
|
|
if (!is_catchpoint)
|
|
{
|
|
if (any_added || any_deleted)
|
|
current_uiout->text (_("Stopped due to shared library event:\n"));
|
|
else
|
|
current_uiout->text (_("Stopped due to shared library event (no "
|
|
"libraries added or removed)\n"));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
|
|
current_uiout->field_string ("reason",
|
|
async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_SOLIB_EVENT));
|
|
|
|
if (any_deleted)
|
|
{
|
|
current_uiout->text (_(" Inferior unloaded "));
|
|
ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (current_uiout, "removed");
|
|
for (int ix = 0; ix < current_program_space->deleted_solibs.size (); ix++)
|
|
{
|
|
const std::string &name = current_program_space->deleted_solibs[ix];
|
|
|
|
if (ix > 0)
|
|
current_uiout->text (" ");
|
|
current_uiout->field_string ("library", name);
|
|
current_uiout->text ("\n");
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (any_added)
|
|
{
|
|
current_uiout->text (_(" Inferior loaded "));
|
|
ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (current_uiout, "added");
|
|
bool first = true;
|
|
for (so_list *iter : current_program_space->added_solibs)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!first)
|
|
current_uiout->text (" ");
|
|
first = false;
|
|
current_uiout->field_string ("library", iter->so_name);
|
|
current_uiout->text ("\n");
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Print a message indicating what happened. This is called from
|
|
normal_stop(). The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat
|
|
list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop. KIND is
|
|
the target_waitkind for the stopping event. This
|
|
routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message
|
|
about reasons for stopping. This will print (for example) the
|
|
"Breakpoint n," part of the output. The return value of this
|
|
routine is one of:
|
|
|
|
PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing.
|
|
PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent
|
|
code to print the location. An example is
|
|
"Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by
|
|
the location.
|
|
PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need
|
|
to also print the location part of the message.
|
|
An example is the catch/throw messages, which
|
|
don't require a location appended to the end.
|
|
PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any
|
|
further info to be printed. */
|
|
|
|
enum print_stop_action
|
|
bpstat_print (bpstat bs, int kind)
|
|
{
|
|
enum print_stop_action val;
|
|
|
|
/* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop.
|
|
(Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not.
|
|
That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken
|
|
with respect to bpstat_explains_signal). */
|
|
for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
|
|
{
|
|
val = print_bp_stop_message (bs);
|
|
if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY
|
|
|| val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
|
|
|| val == PRINT_NOTHING)
|
|
return val;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If we had hit a shared library event breakpoint,
|
|
print_bp_stop_message would print out this message. If we hit an
|
|
OS-level shared library event, do the same thing. */
|
|
if (kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
|
|
{
|
|
print_solib_event (0);
|
|
return PRINT_NOTHING;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start
|
|
with and nothing was printed. */
|
|
return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Evaluate the boolean expression EXP and return the result. */
|
|
|
|
static bool
|
|
breakpoint_cond_eval (expression *exp)
|
|
{
|
|
struct value *mark = value_mark ();
|
|
bool res = value_true (evaluate_expression (exp));
|
|
|
|
value_free_to_mark (mark);
|
|
return res;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Allocate a new bpstat. Link it to the FIFO list by BS_LINK_POINTER. */
|
|
|
|
bpstats::bpstats (struct bp_location *bl, bpstat **bs_link_pointer)
|
|
: next (NULL),
|
|
bp_location_at (bl),
|
|
breakpoint_at (bl->owner),
|
|
commands (NULL),
|
|
print (0),
|
|
stop (0),
|
|
print_it (print_it_normal)
|
|
{
|
|
incref_bp_location (bl);
|
|
**bs_link_pointer = this;
|
|
*bs_link_pointer = &next;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bpstats::bpstats ()
|
|
: next (NULL),
|
|
bp_location_at (NULL),
|
|
breakpoint_at (NULL),
|
|
commands (NULL),
|
|
print (0),
|
|
stop (0),
|
|
print_it (print_it_normal)
|
|
{
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS. Check if any hardware
|
|
watchpoints have triggered, according to the target. */
|
|
|
|
int
|
|
watchpoints_triggered (struct target_waitstatus *ws)
|
|
{
|
|
bool stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint ();
|
|
CORE_ADDR addr;
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
|
|
if (!stopped_by_watchpoint)
|
|
{
|
|
/* We were not stopped by a watchpoint. Mark all watchpoints
|
|
as not triggered. */
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
|
|
if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
|
|
{
|
|
struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
|
|
|
|
w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!target_stopped_data_address (current_top_target (), &addr))
|
|
{
|
|
/* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where.
|
|
Mark all watchpoints as unknown. */
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
|
|
if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
|
|
{
|
|
struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
|
|
|
|
w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* The target could report the data address. Mark watchpoints
|
|
affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not
|
|
triggered. */
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
|
|
if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
|
|
{
|
|
struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
|
|
struct bp_location *loc;
|
|
|
|
w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
|
|
for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
|
|
{
|
|
if (is_masked_watchpoint (b))
|
|
{
|
|
CORE_ADDR newaddr = addr & w->hw_wp_mask;
|
|
CORE_ADDR start = loc->address & w->hw_wp_mask;
|
|
|
|
if (newaddr == start)
|
|
{
|
|
w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
/* Exact match not required. Within range is sufficient. */
|
|
else if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range (current_top_target (),
|
|
addr, loc->address,
|
|
loc->length))
|
|
{
|
|
w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Possible return values for watchpoint_check. */
|
|
enum wp_check_result
|
|
{
|
|
/* The watchpoint has been deleted. */
|
|
WP_DELETED = 1,
|
|
|
|
/* The value has changed. */
|
|
WP_VALUE_CHANGED = 2,
|
|
|
|
/* The value has not changed. */
|
|
WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED = 3,
|
|
|
|
/* Ignore this watchpoint, no matter if the value changed or not. */
|
|
WP_IGNORE = 4,
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
#define BP_TEMPFLAG 1
|
|
#define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2
|
|
|
|
/* Evaluate watchpoint condition expression and check if its value
|
|
changed. */
|
|
|
|
static wp_check_result
|
|
watchpoint_check (bpstat bs)
|
|
{
|
|
struct watchpoint *b;
|
|
struct frame_info *fr;
|
|
int within_current_scope;
|
|
|
|
/* BS is built from an existing struct breakpoint. */
|
|
gdb_assert (bs->breakpoint_at != NULL);
|
|
b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
|
|
|
|
/* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
|
|
watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
|
|
that was used to create the watchpoint. */
|
|
if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
|
|
return WP_IGNORE;
|
|
|
|
if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
|
|
within_current_scope = 1;
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
|
|
struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame);
|
|
CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame);
|
|
|
|
/* stack_frame_destroyed_p() returns a non-zero value if we're
|
|
still in the function but the stack frame has already been
|
|
invalidated. Since we can't rely on the values of local
|
|
variables after the stack has been destroyed, we are treating
|
|
the watchpoint in that state as `not changed' without further
|
|
checking. Don't mark watchpoints as changed if the current
|
|
frame is in an epilogue - even if they are in some other
|
|
frame, our view of the stack is likely to be wrong and
|
|
frame_find_by_id could error out. */
|
|
if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
|
|
return WP_IGNORE;
|
|
|
|
fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
|
|
within_current_scope = (fr != NULL);
|
|
|
|
/* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have
|
|
returned a frame that can't describe this variable. */
|
|
if (within_current_scope)
|
|
{
|
|
struct symbol *function;
|
|
|
|
function = get_frame_function (fr);
|
|
if (function == NULL
|
|
|| !contained_in (b->exp_valid_block,
|
|
SYMBOL_BLOCK_VALUE (function)))
|
|
within_current_scope = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (within_current_scope)
|
|
/* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected
|
|
in normal_stop. So this call to select_frame won't affect
|
|
the user. */
|
|
select_frame (fr);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (within_current_scope)
|
|
{
|
|
/* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a *long*
|
|
time before we return to the command level and call
|
|
free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because we
|
|
might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */
|
|
|
|
int pc = 0;
|
|
struct value *mark;
|
|
struct value *new_val;
|
|
|
|
if (is_masked_watchpoint (b))
|
|
/* Since we don't know the exact trigger address (from
|
|
stopped_data_address), just tell the user we've triggered
|
|
a mask watchpoint. */
|
|
return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
|
|
|
|
mark = value_mark ();
|
|
fetch_subexp_value (b->exp.get (), &pc, &new_val, NULL, NULL, 0);
|
|
|
|
if (b->val_bitsize != 0)
|
|
new_val = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, new_val);
|
|
|
|
/* We use value_equal_contents instead of value_equal because
|
|
the latter coerces an array to a pointer, thus comparing just
|
|
the address of the array instead of its contents. This is
|
|
not what we want. */
|
|
if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL)
|
|
|| (b->val != NULL && !value_equal_contents (b->val.get (),
|
|
new_val)))
|
|
{
|
|
bs->old_val = b->val;
|
|
b->val = release_value (new_val);
|
|
b->val_valid = true;
|
|
if (new_val != NULL)
|
|
value_free_to_mark (mark);
|
|
return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* Nothing changed. */
|
|
value_free_to_mark (mark);
|
|
return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* This seems like the only logical thing to do because
|
|
if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when
|
|
we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains
|
|
garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two
|
|
garbage values, one before and one after the prologue).
|
|
So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and
|
|
watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal
|
|
the first value assigned). */
|
|
/* We print all the stop information in
|
|
breakpoint_ops->print_it, but in this case, by the time we
|
|
call breakpoint_ops->print_it this bp will be deleted
|
|
already. So we have no choice but print the information
|
|
here. */
|
|
|
|
SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS ()
|
|
{
|
|
struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
|
|
|
|
if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
|
|
uiout->field_string
|
|
("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE));
|
|
uiout->message ("\nWatchpoint %pF deleted because the program has "
|
|
"left the block in\n"
|
|
"which its expression is valid.\n",
|
|
signed_field ("wpnum", b->number));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Make sure the watchpoint's commands aren't executed. */
|
|
b->commands = NULL;
|
|
watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
|
|
|
|
return WP_DELETED;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting
|
|
breakpoint location BL. This function does not check if we should
|
|
stop, only if BL explains the stop. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl,
|
|
const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
|
|
const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
|
|
|
|
/* BL is from an existing breakpoint. */
|
|
gdb_assert (b != NULL);
|
|
|
|
return b->ops->breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Determine if the watched values have actually changed, and we
|
|
should stop. If not, set BS->stop to 0. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
|
|
{
|
|
const struct bp_location *bl;
|
|
struct watchpoint *b;
|
|
|
|
/* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
|
|
bl = bs->bp_location_at;
|
|
gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
|
|
b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
|
|
gdb_assert (b != NULL);
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
int must_check_value = 0;
|
|
|
|
if (b->type == bp_watchpoint)
|
|
/* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the
|
|
watched value. */
|
|
must_check_value = 1;
|
|
else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes)
|
|
/* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access)
|
|
and the target earlier reported an address watched by
|
|
this watchpoint. */
|
|
must_check_value = 1;
|
|
else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown
|
|
&& b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
|
|
/* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could
|
|
not report the data address. We must check the watchpoint's
|
|
value. Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without
|
|
a data address, we can't figure it out. */
|
|
must_check_value = 1;
|
|
|
|
if (must_check_value)
|
|
{
|
|
wp_check_result e;
|
|
|
|
try
|
|
{
|
|
e = watchpoint_check (bs);
|
|
}
|
|
catch (const gdb_exception &ex)
|
|
{
|
|
exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
|
|
"Error evaluating expression "
|
|
"for watchpoint %d\n",
|
|
b->number);
|
|
|
|
SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS ()
|
|
{
|
|
printf_filtered (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"),
|
|
b->number);
|
|
}
|
|
watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
|
|
e = WP_DELETED;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
switch (e)
|
|
{
|
|
case WP_DELETED:
|
|
/* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
|
|
bs->print_it = print_it_done;
|
|
/* Stop. */
|
|
break;
|
|
case WP_IGNORE:
|
|
bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
|
|
bs->stop = 0;
|
|
break;
|
|
case WP_VALUE_CHANGED:
|
|
if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
|
|
{
|
|
/* There are two cases to consider here:
|
|
|
|
1. We're watching the triggered memory for reads.
|
|
In that case, trust the target, and always report
|
|
the watchpoint hit to the user. Even though
|
|
reads don't cause value changes, the value may
|
|
have changed since the last time it was read, and
|
|
since we're not trapping writes, we will not see
|
|
those, and as such we should ignore our notion of
|
|
old value.
|
|
|
|
2. We're watching the triggered memory for both
|
|
reads and writes. There are two ways this may
|
|
happen:
|
|
|
|
2.1. This is a target that can't break on data
|
|
reads only, but can break on accesses (reads or
|
|
writes), such as e.g., x86. We detect this case
|
|
at the time we try to insert read watchpoints.
|
|
|
|
2.2. Otherwise, the target supports read
|
|
watchpoints, but, the user set an access or write
|
|
watchpoint watching the same memory as this read
|
|
watchpoint.
|
|
|
|
If we're watching memory writes as well as reads,
|
|
ignore watchpoint hits when we find that the
|
|
value hasn't changed, as reads don't cause
|
|
changes. This still gives false positives when
|
|
the program writes the same value to memory as
|
|
what there was already in memory (we will confuse
|
|
it for a read), but it's much better than
|
|
nothing. */
|
|
|
|
int other_write_watchpoint = 0;
|
|
|
|
if (bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *other_b;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other_b)
|
|
if (other_b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
|
|
|| other_b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
|
|
{
|
|
struct watchpoint *other_w =
|
|
(struct watchpoint *) other_b;
|
|
|
|
if (other_w->watchpoint_triggered
|
|
== watch_triggered_yes)
|
|
{
|
|
other_write_watchpoint = 1;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (other_write_watchpoint
|
|
|| bl->watchpoint_type == hw_access)
|
|
{
|
|
/* We're watching the same memory for writes,
|
|
and the value changed since the last time we
|
|
updated it, so this trap must be for a write.
|
|
Ignore it. */
|
|
bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
|
|
bs->stop = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED:
|
|
if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
|
|
|| b->type == bp_watchpoint)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if
|
|
the value hasn't changed. */
|
|
bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
|
|
bs->stop = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
/* Stop. */
|
|
break;
|
|
default:
|
|
/* Can't happen. */
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else /* must_check_value == 0 */
|
|
{
|
|
/* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but
|
|
not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no
|
|
watchpoint triggered after all. So don't print
|
|
anything for this watchpoint. */
|
|
bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
|
|
bs->stop = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* For breakpoints that are currently marked as telling gdb to stop,
|
|
check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count)
|
|
of breakpoint referred to by BS. If we should not stop for this
|
|
breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat bs, thread_info *thread)
|
|
{
|
|
const struct bp_location *bl;
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
/* Assume stop. */
|
|
bool condition_result = true;
|
|
struct expression *cond;
|
|
|
|
gdb_assert (bs->stop);
|
|
|
|
/* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
|
|
bl = bs->bp_location_at;
|
|
gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
|
|
b = bs->breakpoint_at;
|
|
gdb_assert (b != NULL);
|
|
|
|
/* Even if the target evaluated the condition on its end and notified GDB, we
|
|
need to do so again since GDB does not know if we stopped due to a
|
|
breakpoint or a single step breakpoint. */
|
|
|
|
if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id)
|
|
&& !frame_id_eq (b->frame_id, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())))
|
|
{
|
|
bs->stop = 0;
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If this is a thread/task-specific breakpoint, don't waste cpu
|
|
evaluating the condition if this isn't the specified
|
|
thread/task. */
|
|
if ((b->thread != -1 && b->thread != thread->global_num)
|
|
|| (b->task != 0 && b->task != ada_get_task_number (thread)))
|
|
{
|
|
bs->stop = 0;
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Evaluate extension language breakpoints that have a "stop" method
|
|
implemented. */
|
|
bs->stop = breakpoint_ext_lang_cond_says_stop (b);
|
|
|
|
if (is_watchpoint (b))
|
|
{
|
|
struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
|
|
|
|
cond = w->cond_exp.get ();
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
cond = bl->cond.get ();
|
|
|
|
if (cond && b->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
|
|
{
|
|
int within_current_scope = 1;
|
|
struct watchpoint * w;
|
|
|
|
/* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could
|
|
be a long time before we return to the command level and
|
|
call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values
|
|
because we might be in the middle of evaluating a
|
|
function call. */
|
|
struct value *mark = value_mark ();
|
|
|
|
if (is_watchpoint (b))
|
|
w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
|
|
else
|
|
w = NULL;
|
|
|
|
/* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that
|
|
the conditions will have the right context. Because we
|
|
use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's
|
|
variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start
|
|
of the inlined function; the current frame will be the
|
|
call site. */
|
|
if (w == NULL || w->cond_exp_valid_block == NULL)
|
|
select_frame (get_current_frame ());
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
struct frame_info *frame;
|
|
|
|
/* For local watchpoint expressions, which particular
|
|
instance of a local is being watched matters, so we
|
|
keep track of the frame to evaluate the expression
|
|
in. To evaluate the condition however, it doesn't
|
|
really matter which instantiation of the function
|
|
where the condition makes sense triggers the
|
|
watchpoint. This allows an expression like "watch
|
|
global if q > 10" set in `func', catch writes to
|
|
global on all threads that call `func', or catch
|
|
writes on all recursive calls of `func' by a single
|
|
thread. We simply always evaluate the condition in
|
|
the innermost frame that's executing where it makes
|
|
sense to evaluate the condition. It seems
|
|
intuitive. */
|
|
frame = block_innermost_frame (w->cond_exp_valid_block);
|
|
if (frame != NULL)
|
|
select_frame (frame);
|
|
else
|
|
within_current_scope = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
if (within_current_scope)
|
|
{
|
|
try
|
|
{
|
|
condition_result = breakpoint_cond_eval (cond);
|
|
}
|
|
catch (const gdb_exception &ex)
|
|
{
|
|
exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
|
|
"Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n");
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
warning (_("Watchpoint condition cannot be tested "
|
|
"in the current scope"));
|
|
/* If we failed to set the right context for this
|
|
watchpoint, unconditionally report it. */
|
|
}
|
|
/* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint #. */
|
|
value_free_to_mark (mark);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (cond && !condition_result)
|
|
{
|
|
bs->stop = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
else if (b->ignore_count > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
b->ignore_count--;
|
|
bs->stop = 0;
|
|
/* Increase the hit count even though we don't stop. */
|
|
++(b->hit_count);
|
|
gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Returns true if we need to track moribund locations of LOC's type
|
|
on the current target. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
need_moribund_for_location_type (struct bp_location *loc)
|
|
{
|
|
return ((loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
|
|
&& !target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ())
|
|
|| (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
|
|
&& !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ()));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* See breakpoint.h. */
|
|
|
|
bpstat
|
|
build_bpstat_chain (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
|
|
const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
bpstat bs_head = NULL, *bs_link = &bs_head;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
for (bp_location *bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
|
|
{
|
|
/* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first
|
|
location. The watchpoint_check function will work on the
|
|
entire expression, not the individual locations. For
|
|
read watchpoints, the watchpoints_triggered function has
|
|
checked all locations already. */
|
|
if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bl != b->loc)
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if (!bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address
|
|
matches. */
|
|
|
|
bpstat bs = new bpstats (bl, &bs_link); /* Alloc a bpstat to
|
|
explain stop. */
|
|
|
|
/* Assume we stop. Should we find a watchpoint that is not
|
|
actually triggered, or if the condition of the breakpoint
|
|
evaluates as false, we'll reset 'stop' to 0. */
|
|
bs->stop = 1;
|
|
bs->print = 1;
|
|
|
|
/* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated
|
|
watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the
|
|
out-of-scope event. We'll get to the watchpoint next
|
|
iteration. */
|
|
if (b->type == bp_watchpoint_scope && b->related_breakpoint != b)
|
|
{
|
|
struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b->related_breakpoint;
|
|
|
|
w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Check if a moribund breakpoint explains the stop. */
|
|
if (!target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ()
|
|
|| !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ())
|
|
{
|
|
for (bp_location *loc : moribund_locations)
|
|
{
|
|
if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, bp_addr)
|
|
&& need_moribund_for_location_type (loc))
|
|
{
|
|
bpstat bs = new bpstats (loc, &bs_link);
|
|
/* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed. */
|
|
bs->stop = 0;
|
|
bs->print = 0;
|
|
bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return bs_head;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* See breakpoint.h. */
|
|
|
|
bpstat
|
|
bpstat_stop_status (const address_space *aspace,
|
|
CORE_ADDR bp_addr, thread_info *thread,
|
|
const struct target_waitstatus *ws,
|
|
bpstat stop_chain)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
|
|
/* First item of allocated bpstat's. */
|
|
bpstat bs_head = stop_chain;
|
|
bpstat bs;
|
|
int need_remove_insert;
|
|
int removed_any;
|
|
|
|
/* First, build the bpstat chain with locations that explain a
|
|
target stop, while being careful to not set the target running,
|
|
as that may invalidate locations (in particular watchpoint
|
|
locations are recreated). Resuming will happen here with
|
|
breakpoint conditions or watchpoint expressions that include
|
|
inferior function calls. */
|
|
if (bs_head == NULL)
|
|
bs_head = build_bpstat_chain (aspace, bp_addr, ws);
|
|
|
|
/* A bit of special processing for shlib breakpoints. We need to
|
|
process solib loading here, so that the lists of loaded and
|
|
unloaded libraries are correct before we handle "catch load" and
|
|
"catch unload". */
|
|
for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
|
|
{
|
|
if (bs->breakpoint_at && bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
|
|
{
|
|
handle_solib_event ();
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Now go through the locations that caused the target to stop, and
|
|
check whether we're interested in reporting this stop to higher
|
|
layers, or whether we should resume the target transparently. */
|
|
|
|
removed_any = 0;
|
|
|
|
for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!bs->stop)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
b = bs->breakpoint_at;
|
|
b->ops->check_status (bs);
|
|
if (bs->stop)
|
|
{
|
|
bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, thread);
|
|
|
|
if (bs->stop)
|
|
{
|
|
++(b->hit_count);
|
|
gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
|
|
|
|
/* We will stop here. */
|
|
if (b->disposition == disp_disable)
|
|
{
|
|
--(b->enable_count);
|
|
if (b->enable_count <= 0)
|
|
b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
|
|
removed_any = 1;
|
|
}
|
|
if (b->silent)
|
|
bs->print = 0;
|
|
bs->commands = b->commands;
|
|
if (command_line_is_silent (bs->commands
|
|
? bs->commands.get () : NULL))
|
|
bs->print = 0;
|
|
|
|
b->ops->after_condition_true (bs);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Print nothing for this entry if we don't stop or don't
|
|
print. */
|
|
if (!bs->stop || !bs->print)
|
|
bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may
|
|
not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are
|
|
watching may have. Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get
|
|
done later. */
|
|
need_remove_insert = 0;
|
|
if (! bpstat_causes_stop (bs_head))
|
|
for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
|
|
if (!bs->stop
|
|
&& bs->breakpoint_at
|
|
&& is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at))
|
|
{
|
|
struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
|
|
|
|
update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
|
|
need_remove_insert = 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (need_remove_insert)
|
|
update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
|
|
else if (removed_any)
|
|
update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
|
|
|
|
return bs_head;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
handle_jit_event (void)
|
|
{
|
|
struct frame_info *frame;
|
|
struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
|
|
|
|
infrun_debug_printf ("handling bp_jit_event");
|
|
|
|
/* Switch terminal for any messages produced by
|
|
breakpoint_re_set. */
|
|
target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
|
|
|
|
frame = get_current_frame ();
|
|
gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
|
|
objfile *jiter = symbol_objfile (get_frame_function (frame));
|
|
|
|
jit_event_handler (gdbarch, jiter);
|
|
|
|
target_terminal::inferior ();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Prepare WHAT final decision for infrun. */
|
|
|
|
/* Decide what infrun needs to do with this bpstat. */
|
|
|
|
struct bpstat_what
|
|
bpstat_what (bpstat bs_head)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bpstat_what retval;
|
|
bpstat bs;
|
|
|
|
retval.main_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
|
|
retval.call_dummy = STOP_NONE;
|
|
retval.is_longjmp = false;
|
|
|
|
for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Extract this BS's action. After processing each BS, we check
|
|
if its action overrides all we've seem so far. */
|
|
enum bpstat_what_main_action this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
|
|
enum bptype bptype;
|
|
|
|
if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
/* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary
|
|
breakpoint which has since been deleted. */
|
|
bptype = bp_none;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
bptype = bs->breakpoint_at->type;
|
|
|
|
switch (bptype)
|
|
{
|
|
case bp_none:
|
|
break;
|
|
case bp_breakpoint:
|
|
case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
|
|
case bp_single_step:
|
|
case bp_until:
|
|
case bp_finish:
|
|
case bp_shlib_event:
|
|
if (bs->stop)
|
|
{
|
|
if (bs->print)
|
|
this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
|
|
else
|
|
this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
|
|
break;
|
|
case bp_watchpoint:
|
|
case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
|
|
case bp_read_watchpoint:
|
|
case bp_access_watchpoint:
|
|
if (bs->stop)
|
|
{
|
|
if (bs->print)
|
|
this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
|
|
else
|
|
this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping.
|
|
This requires no further action. */
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
case bp_longjmp:
|
|
case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
|
|
case bp_exception:
|
|
if (bs->stop)
|
|
{
|
|
this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME;
|
|
retval.is_longjmp = bptype != bp_exception;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
|
|
break;
|
|
case bp_longjmp_resume:
|
|
case bp_exception_resume:
|
|
if (bs->stop)
|
|
{
|
|
this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME;
|
|
retval.is_longjmp = bptype == bp_longjmp_resume;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
|
|
break;
|
|
case bp_step_resume:
|
|
if (bs->stop)
|
|
this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME;
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* It is for the wrong frame. */
|
|
this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
case bp_hp_step_resume:
|
|
if (bs->stop)
|
|
this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_HP_STEP_RESUME;
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* It is for the wrong frame. */
|
|
this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
case bp_watchpoint_scope:
|
|
case bp_thread_event:
|
|
case bp_overlay_event:
|
|
case bp_longjmp_master:
|
|
case bp_std_terminate_master:
|
|
case bp_exception_master:
|
|
this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
|
|
break;
|
|
case bp_catchpoint:
|
|
if (bs->stop)
|
|
{
|
|
if (bs->print)
|
|
this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
|
|
else
|
|
this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* Some catchpoints are implemented with breakpoints.
|
|
For those, we need to step over the breakpoint. */
|
|
if (bs->bp_location_at->loc_type != bp_loc_other)
|
|
this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
case bp_jit_event:
|
|
this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
|
|
break;
|
|
case bp_call_dummy:
|
|
/* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
|
|
so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
|
|
retval.call_dummy = STOP_STACK_DUMMY;
|
|
this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
|
|
break;
|
|
case bp_std_terminate:
|
|
/* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
|
|
so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
|
|
retval.call_dummy = STOP_STD_TERMINATE;
|
|
this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
|
|
break;
|
|
case bp_tracepoint:
|
|
case bp_fast_tracepoint:
|
|
case bp_static_tracepoint:
|
|
/* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and
|
|
if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered
|
|
out already. */
|
|
internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
|
|
_("bpstat_what: tracepoint encountered"));
|
|
break;
|
|
case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
|
|
/* Step over it (and insert bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return). */
|
|
this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
|
|
break;
|
|
case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
|
|
/* The breakpoint will be removed, execution will restart from the
|
|
PC of the former breakpoint. */
|
|
this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case bp_dprintf:
|
|
if (bs->stop)
|
|
this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
|
|
else
|
|
this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
|
|
_("bpstat_what: unhandled bptype %d"), (int) bptype);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
retval.main_action = std::max (retval.main_action, this_action);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return retval;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
bpstat_run_callbacks (bpstat bs_head)
|
|
{
|
|
bpstat bs;
|
|
|
|
for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
|
|
|
|
if (b == NULL)
|
|
continue;
|
|
switch (b->type)
|
|
{
|
|
case bp_jit_event:
|
|
handle_jit_event ();
|
|
break;
|
|
case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
|
|
gnu_ifunc_resolver_stop (b);
|
|
break;
|
|
case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
|
|
gnu_ifunc_resolver_return_stop (b);
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* See breakpoint.h. */
|
|
|
|
bool
|
|
bpstat_should_step ()
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
|
|
if (breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc != NULL)
|
|
return true;
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* See breakpoint.h. */
|
|
|
|
bool
|
|
bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat bs)
|
|
{
|
|
for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
|
|
if (bs->stop)
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Compute a string of spaces suitable to indent the next line
|
|
so it starts at the position corresponding to the table column
|
|
named COL_NAME in the currently active table of UIOUT. */
|
|
|
|
static char *
|
|
wrap_indent_at_field (struct ui_out *uiout, const char *col_name)
|
|
{
|
|
static char wrap_indent[80];
|
|
int i, total_width, width, align;
|
|
const char *text;
|
|
|
|
total_width = 0;
|
|
for (i = 1; uiout->query_table_field (i, &width, &align, &text); i++)
|
|
{
|
|
if (strcmp (text, col_name) == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
gdb_assert (total_width < sizeof wrap_indent);
|
|
memset (wrap_indent, ' ', total_width);
|
|
wrap_indent[total_width] = 0;
|
|
|
|
return wrap_indent;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
total_width += width + 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Determine if the locations of this breakpoint will have their conditions
|
|
evaluated by the target, host or a mix of both. Returns the following:
|
|
|
|
"host": Host evals condition.
|
|
"host or target": Host or Target evals condition.
|
|
"target": Target evals condition.
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
static const char *
|
|
bp_condition_evaluator (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *bl;
|
|
char host_evals = 0;
|
|
char target_evals = 0;
|
|
|
|
if (!b)
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
|
|
if (!is_breakpoint (b))
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
|
|
if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
|
|
|| !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
|
|
return condition_evaluation_host;
|
|
|
|
for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
|
|
{
|
|
if (bl->cond_bytecode)
|
|
target_evals++;
|
|
else
|
|
host_evals++;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (host_evals && target_evals)
|
|
return condition_evaluation_both;
|
|
else if (target_evals)
|
|
return condition_evaluation_target;
|
|
else
|
|
return condition_evaluation_host;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Determine the breakpoint location's condition evaluator. This is
|
|
similar to bp_condition_evaluator, but for locations. */
|
|
|
|
static const char *
|
|
bp_location_condition_evaluator (struct bp_location *bl)
|
|
{
|
|
if (bl && !is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
|
|
if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
|
|
|| !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
|
|
return condition_evaluation_host;
|
|
|
|
if (bl && bl->cond_bytecode)
|
|
return condition_evaluation_target;
|
|
else
|
|
return condition_evaluation_host;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
print_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
|
|
struct bp_location *loc)
|
|
{
|
|
struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
|
|
|
|
scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
|
|
|
|
if (loc != NULL && loc->shlib_disabled)
|
|
loc = NULL;
|
|
|
|
if (loc != NULL)
|
|
set_current_program_space (loc->pspace);
|
|
|
|
if (b->display_canonical)
|
|
uiout->field_string ("what", event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
|
|
else if (loc && loc->symtab)
|
|
{
|
|
const struct symbol *sym = loc->symbol;
|
|
|
|
if (sym)
|
|
{
|
|
uiout->text ("in ");
|
|
uiout->field_string ("func", sym->print_name (),
|
|
function_name_style.style ());
|
|
uiout->text (" ");
|
|
uiout->wrap_hint (wrap_indent_at_field (uiout, "what"));
|
|
uiout->text ("at ");
|
|
}
|
|
uiout->field_string ("file",
|
|
symtab_to_filename_for_display (loc->symtab),
|
|
file_name_style.style ());
|
|
uiout->text (":");
|
|
|
|
if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
|
|
uiout->field_string ("fullname", symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab));
|
|
|
|
uiout->field_signed ("line", loc->line_number);
|
|
}
|
|
else if (loc)
|
|
{
|
|
string_file stb;
|
|
|
|
print_address_symbolic (loc->gdbarch, loc->address, &stb,
|
|
demangle, "");
|
|
uiout->field_stream ("at", stb);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
uiout->field_string ("pending",
|
|
event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
|
|
/* If extra_string is available, it could be holding a condition
|
|
or dprintf arguments. In either case, make sure it is printed,
|
|
too, but only for non-MI streams. */
|
|
if (!uiout->is_mi_like_p () && b->extra_string != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
|
|
uiout->text (",");
|
|
else
|
|
uiout->text (" ");
|
|
uiout->text (b->extra_string);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (loc && is_breakpoint (b)
|
|
&& breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode () == condition_evaluation_target
|
|
&& bp_condition_evaluator (b) == condition_evaluation_both)
|
|
{
|
|
uiout->text (" (");
|
|
uiout->field_string ("evaluated-by",
|
|
bp_location_condition_evaluator (loc));
|
|
uiout->text (")");
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static const char *
|
|
bptype_string (enum bptype type)
|
|
{
|
|
struct ep_type_description
|
|
{
|
|
enum bptype type;
|
|
const char *description;
|
|
};
|
|
static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] =
|
|
{
|
|
{bp_none, "?deleted?"},
|
|
{bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"},
|
|
{bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"},
|
|
{bp_single_step, "sw single-step"},
|
|
{bp_until, "until"},
|
|
{bp_finish, "finish"},
|
|
{bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"},
|
|
{bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"},
|
|
{bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"},
|
|
{bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"},
|
|
{bp_longjmp, "longjmp"},
|
|
{bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"},
|
|
{bp_longjmp_call_dummy, "longjmp for call dummy"},
|
|
{bp_exception, "exception"},
|
|
{bp_exception_resume, "exception resume"},
|
|
{bp_step_resume, "step resume"},
|
|
{bp_hp_step_resume, "high-priority step resume"},
|
|
{bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"},
|
|
{bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"},
|
|
{bp_std_terminate, "std::terminate"},
|
|
{bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"},
|
|
{bp_thread_event, "thread events"},
|
|
{bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"},
|
|
{bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"},
|
|
{bp_std_terminate_master, "std::terminate master"},
|
|
{bp_exception_master, "exception master"},
|
|
{bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"},
|
|
{bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"},
|
|
{bp_fast_tracepoint, "fast tracepoint"},
|
|
{bp_static_tracepoint, "static tracepoint"},
|
|
{bp_dprintf, "dprintf"},
|
|
{bp_jit_event, "jit events"},
|
|
{bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver"},
|
|
{bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver return"},
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
if (((int) type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0])))
|
|
|| ((int) type != bptypes[(int) type].type))
|
|
internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
|
|
_("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."),
|
|
(int) type);
|
|
|
|
return bptypes[(int) type].description;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* For MI, output a field named 'thread-groups' with a list as the value.
|
|
For CLI, prefix the list with the string 'inf'. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
output_thread_groups (struct ui_out *uiout,
|
|
const char *field_name,
|
|
const std::vector<int> &inf_nums,
|
|
int mi_only)
|
|
{
|
|
int is_mi = uiout->is_mi_like_p ();
|
|
|
|
/* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
|
|
there are several. Always display them for MI. */
|
|
if (!is_mi && mi_only)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (uiout, field_name);
|
|
|
|
for (size_t i = 0; i < inf_nums.size (); i++)
|
|
{
|
|
if (is_mi)
|
|
{
|
|
char mi_group[10];
|
|
|
|
xsnprintf (mi_group, sizeof (mi_group), "i%d", inf_nums[i]);
|
|
uiout->field_string (NULL, mi_group);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
if (i == 0)
|
|
uiout->text (" inf ");
|
|
else
|
|
uiout->text (", ");
|
|
|
|
uiout->text (plongest (inf_nums[i]));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Print B to gdb_stdout. If RAW_LOC, print raw breakpoint locations
|
|
instead of going via breakpoint_ops::print_one. This makes "maint
|
|
info breakpoints" show the software breakpoint locations of
|
|
catchpoints, which are considered internal implementation
|
|
detail. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
|
|
struct bp_location *loc,
|
|
int loc_number,
|
|
struct bp_location **last_loc,
|
|
int allflag, bool raw_loc)
|
|
{
|
|
struct command_line *l;
|
|
static char bpenables[] = "nynny";
|
|
|
|
struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
|
|
int header_of_multiple = 0;
|
|
int part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL);
|
|
struct value_print_options opts;
|
|
|
|
get_user_print_options (&opts);
|
|
|
|
gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0);
|
|
/* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning treatment of
|
|
breakpoints with single disabled location. */
|
|
if (loc == NULL
|
|
&& (b->loc != NULL
|
|
&& (b->loc->next != NULL || !b->loc->enabled)))
|
|
header_of_multiple = 1;
|
|
if (loc == NULL)
|
|
loc = b->loc;
|
|
|
|
annotate_record ();
|
|
|
|
/* 1 */
|
|
annotate_field (0);
|
|
if (part_of_multiple)
|
|
uiout->field_fmt ("number", "%d.%d", b->number, loc_number);
|
|
else
|
|
uiout->field_signed ("number", b->number);
|
|
|
|
/* 2 */
|
|
annotate_field (1);
|
|
if (part_of_multiple)
|
|
uiout->field_skip ("type");
|
|
else
|
|
uiout->field_string ("type", bptype_string (b->type));
|
|
|
|
/* 3 */
|
|
annotate_field (2);
|
|
if (part_of_multiple)
|
|
uiout->field_skip ("disp");
|
|
else
|
|
uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
|
|
|
|
/* 4 */
|
|
annotate_field (3);
|
|
if (part_of_multiple)
|
|
uiout->field_string ("enabled", loc->enabled ? "y" : "n");
|
|
else
|
|
uiout->field_fmt ("enabled", "%c", bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]);
|
|
|
|
/* 5 and 6 */
|
|
if (!raw_loc && b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_one != NULL)
|
|
b->ops->print_one (b, last_loc);
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
if (is_watchpoint (b))
|
|
{
|
|
struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
|
|
|
|
/* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
|
|
not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
|
|
is relatively readable). */
|
|
if (opts.addressprint)
|
|
uiout->field_skip ("addr");
|
|
annotate_field (5);
|
|
uiout->field_string ("what", w->exp_string);
|
|
}
|
|
else if (!is_catchpoint (b) || is_exception_catchpoint (b)
|
|
|| is_ada_exception_catchpoint (b))
|
|
{
|
|
if (opts.addressprint)
|
|
{
|
|
annotate_field (4);
|
|
if (header_of_multiple)
|
|
uiout->field_string ("addr", "<MULTIPLE>",
|
|
metadata_style.style ());
|
|
else if (b->loc == NULL || loc->shlib_disabled)
|
|
uiout->field_string ("addr", "<PENDING>",
|
|
metadata_style.style ());
|
|
else
|
|
uiout->field_core_addr ("addr",
|
|
loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
|
|
}
|
|
annotate_field (5);
|
|
if (!header_of_multiple)
|
|
print_breakpoint_location (b, loc);
|
|
if (b->loc)
|
|
*last_loc = b->loc;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (loc != NULL && !header_of_multiple)
|
|
{
|
|
std::vector<int> inf_nums;
|
|
int mi_only = 1;
|
|
|
|
for (inferior *inf : all_inferiors ())
|
|
{
|
|
if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace)
|
|
inf_nums.push_back (inf->num);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
|
|
there are several. Always display for MI. */
|
|
if (allflag
|
|
|| (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
|
|
&& (program_spaces.size () > 1
|
|
|| number_of_inferiors () > 1)
|
|
/* LOC is for existing B, it cannot be in
|
|
moribund_locations and thus having NULL OWNER. */
|
|
&& loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint))
|
|
mi_only = 0;
|
|
output_thread_groups (uiout, "thread-groups", inf_nums, mi_only);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!part_of_multiple)
|
|
{
|
|
if (b->thread != -1)
|
|
{
|
|
/* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the
|
|
"stop only in" line a little further down. */
|
|
uiout->text (" thread ");
|
|
uiout->field_signed ("thread", b->thread);
|
|
}
|
|
else if (b->task != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
uiout->text (" task ");
|
|
uiout->field_signed ("task", b->task);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
uiout->text ("\n");
|
|
|
|
if (!part_of_multiple)
|
|
b->ops->print_one_detail (b, uiout);
|
|
|
|
if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id))
|
|
{
|
|
annotate_field (6);
|
|
uiout->text ("\tstop only in stack frame at ");
|
|
/* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poking around inside
|
|
the frame ID. */
|
|
uiout->field_core_addr ("frame",
|
|
b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr);
|
|
uiout->text ("\n");
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string)
|
|
{
|
|
annotate_field (7);
|
|
if (is_tracepoint (b))
|
|
uiout->text ("\ttrace only if ");
|
|
else
|
|
uiout->text ("\tstop only if ");
|
|
uiout->field_string ("cond", b->cond_string);
|
|
|
|
/* Print whether the target is doing the breakpoint's condition
|
|
evaluation. If GDB is doing the evaluation, don't print anything. */
|
|
if (is_breakpoint (b)
|
|
&& breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ()
|
|
== condition_evaluation_target)
|
|
{
|
|
uiout->message (" (%pF evals)",
|
|
string_field ("evaluated-by",
|
|
bp_condition_evaluator (b)));
|
|
}
|
|
uiout->text ("\n");
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1)
|
|
{
|
|
/* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
|
|
uiout->text ("\tstop only in thread ");
|
|
if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
|
|
uiout->field_signed ("thread", b->thread);
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (b->thread);
|
|
|
|
uiout->field_string ("thread", print_thread_id (thr));
|
|
}
|
|
uiout->text ("\n");
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!part_of_multiple)
|
|
{
|
|
if (b->hit_count)
|
|
{
|
|
/* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
|
|
if (is_catchpoint (b))
|
|
uiout->text ("\tcatchpoint");
|
|
else if (is_tracepoint (b))
|
|
uiout->text ("\ttracepoint");
|
|
else
|
|
uiout->text ("\tbreakpoint");
|
|
uiout->text (" already hit ");
|
|
uiout->field_signed ("times", b->hit_count);
|
|
if (b->hit_count == 1)
|
|
uiout->text (" time\n");
|
|
else
|
|
uiout->text (" times\n");
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is mi. */
|
|
if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
|
|
uiout->field_signed ("times", b->hit_count);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count)
|
|
{
|
|
annotate_field (8);
|
|
uiout->message ("\tignore next %pF hits\n",
|
|
signed_field ("ignore", b->ignore_count));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Note that an enable count of 1 corresponds to "enable once"
|
|
behavior, which is reported by the combination of enablement and
|
|
disposition, so we don't need to mention it here. */
|
|
if (!part_of_multiple && b->enable_count > 1)
|
|
{
|
|
annotate_field (8);
|
|
uiout->text ("\tdisable after ");
|
|
/* Tweak the wording to clarify that ignore and enable counts
|
|
are distinct, and have additive effect. */
|
|
if (b->ignore_count)
|
|
uiout->text ("additional ");
|
|
else
|
|
uiout->text ("next ");
|
|
uiout->field_signed ("enable", b->enable_count);
|
|
uiout->text (" hits\n");
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!part_of_multiple && is_tracepoint (b))
|
|
{
|
|
struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
|
|
|
|
if (tp->traceframe_usage)
|
|
{
|
|
uiout->text ("\ttrace buffer usage ");
|
|
uiout->field_signed ("traceframe-usage", tp->traceframe_usage);
|
|
uiout->text (" bytes\n");
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
l = b->commands ? b->commands.get () : NULL;
|
|
if (!part_of_multiple && l)
|
|
{
|
|
annotate_field (9);
|
|
ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, "script");
|
|
print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (is_tracepoint (b))
|
|
{
|
|
struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
|
|
|
|
if (!part_of_multiple && t->pass_count)
|
|
{
|
|
annotate_field (10);
|
|
uiout->text ("\tpass count ");
|
|
uiout->field_signed ("pass", t->pass_count);
|
|
uiout->text (" \n");
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Don't display it when tracepoint or tracepoint location is
|
|
pending. */
|
|
if (!header_of_multiple && loc != NULL && !loc->shlib_disabled)
|
|
{
|
|
annotate_field (11);
|
|
|
|
if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
|
|
uiout->field_string ("installed",
|
|
loc->inserted ? "y" : "n");
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
if (loc->inserted)
|
|
uiout->text ("\t");
|
|
else
|
|
uiout->text ("\tnot ");
|
|
uiout->text ("installed on target\n");
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (uiout->is_mi_like_p () && !part_of_multiple)
|
|
{
|
|
if (is_watchpoint (b))
|
|
{
|
|
struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
|
|
|
|
uiout->field_string ("original-location", w->exp_string);
|
|
}
|
|
else if (b->location != NULL
|
|
&& event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()) != NULL)
|
|
uiout->field_string ("original-location",
|
|
event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* See breakpoint.h. */
|
|
|
|
bool fix_multi_location_breakpoint_output_globally = false;
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
|
|
struct bp_location **last_loc,
|
|
int allflag)
|
|
{
|
|
struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
|
|
bool use_fixed_output
|
|
= (uiout->test_flags (fix_multi_location_breakpoint_output)
|
|
|| fix_multi_location_breakpoint_output_globally);
|
|
|
|
gdb::optional<ui_out_emit_tuple> bkpt_tuple_emitter (gdb::in_place, uiout, "bkpt");
|
|
print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc, allflag, false);
|
|
|
|
/* The mi2 broken format: the main breakpoint tuple ends here, the locations
|
|
are outside. */
|
|
if (!use_fixed_output)
|
|
bkpt_tuple_emitter.reset ();
|
|
|
|
/* If this breakpoint has custom print function,
|
|
it's already printed. Otherwise, print individual
|
|
locations, if any. */
|
|
if (b->ops == NULL
|
|
|| b->ops->print_one == NULL
|
|
|| allflag)
|
|
{
|
|
/* If breakpoint has a single location that is disabled, we
|
|
print it as if it had several locations, since otherwise it's
|
|
hard to represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled"
|
|
situation.
|
|
|
|
Note that while hardware watchpoints have several locations
|
|
internally, that's not a property exposed to users.
|
|
|
|
Likewise, while catchpoints may be implemented with
|
|
breakpoints (e.g., catch throw), that's not a property
|
|
exposed to users. We do however display the internal
|
|
breakpoint locations with "maint info breakpoints". */
|
|
if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
|
|
&& (!is_catchpoint (b) || is_exception_catchpoint (b)
|
|
|| is_ada_exception_catchpoint (b))
|
|
&& (allflag
|
|
|| (b->loc && (b->loc->next || !b->loc->enabled))))
|
|
{
|
|
gdb::optional<ui_out_emit_list> locations_list;
|
|
|
|
/* For MI version <= 2, keep the behavior where GDB outputs an invalid
|
|
MI record. For later versions, place breakpoint locations in a
|
|
list. */
|
|
if (uiout->is_mi_like_p () && use_fixed_output)
|
|
locations_list.emplace (uiout, "locations");
|
|
|
|
int n = 1;
|
|
for (bp_location *loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next, ++n)
|
|
{
|
|
ui_out_emit_tuple loc_tuple_emitter (uiout, NULL);
|
|
print_one_breakpoint_location (b, loc, n, last_loc,
|
|
allflag, allflag);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
int print_address_bits = 0;
|
|
struct bp_location *loc;
|
|
|
|
/* Software watchpoints that aren't watching memory don't have an
|
|
address to print. */
|
|
if (is_no_memory_software_watchpoint (b))
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
|
|
{
|
|
int addr_bit;
|
|
|
|
addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc->gdbarch);
|
|
if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
|
|
print_address_bits = addr_bit;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return print_address_bits;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* See breakpoint.h. */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
print_breakpoint (breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *dummy_loc = NULL;
|
|
print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, 0);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Return true if this breakpoint was set by the user, false if it is
|
|
internal or momentary. */
|
|
|
|
int
|
|
user_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
return b->number > 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* See breakpoint.h. */
|
|
|
|
int
|
|
pending_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
return b->loc == NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Print information on breakpoints (including watchpoints and tracepoints).
|
|
|
|
If non-NULL, BP_NUM_LIST is a list of numbers and number ranges as
|
|
understood by number_or_range_parser. Only breakpoints included in this
|
|
list are then printed.
|
|
|
|
If SHOW_INTERNAL is true, print internal breakpoints.
|
|
|
|
If FILTER is non-NULL, call it on each breakpoint and only include the
|
|
ones for which it returns true.
|
|
|
|
Return the total number of breakpoints listed. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
breakpoint_1 (const char *bp_num_list, bool show_internal,
|
|
bool (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
struct bp_location *last_loc = NULL;
|
|
int nr_printable_breakpoints;
|
|
struct value_print_options opts;
|
|
int print_address_bits = 0;
|
|
int print_type_col_width = 14;
|
|
struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
|
|
|
|
get_user_print_options (&opts);
|
|
|
|
/* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the size
|
|
required for address fields. */
|
|
nr_printable_breakpoints = 0;
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
|
|
{
|
|
/* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
|
|
if (filter && !filter (b))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* If we have a BP_NUM_LIST string, it is a list of breakpoints to
|
|
accept. Skip the others. */
|
|
if (bp_num_list != NULL && *bp_num_list != '\0')
|
|
{
|
|
if (show_internal && parse_and_eval_long (bp_num_list) != b->number)
|
|
continue;
|
|
if (!show_internal && !number_is_in_list (bp_num_list, b->number))
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (show_internal || user_breakpoint_p (b))
|
|
{
|
|
int addr_bit, type_len;
|
|
|
|
addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
|
|
if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
|
|
print_address_bits = addr_bit;
|
|
|
|
type_len = strlen (bptype_string (b->type));
|
|
if (type_len > print_type_col_width)
|
|
print_type_col_width = type_len;
|
|
|
|
nr_printable_breakpoints++;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
ui_out_emit_table table_emitter (uiout,
|
|
opts.addressprint ? 6 : 5,
|
|
nr_printable_breakpoints,
|
|
"BreakpointTable");
|
|
|
|
if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
|
|
annotate_breakpoints_headers ();
|
|
if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
|
|
annotate_field (0);
|
|
uiout->table_header (7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */
|
|
if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
|
|
annotate_field (1);
|
|
uiout->table_header (print_type_col_width, ui_left, "type", "Type"); /* 2 */
|
|
if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
|
|
annotate_field (2);
|
|
uiout->table_header (4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */
|
|
if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
|
|
annotate_field (3);
|
|
uiout->table_header (3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */
|
|
if (opts.addressprint)
|
|
{
|
|
if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
|
|
annotate_field (4);
|
|
if (print_address_bits <= 32)
|
|
uiout->table_header (10, ui_left, "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
|
|
else
|
|
uiout->table_header (18, ui_left, "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
|
|
}
|
|
if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
|
|
annotate_field (5);
|
|
uiout->table_header (40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */
|
|
uiout->table_body ();
|
|
if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
|
|
annotate_breakpoints_table ();
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
|
|
{
|
|
QUIT;
|
|
/* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
|
|
if (filter && !filter (b))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* If we have a BP_NUM_LIST string, it is a list of breakpoints to
|
|
accept. Skip the others. */
|
|
|
|
if (bp_num_list != NULL && *bp_num_list != '\0')
|
|
{
|
|
if (show_internal) /* maintenance info breakpoint */
|
|
{
|
|
if (parse_and_eval_long (bp_num_list) != b->number)
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
else /* all others */
|
|
{
|
|
if (!number_is_in_list (bp_num_list, b->number))
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
/* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the
|
|
show_internal is set. */
|
|
if (show_internal || user_breakpoint_p (b))
|
|
print_one_breakpoint (b, &last_loc, show_internal);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
/* If there's a filter, let the caller decide how to report
|
|
empty list. */
|
|
if (!filter)
|
|
{
|
|
if (bp_num_list == NULL || *bp_num_list == '\0')
|
|
uiout->message ("No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n");
|
|
else
|
|
uiout->message ("No breakpoint or watchpoint matching '%s'.\n",
|
|
bp_num_list);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
if (last_loc && !server_command)
|
|
set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when
|
|
there have been breakpoints? */
|
|
annotate_breakpoints_table_end ();
|
|
|
|
return nr_printable_breakpoints;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Display the value of default-collect in a way that is generally
|
|
compatible with the breakpoint list. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
default_collect_info (void)
|
|
{
|
|
struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
|
|
|
|
/* If it has no value (which is frequently the case), say nothing; a
|
|
message like "No default-collect." gets in user's face when it's
|
|
not wanted. */
|
|
if (!*default_collect)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
/* The following phrase lines up nicely with per-tracepoint collect
|
|
actions. */
|
|
uiout->text ("default collect ");
|
|
uiout->field_string ("default-collect", default_collect);
|
|
uiout->text (" \n");
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
info_breakpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
breakpoint_1 (args, false, NULL);
|
|
|
|
default_collect_info ();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
info_watchpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
int num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, false, is_watchpoint);
|
|
struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
|
|
|
|
if (num_printed == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
|
|
uiout->message ("No watchpoints.\n");
|
|
else
|
|
uiout->message ("No watchpoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
maintenance_info_breakpoints (const char *args, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
breakpoint_1 (args, true, NULL);
|
|
|
|
default_collect_info ();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b,
|
|
struct program_space *pspace,
|
|
CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
|
|
|
|
for (; bl; bl = bl->next)
|
|
{
|
|
if (bl->pspace == pspace
|
|
&& bl->address == pc
|
|
&& (!overlay_debugging || bl->section == section))
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Print a message describing any user-breakpoints set at PC. This
|
|
concerns with logical breakpoints, so we match program spaces, not
|
|
address spaces. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
|
|
struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
|
|
struct obj_section *section, int thread)
|
|
{
|
|
int others = 0;
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
|
|
others += (user_breakpoint_p (b)
|
|
&& breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section));
|
|
if (others > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
if (others == 1)
|
|
printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoint "));
|
|
else /* if (others == ???) */
|
|
printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoints "));
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
|
|
if (user_breakpoint_p (b) && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section))
|
|
{
|
|
others--;
|
|
printf_filtered ("%d", b->number);
|
|
if (b->thread == -1 && thread != -1)
|
|
printf_filtered (" (all threads)");
|
|
else if (b->thread != -1)
|
|
printf_filtered (" (thread %d)", b->thread);
|
|
printf_filtered ("%s%s ",
|
|
((b->enable_state == bp_disabled
|
|
|| b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
|
|
? " (disabled)"
|
|
: ""),
|
|
(others > 1) ? ","
|
|
: ((others == 1) ? " and" : ""));
|
|
}
|
|
current_uiout->message (_("also set at pc %ps.\n"),
|
|
styled_string (address_style.style (),
|
|
paddress (gdbarch, pc)));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of LOC.
|
|
For some breakpoint types, the locations' address members are
|
|
irrelevant and it makes no sense to attempt to compare them to
|
|
other addresses (or use them for any other purpose either).
|
|
|
|
More specifically, software watchpoints and catchpoints that are
|
|
not backed by breakpoints always have a zero valued location
|
|
address and we don't want to mark breakpoints of any of these types
|
|
to be a duplicate of an actual breakpoint location at address
|
|
zero. */
|
|
|
|
static bool
|
|
bl_address_is_meaningful (bp_location *loc)
|
|
{
|
|
return loc->loc_type != bp_loc_other;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns
|
|
true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
|
|
struct bp_location *loc2)
|
|
{
|
|
struct watchpoint *w1 = (struct watchpoint *) loc1->owner;
|
|
struct watchpoint *w2 = (struct watchpoint *) loc2->owner;
|
|
|
|
/* Both of them must exist. */
|
|
gdb_assert (w1 != NULL);
|
|
gdb_assert (w2 != NULL);
|
|
|
|
/* If the target can evaluate the condition expression in hardware,
|
|
then we we need to insert both watchpoints even if they are at
|
|
the same place. Otherwise the watchpoint will only trigger when
|
|
the condition of whichever watchpoint was inserted evaluates to
|
|
true, not giving a chance for GDB to check the condition of the
|
|
other watchpoint. */
|
|
if ((w1->cond_exp
|
|
&& target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc1->address,
|
|
loc1->length,
|
|
loc1->watchpoint_type,
|
|
w1->cond_exp.get ()))
|
|
|| (w2->cond_exp
|
|
&& target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc2->address,
|
|
loc2->length,
|
|
loc2->watchpoint_type,
|
|
w2->cond_exp.get ())))
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
/* Note that this checks the owner's type, not the location's. In
|
|
case the target does not support read watchpoints, but does
|
|
support access watchpoints, we'll have bp_read_watchpoint
|
|
watchpoints with hw_access locations. Those should be considered
|
|
duplicates of hw_read locations. The hw_read locations will
|
|
become hw_access locations later. */
|
|
return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type
|
|
&& loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace
|
|
&& loc1->address == loc2->address
|
|
&& loc1->length == loc2->length);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* See breakpoint.h. */
|
|
|
|
int
|
|
breakpoint_address_match (const address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
|
|
const address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2)
|
|
{
|
|
return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
|
|
|| aspace1 == aspace2)
|
|
&& addr1 == addr2);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Returns true if {ASPACE2,ADDR2} falls within the range determined by
|
|
{ASPACE1,ADDR1,LEN1}. In most targets, this can only be true if ASPACE1
|
|
matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address
|
|
space doesn't really matter. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
breakpoint_address_match_range (const address_space *aspace1,
|
|
CORE_ADDR addr1,
|
|
int len1, const address_space *aspace2,
|
|
CORE_ADDR addr2)
|
|
{
|
|
return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
|
|
|| aspace1 == aspace2)
|
|
&& addr2 >= addr1 && addr2 < addr1 + len1);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Returns true if {ASPACE,ADDR} matches the breakpoint BL. BL may be
|
|
a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a match happens only if ASPACE
|
|
matches the breakpoint's address space. On targets that have global
|
|
breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
|
|
const address_space *aspace,
|
|
CORE_ADDR addr)
|
|
{
|
|
return (breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
|
|
aspace, addr)
|
|
|| (bl->length
|
|
&& breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace,
|
|
bl->address, bl->length,
|
|
aspace, addr)));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Returns true if the [ADDR,ADDR+LEN) range in ASPACE overlaps
|
|
breakpoint BL. BL may be a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a
|
|
match happens only if ASPACE matches the breakpoint's address
|
|
space. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address space
|
|
doesn't really matter. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *bl,
|
|
const address_space *aspace,
|
|
CORE_ADDR addr, int len)
|
|
{
|
|
if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
|
|
|| bl->pspace->aspace == aspace)
|
|
{
|
|
int bl_len = bl->length != 0 ? bl->length : 1;
|
|
|
|
if (mem_ranges_overlap (addr, len, bl->address, bl_len))
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If LOC1 and LOC2's owners are not tracepoints, returns false directly.
|
|
Then, if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same tracepoint location, returns
|
|
true, otherwise returns false. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
tracepoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
|
|
struct bp_location *loc2)
|
|
{
|
|
if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) && is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
|
|
/* Since tracepoint locations are never duplicated with others', tracepoint
|
|
locations at the same address of different tracepoints are regarded as
|
|
different locations. */
|
|
return (loc1->address == loc2->address && loc1->owner == loc2->owner);
|
|
else
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses
|
|
(bl_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent
|
|
the same location. If SW_HW_BPS_MATCH is true, then software
|
|
breakpoint locations and hardware breakpoint locations match,
|
|
otherwise they don't. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
|
|
struct bp_location *loc2,
|
|
bool sw_hw_bps_match)
|
|
{
|
|
int hw_point1, hw_point2;
|
|
|
|
/* Both of them must not be in moribund_locations. */
|
|
gdb_assert (loc1->owner != NULL);
|
|
gdb_assert (loc2->owner != NULL);
|
|
|
|
hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner);
|
|
hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner);
|
|
|
|
if (hw_point1 != hw_point2)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
else if (hw_point1)
|
|
return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
|
|
else if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) || is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
|
|
return tracepoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
|
|
else
|
|
/* We compare bp_location.length in order to cover ranged
|
|
breakpoints. Keep this in sync with
|
|
bp_location_is_less_than. */
|
|
return (breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace, loc1->address,
|
|
loc2->pspace->aspace, loc2->address)
|
|
&& (loc1->loc_type == loc2->loc_type || sw_hw_bps_match)
|
|
&& loc1->length == loc2->length);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr,
|
|
int bnum, int have_bnum)
|
|
{
|
|
/* The longest string possibly returned by hex_string_custom
|
|
is 50 chars. These must be at least that big for safety. */
|
|
char astr1[64];
|
|
char astr2[64];
|
|
|
|
strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8));
|
|
strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8));
|
|
if (have_bnum)
|
|
warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."),
|
|
bnum, astr1, astr2);
|
|
else
|
|
warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural
|
|
constraints on breakpoint placement. Return the adjusted address.
|
|
Note: Very few targets require this kind of adjustment. For most
|
|
targets, this function is simply the identity function. */
|
|
|
|
static CORE_ADDR
|
|
adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
|
|
CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype)
|
|
{
|
|
if (bptype == bp_watchpoint
|
|
|| bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint
|
|
|| bptype == bp_read_watchpoint
|
|
|| bptype == bp_access_watchpoint
|
|
|| bptype == bp_catchpoint)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not
|
|
have their addresses modified. */
|
|
return bpaddr;
|
|
}
|
|
else if (bptype == bp_single_step)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Single-step breakpoints should not have their addresses
|
|
modified. If there's any architectural constrain that
|
|
applies to this address, then it should have already been
|
|
taken into account when the breakpoint was created in the
|
|
first place. If we didn't do this, stepping through e.g.,
|
|
Thumb-2 IT blocks would break. */
|
|
return bpaddr;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr = bpaddr;
|
|
|
|
if (gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch))
|
|
{
|
|
/* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement
|
|
of breakpoint instructions. Obtain the adjusted address. */
|
|
adjusted_bpaddr = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
adjusted_bpaddr = address_significant (gdbarch, adjusted_bpaddr);
|
|
|
|
/* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter
|
|
a user's expectations. Print a warning if an adjustment
|
|
is required. */
|
|
if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr)
|
|
breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, 0);
|
|
|
|
return adjusted_bpaddr;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static bp_loc_type
|
|
bp_location_from_bp_type (bptype type)
|
|
{
|
|
switch (type)
|
|
{
|
|
case bp_breakpoint:
|
|
case bp_single_step:
|
|
case bp_until:
|
|
case bp_finish:
|
|
case bp_longjmp:
|
|
case bp_longjmp_resume:
|
|
case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
|
|
case bp_exception:
|
|
case bp_exception_resume:
|
|
case bp_step_resume:
|
|
case bp_hp_step_resume:
|
|
case bp_watchpoint_scope:
|
|
case bp_call_dummy:
|
|
case bp_std_terminate:
|
|
case bp_shlib_event:
|
|
case bp_thread_event:
|
|
case bp_overlay_event:
|
|
case bp_jit_event:
|
|
case bp_longjmp_master:
|
|
case bp_std_terminate_master:
|
|
case bp_exception_master:
|
|
case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
|
|
case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
|
|
case bp_dprintf:
|
|
return bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
|
|
case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
|
|
return bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
|
|
case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
|
|
case bp_read_watchpoint:
|
|
case bp_access_watchpoint:
|
|
return bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint;
|
|
case bp_watchpoint:
|
|
case bp_catchpoint:
|
|
case bp_tracepoint:
|
|
case bp_fast_tracepoint:
|
|
case bp_static_tracepoint:
|
|
return bp_loc_other;
|
|
default:
|
|
internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unknown breakpoint type"));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bp_location::bp_location (breakpoint *owner, bp_loc_type type)
|
|
{
|
|
this->owner = owner;
|
|
this->cond_bytecode = NULL;
|
|
this->shlib_disabled = 0;
|
|
this->enabled = 1;
|
|
|
|
this->loc_type = type;
|
|
|
|
if (this->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
|
|
|| this->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
|
|
mark_breakpoint_location_modified (this);
|
|
|
|
this->refc = 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bp_location::bp_location (breakpoint *owner)
|
|
: bp_location::bp_location (owner,
|
|
bp_location_from_bp_type (owner->type))
|
|
{
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Allocate a struct bp_location. */
|
|
|
|
static struct bp_location *
|
|
allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt)
|
|
{
|
|
return bpt->ops->allocate_location (bpt);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc)
|
|
{
|
|
delete loc;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Increment reference count. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl)
|
|
{
|
|
++bl->refc;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Decrement reference count. If the reference count reaches 0,
|
|
destroy the bp_location. Sets *BLP to NULL. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **blp)
|
|
{
|
|
gdb_assert ((*blp)->refc > 0);
|
|
|
|
if (--(*blp)->refc == 0)
|
|
free_bp_location (*blp);
|
|
*blp = NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Add breakpoint B at the end of the global breakpoint chain. */
|
|
|
|
static breakpoint *
|
|
add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&b)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b1;
|
|
struct breakpoint *result = b.get ();
|
|
|
|
/* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain so that a list of
|
|
breakpoints will come out in order of increasing numbers. */
|
|
|
|
b1 = breakpoint_chain;
|
|
if (b1 == 0)
|
|
breakpoint_chain = b.release ();
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
while (b1->next)
|
|
b1 = b1->next;
|
|
b1->next = b.release ();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return result;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Initializes breakpoint B with type BPTYPE and no locations yet. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct breakpoint *b,
|
|
struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
|
|
enum bptype bptype,
|
|
const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
|
|
{
|
|
gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
|
|
|
|
b->ops = ops;
|
|
b->type = bptype;
|
|
b->gdbarch = gdbarch;
|
|
b->language = current_language->la_language;
|
|
b->input_radix = input_radix;
|
|
b->related_breakpoint = b;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Helper to set_raw_breakpoint below. Creates a breakpoint
|
|
that has type BPTYPE and has no locations as yet. */
|
|
|
|
static struct breakpoint *
|
|
set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
|
|
enum bptype bptype,
|
|
const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
|
|
{
|
|
std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype);
|
|
|
|
init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, bptype, ops);
|
|
return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Initialize loc->function_name. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc)
|
|
{
|
|
gdb_assert (loc->owner != NULL);
|
|
|
|
if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint
|
|
|| loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
|
|
|| is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
|
|
{
|
|
const char *function_name;
|
|
|
|
if (loc->msymbol != NULL
|
|
&& (MSYMBOL_TYPE (loc->msymbol) == mst_text_gnu_ifunc
|
|
|| MSYMBOL_TYPE (loc->msymbol) == mst_data_gnu_ifunc))
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
|
|
|
|
function_name = loc->msymbol->linkage_name ();
|
|
|
|
if (b->type == bp_breakpoint && b->loc == loc
|
|
&& loc->next == NULL && b->related_breakpoint == b)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Create only the whole new breakpoint of this type but do not
|
|
mess more complicated breakpoints with multiple locations. */
|
|
b->type = bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver;
|
|
/* Remember the resolver's address for use by the return
|
|
breakpoint. */
|
|
loc->related_address = loc->address;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
find_pc_partial_function (loc->address, &function_name, NULL, NULL);
|
|
|
|
if (function_name)
|
|
loc->function_name = xstrdup (function_name);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL. */
|
|
struct gdbarch *
|
|
get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal)
|
|
{
|
|
if (sal.section)
|
|
return sal.section->objfile->arch ();
|
|
if (sal.symtab)
|
|
return SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal.symtab)->arch ();
|
|
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Low level routine for partially initializing a breakpoint of type
|
|
BPTYPE. The newly created breakpoint's address, section, source
|
|
file name, and line number are provided by SAL.
|
|
|
|
It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
|
|
the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
|
|
information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
init_raw_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
|
|
struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
|
|
const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
|
|
{
|
|
init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, bptype, ops);
|
|
|
|
add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
|
|
|
|
if (bptype != bp_catchpoint)
|
|
gdb_assert (sal.pspace != NULL);
|
|
|
|
/* Store the program space that was used to set the breakpoint,
|
|
except for ordinary breakpoints, which are independent of the
|
|
program space. */
|
|
if (bptype != bp_breakpoint && bptype != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
|
|
b->pspace = sal.pspace;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* set_raw_breakpoint is a low level routine for allocating and
|
|
partially initializing a breakpoint of type BPTYPE. The newly
|
|
created breakpoint's address, section, source file name, and line
|
|
number are provided by SAL. The newly created and partially
|
|
initialized breakpoint is added to the breakpoint chain and
|
|
is also returned as the value of this function.
|
|
|
|
It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
|
|
the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
|
|
information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. In
|
|
particular, set_raw_breakpoint does NOT set the breakpoint
|
|
number! Care should be taken to not allow an error to occur
|
|
prior to completing the initialization of the breakpoint. If this
|
|
should happen, a bogus breakpoint will be left on the chain. */
|
|
|
|
struct breakpoint *
|
|
set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
|
|
struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
|
|
const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
|
|
{
|
|
std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype);
|
|
|
|
init_raw_breakpoint (b.get (), gdbarch, sal, bptype, ops);
|
|
return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint
|
|
if we do a longjmp() or 'throw' in TP. FRAME is the frame which
|
|
initiated the operation. */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
set_longjmp_breakpoint (struct thread_info *tp, struct frame_id frame)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
|
|
int thread = tp->global_num;
|
|
|
|
/* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step,
|
|
we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled
|
|
longjmp "master" breakpoints. Here, we simply create momentary
|
|
clones of those and enable them for the requested thread. */
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
|
|
if (b->pspace == current_program_space
|
|
&& (b->type == bp_longjmp_master
|
|
|| b->type == bp_exception_master))
|
|
{
|
|
enum bptype type = b->type == bp_longjmp_master ? bp_longjmp : bp_exception;
|
|
struct breakpoint *clone;
|
|
|
|
/* longjmp_breakpoint_ops ensures INITIATING_FRAME is cleared again
|
|
after their removal. */
|
|
clone = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, type,
|
|
&momentary_breakpoint_ops, 1);
|
|
clone->thread = thread;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
tp->initiating_frame = frame;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD. */
|
|
void
|
|
delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
|
|
if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
|
|
{
|
|
if (b->thread == thread)
|
|
delete_breakpoint (b);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
delete_longjmp_breakpoint_at_next_stop (int thread)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
|
|
if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
|
|
{
|
|
if (b->thread == thread)
|
|
b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Place breakpoints of type bp_longjmp_call_dummy to catch longjmp for
|
|
INFERIOR_PTID thread. Chain them all by RELATED_BREAKPOINT and return
|
|
pointer to any of them. Return NULL if this system cannot place longjmp
|
|
breakpoints. */
|
|
|
|
struct breakpoint *
|
|
set_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (void)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b, *retval = NULL;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
|
|
if (b->pspace == current_program_space && b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *new_b;
|
|
|
|
new_b = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_longjmp_call_dummy,
|
|
&momentary_breakpoint_ops,
|
|
1);
|
|
new_b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num;
|
|
|
|
/* Link NEW_B into the chain of RETVAL breakpoints. */
|
|
|
|
gdb_assert (new_b->related_breakpoint == new_b);
|
|
if (retval == NULL)
|
|
retval = new_b;
|
|
new_b->related_breakpoint = retval;
|
|
while (retval->related_breakpoint != new_b->related_breakpoint)
|
|
retval = retval->related_breakpoint;
|
|
retval->related_breakpoint = new_b;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return retval;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Verify all existing dummy frames and their associated breakpoints for
|
|
TP. Remove those which can no longer be found in the current frame
|
|
stack.
|
|
|
|
You should call this function only at places where it is safe to currently
|
|
unwind the whole stack. Failed stack unwind would discard live dummy
|
|
frames. */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
check_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (struct thread_info *tp)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
|
|
if (b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy && b->thread == tp->global_num)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *dummy_b = b->related_breakpoint;
|
|
|
|
while (dummy_b != b && dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy)
|
|
dummy_b = dummy_b->related_breakpoint;
|
|
if (dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy
|
|
|| frame_find_by_id (dummy_b->frame_id) != NULL)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
dummy_frame_discard (dummy_b->frame_id, tp);
|
|
|
|
while (b->related_breakpoint != b)
|
|
{
|
|
if (b_tmp == b->related_breakpoint)
|
|
b_tmp = b->related_breakpoint->next;
|
|
delete_breakpoint (b->related_breakpoint);
|
|
}
|
|
delete_breakpoint (b);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
enable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
|
|
if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
|
|
{
|
|
b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
|
|
update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
|
|
overlay_events_enabled = 1;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
disable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
|
|
if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
|
|
{
|
|
b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
|
|
update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
|
|
overlay_events_enabled = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Set an active std::terminate breakpoint for each std::terminate
|
|
master breakpoint. */
|
|
void
|
|
set_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
|
|
if (b->pspace == current_program_space
|
|
&& b->type == bp_std_terminate_master)
|
|
{
|
|
momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_std_terminate,
|
|
&momentary_breakpoint_ops, 1);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Delete all the std::terminate breakpoints. */
|
|
void
|
|
delete_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
|
|
if (b->type == bp_std_terminate)
|
|
delete_breakpoint (b);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
struct breakpoint *
|
|
create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
|
|
b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event,
|
|
&internal_breakpoint_ops);
|
|
|
|
b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
|
|
/* location has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me. */
|
|
b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address, NULL, 0);
|
|
|
|
update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
|
|
|
|
return b;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
struct lang_and_radix
|
|
{
|
|
enum language lang;
|
|
int radix;
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration. */
|
|
|
|
struct breakpoint *
|
|
create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
|
|
{
|
|
return create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event,
|
|
&internal_breakpoint_ops);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Remove JIT code registration and unregistration breakpoint(s). */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
remove_jit_event_breakpoints (void)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
|
|
if (b->type == bp_jit_event
|
|
&& b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
|
|
delete_breakpoint (b);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
|
|
if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
|
|
&& b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
|
|
delete_breakpoint (b);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* See breakpoint.h. */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
remove_solib_event_breakpoints_at_next_stop (void)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
|
|
if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
|
|
&& b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
|
|
b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Helper for create_solib_event_breakpoint /
|
|
create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint. Allows specifying which
|
|
INSERT_MODE to pass through to update_global_location_list. */
|
|
|
|
static struct breakpoint *
|
|
create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address,
|
|
enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
|
|
b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event,
|
|
&internal_breakpoint_ops);
|
|
update_global_location_list_nothrow (insert_mode);
|
|
return b;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
struct breakpoint *
|
|
create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
|
|
{
|
|
return create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* See breakpoint.h. */
|
|
|
|
struct breakpoint *
|
|
create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
|
|
/* Explicitly tell update_global_location_list to insert
|
|
locations. */
|
|
b = create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_INSERT);
|
|
if (!b->loc->inserted)
|
|
{
|
|
delete_breakpoint (b);
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
return b;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries. Only
|
|
apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
|
|
{
|
|
/* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
|
|
struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
|
|
|
|
/* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled for
|
|
those with loc->duplicate set. This is so that when breakpoint
|
|
becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to
|
|
insert all breakpoints. If we don't set shlib_disabled here,
|
|
we'll try to insert those breakpoints and fail. */
|
|
if (((b->type == bp_breakpoint)
|
|
|| (b->type == bp_jit_event)
|
|
|| (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
|
|
|| (is_tracepoint (b)))
|
|
&& loc->pspace == current_program_space
|
|
&& !loc->shlib_disabled
|
|
&& solib_name_from_address (loc->pspace, loc->address)
|
|
)
|
|
{
|
|
loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints that are in SOLIB upon
|
|
notification of unloaded_shlib. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
|
|
disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list *solib)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
|
|
int disabled_shlib_breaks = 0;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
|
|
{
|
|
/* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
|
|
struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
|
|
|
|
if (solib->pspace == loc->pspace
|
|
&& !loc->shlib_disabled
|
|
&& (((b->type == bp_breakpoint
|
|
|| b->type == bp_jit_event
|
|
|| b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
|
|
&& (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
|
|
|| loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint))
|
|
|| is_tracepoint (b))
|
|
&& solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc->address))
|
|
{
|
|
loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
|
|
/* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint
|
|
succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted
|
|
to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints. */
|
|
loc->inserted = 0;
|
|
|
|
/* This may cause duplicate notifications for the same breakpoint. */
|
|
gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
|
|
|
|
if (!disabled_shlib_breaks)
|
|
{
|
|
target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
|
|
warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints "
|
|
"for unloaded shared library \"%s\""),
|
|
solib->so_name);
|
|
}
|
|
disabled_shlib_breaks = 1;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints in OBJFILE upon
|
|
notification of free_objfile. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
|
|
disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
|
|
if (objfile == NULL)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
/* OBJF_SHARED|OBJF_USERLOADED objfiles are dynamic modules manually
|
|
managed by the user with add-symbol-file/remove-symbol-file.
|
|
Similarly to how breakpoints in shared libraries are handled in
|
|
response to "nosharedlibrary", mark breakpoints in such modules
|
|
shlib_disabled so they end up uninserted on the next global
|
|
location list update. Shared libraries not loaded by the user
|
|
aren't handled here -- they're already handled in
|
|
disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib, called by solib.c's
|
|
solib_unloaded observer. We skip objfiles that are not
|
|
OBJF_SHARED as those aren't considered dynamic objects (e.g. the
|
|
main objfile). */
|
|
if ((objfile->flags & OBJF_SHARED) == 0
|
|
|| (objfile->flags & OBJF_USERLOADED) == 0)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *loc;
|
|
int bp_modified = 0;
|
|
|
|
if (!is_breakpoint (b) && !is_tracepoint (b))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
for (loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
|
|
{
|
|
CORE_ADDR loc_addr = loc->address;
|
|
|
|
if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
|
|
&& loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if (loc->shlib_disabled != 0)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if (objfile->pspace != loc->pspace)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
|
|
&& loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if (is_addr_in_objfile (loc_addr, objfile))
|
|
{
|
|
loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
|
|
/* At this point, we don't know whether the object was
|
|
unmapped from the inferior or not, so leave the
|
|
inserted flag alone. We'll handle failure to
|
|
uninsert quietly, in case the object was indeed
|
|
unmapped. */
|
|
|
|
mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
|
|
|
|
bp_modified = 1;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (bp_modified)
|
|
gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* FORK & VFORK catchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
/* An instance of this type is used to represent a fork or vfork
|
|
catchpoint. A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points
|
|
to CATCH_FORK_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
|
|
|
|
struct fork_catchpoint : public breakpoint
|
|
{
|
|
/* Process id of a child process whose forking triggered this
|
|
catchpoint. This field is only valid immediately after this
|
|
catchpoint has triggered. */
|
|
ptid_t forked_inferior_pid;
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for fork
|
|
catchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
insert_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl)
|
|
{
|
|
return target_insert_fork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for fork
|
|
catchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
remove_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
|
|
{
|
|
return target_remove_fork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for fork
|
|
catchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
breakpoint_hit_catch_fork (const struct bp_location *bl,
|
|
const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
|
|
const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
|
|
{
|
|
struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
|
|
|
|
if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_FORKED)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for fork
|
|
catchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static enum print_stop_action
|
|
print_it_catch_fork (bpstat bs)
|
|
{
|
|
struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
|
|
struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
|
|
struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
|
|
|
|
annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
|
|
maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
|
|
if (b->disposition == disp_del)
|
|
uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
|
|
else
|
|
uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
|
|
if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
|
|
{
|
|
uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FORK));
|
|
uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
|
|
}
|
|
uiout->field_signed ("bkptno", b->number);
|
|
uiout->text (" (forked process ");
|
|
uiout->field_signed ("newpid", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
|
|
uiout->text ("), ");
|
|
return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for fork
|
|
catchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
print_one_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
|
|
{
|
|
struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
|
|
struct value_print_options opts;
|
|
struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
|
|
|
|
get_user_print_options (&opts);
|
|
|
|
/* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
|
|
line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
|
|
readable). */
|
|
if (opts.addressprint)
|
|
uiout->field_skip ("addr");
|
|
annotate_field (5);
|
|
uiout->text ("fork");
|
|
if (c->forked_inferior_pid != null_ptid)
|
|
{
|
|
uiout->text (", process ");
|
|
uiout->field_signed ("what", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
|
|
uiout->spaces (1);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
|
|
uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "fork");
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for fork
|
|
catchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
print_mention_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (fork)"), b->number);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for fork
|
|
catchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
print_recreate_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
|
|
{
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch fork");
|
|
print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in fork catchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static struct breakpoint_ops catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
|
|
catchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
insert_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl)
|
|
{
|
|
return target_insert_vfork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
|
|
catchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
remove_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
|
|
{
|
|
return target_remove_vfork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
|
|
catchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork (const struct bp_location *bl,
|
|
const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
|
|
const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
|
|
{
|
|
struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
|
|
|
|
if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_VFORKED)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
|
|
catchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static enum print_stop_action
|
|
print_it_catch_vfork (bpstat bs)
|
|
{
|
|
struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
|
|
struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
|
|
struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
|
|
|
|
annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
|
|
maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
|
|
if (b->disposition == disp_del)
|
|
uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
|
|
else
|
|
uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
|
|
if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
|
|
{
|
|
uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_VFORK));
|
|
uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
|
|
}
|
|
uiout->field_signed ("bkptno", b->number);
|
|
uiout->text (" (vforked process ");
|
|
uiout->field_signed ("newpid", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
|
|
uiout->text ("), ");
|
|
return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
|
|
catchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
print_one_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
|
|
{
|
|
struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
|
|
struct value_print_options opts;
|
|
struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
|
|
|
|
get_user_print_options (&opts);
|
|
/* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
|
|
line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
|
|
readable). */
|
|
if (opts.addressprint)
|
|
uiout->field_skip ("addr");
|
|
annotate_field (5);
|
|
uiout->text ("vfork");
|
|
if (c->forked_inferior_pid != null_ptid)
|
|
{
|
|
uiout->text (", process ");
|
|
uiout->field_signed ("what", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
|
|
uiout->spaces (1);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
|
|
uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "vfork");
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
|
|
catchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
print_mention_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (vfork)"), b->number);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
|
|
catchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
print_recreate_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
|
|
{
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch vfork");
|
|
print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in vfork catchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static struct breakpoint_ops catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
|
|
/* An instance of this type is used to represent an solib catchpoint.
|
|
A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
|
|
CATCH_SOLIB_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
|
|
|
|
struct solib_catchpoint : public breakpoint
|
|
{
|
|
~solib_catchpoint () override;
|
|
|
|
/* True for "catch load", false for "catch unload". */
|
|
unsigned char is_load;
|
|
|
|
/* Regular expression to match, if any. COMPILED is only valid when
|
|
REGEX is non-NULL. */
|
|
char *regex;
|
|
std::unique_ptr<compiled_regex> compiled;
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
solib_catchpoint::~solib_catchpoint ()
|
|
{
|
|
xfree (this->regex);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
insert_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore)
|
|
{
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
remove_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
|
|
{
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
breakpoint_hit_catch_solib (const struct bp_location *bl,
|
|
const address_space *aspace,
|
|
CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
|
|
const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
|
|
{
|
|
struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
|
|
struct breakpoint *other;
|
|
|
|
if (ws->kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
|
|
return 1;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *other_bl;
|
|
|
|
if (other == bl->owner)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if (other->type != bp_shlib_event)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if (self->pspace != NULL && other->pspace != self->pspace)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
for (other_bl = other->loc; other_bl != NULL; other_bl = other_bl->next)
|
|
{
|
|
if (other->ops->breakpoint_hit (other_bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
check_status_catch_solib (struct bpstats *bs)
|
|
{
|
|
struct solib_catchpoint *self
|
|
= (struct solib_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
|
|
|
|
if (self->is_load)
|
|
{
|
|
for (so_list *iter : current_program_space->added_solibs)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!self->regex
|
|
|| self->compiled->exec (iter->so_name, 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
for (const std::string &iter : current_program_space->deleted_solibs)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!self->regex
|
|
|| self->compiled->exec (iter.c_str (), 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bs->stop = 0;
|
|
bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static enum print_stop_action
|
|
print_it_catch_solib (bpstat bs)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
|
|
struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
|
|
|
|
annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
|
|
maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
|
|
if (b->disposition == disp_del)
|
|
uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
|
|
else
|
|
uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
|
|
uiout->field_signed ("bkptno", b->number);
|
|
uiout->text ("\n");
|
|
if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
|
|
uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
|
|
print_solib_event (1);
|
|
return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
print_one_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **locs)
|
|
{
|
|
struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
|
|
struct value_print_options opts;
|
|
struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
|
|
|
|
get_user_print_options (&opts);
|
|
/* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
|
|
line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
|
|
readable). */
|
|
if (opts.addressprint)
|
|
{
|
|
annotate_field (4);
|
|
uiout->field_skip ("addr");
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
std::string msg;
|
|
annotate_field (5);
|
|
if (self->is_load)
|
|
{
|
|
if (self->regex)
|
|
msg = string_printf (_("load of library matching %s"), self->regex);
|
|
else
|
|
msg = _("load of library");
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
if (self->regex)
|
|
msg = string_printf (_("unload of library matching %s"), self->regex);
|
|
else
|
|
msg = _("unload of library");
|
|
}
|
|
uiout->field_string ("what", msg);
|
|
|
|
if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
|
|
uiout->field_string ("catch-type", self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
print_mention_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
|
|
|
|
printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (%s)"), b->number,
|
|
self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
print_recreate_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
|
|
{
|
|
struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
|
|
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "%s %s",
|
|
b->disposition == disp_del ? "tcatch" : "catch",
|
|
self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
|
|
if (self->regex)
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", self->regex);
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static struct breakpoint_ops catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
|
|
/* Shared helper function (MI and CLI) for creating and installing
|
|
a shared object event catchpoint. If IS_LOAD is non-zero then
|
|
the events to be caught are load events, otherwise they are
|
|
unload events. If IS_TEMP is non-zero the catchpoint is a
|
|
temporary one. If ENABLED is non-zero the catchpoint is
|
|
created in an enabled state. */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
add_solib_catchpoint (const char *arg, int is_load, int is_temp, int enabled)
|
|
{
|
|
struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
|
|
|
|
if (!arg)
|
|
arg = "";
|
|
arg = skip_spaces (arg);
|
|
|
|
std::unique_ptr<solib_catchpoint> c (new solib_catchpoint ());
|
|
|
|
if (*arg != '\0')
|
|
{
|
|
c->compiled.reset (new compiled_regex (arg, REG_NOSUB,
|
|
_("Invalid regexp")));
|
|
c->regex = xstrdup (arg);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
c->is_load = is_load;
|
|
init_catchpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, is_temp, NULL,
|
|
&catch_solib_breakpoint_ops);
|
|
|
|
c->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
|
|
|
|
install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* A helper function that does all the work for "catch load" and
|
|
"catch unload". */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
catch_load_or_unload (const char *arg, int from_tty, int is_load,
|
|
struct cmd_list_element *command)
|
|
{
|
|
int tempflag;
|
|
const int enabled = 1;
|
|
|
|
tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
|
|
|
|
add_solib_catchpoint (arg, is_load, tempflag, enabled);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
catch_load_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
|
|
struct cmd_list_element *command)
|
|
{
|
|
catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 1, command);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
catch_unload_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
|
|
struct cmd_list_element *command)
|
|
{
|
|
catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 0, command);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Initialize a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind. If TEMPFLAG
|
|
is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary. If COND_STRING is
|
|
not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint. OPS, if not NULL, is
|
|
the breakpoint_ops structure associated to the catchpoint. */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
init_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
|
|
struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
|
|
const char *cond_string,
|
|
const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
|
|
{
|
|
symtab_and_line sal;
|
|
sal.pspace = current_program_space;
|
|
|
|
init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint, ops);
|
|
|
|
b->cond_string = (cond_string == NULL) ? NULL : xstrdup (cond_string);
|
|
b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
install_breakpoint (int internal, std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&arg, int update_gll)
|
|
{
|
|
breakpoint *b = add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (arg));
|
|
set_breakpoint_number (internal, b);
|
|
if (is_tracepoint (b))
|
|
set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
|
|
if (!internal)
|
|
mention (b);
|
|
gdb::observers::breakpoint_created.notify (b);
|
|
|
|
if (update_gll)
|
|
update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
|
|
int tempflag, const char *cond_string,
|
|
const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
|
|
{
|
|
std::unique_ptr<fork_catchpoint> c (new fork_catchpoint ());
|
|
|
|
init_catchpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
|
|
|
|
c->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
|
|
|
|
install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Exec catchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
/* An instance of this type is used to represent an exec catchpoint.
|
|
A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
|
|
CATCH_EXEC_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
|
|
|
|
struct exec_catchpoint : public breakpoint
|
|
{
|
|
~exec_catchpoint () override;
|
|
|
|
/* Filename of a program whose exec triggered this catchpoint.
|
|
This field is only valid immediately after this catchpoint has
|
|
triggered. */
|
|
char *exec_pathname;
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* Exec catchpoint destructor. */
|
|
|
|
exec_catchpoint::~exec_catchpoint ()
|
|
{
|
|
xfree (this->exec_pathname);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
insert_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl)
|
|
{
|
|
return target_insert_exec_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
remove_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
|
|
{
|
|
return target_remove_exec_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
breakpoint_hit_catch_exec (const struct bp_location *bl,
|
|
const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
|
|
const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
|
|
{
|
|
struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
|
|
|
|
if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_EXECD)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
c->exec_pathname = xstrdup (ws->value.execd_pathname);
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static enum print_stop_action
|
|
print_it_catch_exec (bpstat bs)
|
|
{
|
|
struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
|
|
struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
|
|
struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
|
|
|
|
annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
|
|
maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
|
|
if (b->disposition == disp_del)
|
|
uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
|
|
else
|
|
uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
|
|
if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
|
|
{
|
|
uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_EXEC));
|
|
uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
|
|
}
|
|
uiout->field_signed ("bkptno", b->number);
|
|
uiout->text (" (exec'd ");
|
|
uiout->field_string ("new-exec", c->exec_pathname);
|
|
uiout->text ("), ");
|
|
|
|
return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
print_one_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
|
|
{
|
|
struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
|
|
struct value_print_options opts;
|
|
struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
|
|
|
|
get_user_print_options (&opts);
|
|
|
|
/* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
|
|
not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
|
|
is relatively readable). */
|
|
if (opts.addressprint)
|
|
uiout->field_skip ("addr");
|
|
annotate_field (5);
|
|
uiout->text ("exec");
|
|
if (c->exec_pathname != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
uiout->text (", program \"");
|
|
uiout->field_string ("what", c->exec_pathname);
|
|
uiout->text ("\" ");
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
|
|
uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "exec");
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
print_mention_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (exec)"), b->number);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for exec
|
|
catchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
print_recreate_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
|
|
{
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch exec");
|
|
print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
hw_breakpoint_used_count (void)
|
|
{
|
|
int i = 0;
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
struct bp_location *bl;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
|
|
{
|
|
if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (b))
|
|
for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Special types of hardware breakpoints may use more than
|
|
one register. */
|
|
i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return i;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Returns the resources B would use if it were a hardware
|
|
watchpoint. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
int i = 0;
|
|
struct bp_location *bl;
|
|
|
|
if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Special types of hardware watchpoints may use more than
|
|
one register. */
|
|
i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return i;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Returns the sum the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of
|
|
type TYPE in the breakpoints list. Also returns in OTHER_TYPE_USED
|
|
the sum of the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of other
|
|
types _not_ TYPE. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
|
|
enum bptype type, int *other_type_used)
|
|
{
|
|
int i = 0;
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
|
|
*other_type_used = 0;
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
|
|
{
|
|
if (b == except)
|
|
continue;
|
|
if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if (b->type == type)
|
|
i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b);
|
|
else if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
|
|
*other_type_used = 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return i;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
|
|
{
|
|
if (is_watchpoint (b) && breakpoint_enabled (b))
|
|
{
|
|
b->enable_state = bp_call_disabled;
|
|
update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
|
|
{
|
|
if (is_watchpoint (b) && b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
|
|
{
|
|
b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
|
|
update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void)
|
|
{
|
|
current_program_space->executing_startup = 1;
|
|
update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void)
|
|
{
|
|
current_program_space->executing_startup = 0;
|
|
breakpoint_re_set ();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Create a new single-step breakpoint for thread THREAD, with no
|
|
locations. */
|
|
|
|
static struct breakpoint *
|
|
new_single_step_breakpoint (int thread, struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
|
|
{
|
|
std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b (new breakpoint ());
|
|
|
|
init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, bp_single_step,
|
|
&momentary_breakpoint_ops);
|
|
|
|
b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
|
|
b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
|
|
|
|
b->thread = thread;
|
|
gdb_assert (b->thread != 0);
|
|
|
|
return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Set a momentary breakpoint of type TYPE at address specified by
|
|
SAL. If FRAME_ID is valid, the breakpoint is restricted to that
|
|
frame. */
|
|
|
|
breakpoint_up
|
|
set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal,
|
|
struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
|
|
/* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined or
|
|
tail-called one. */
|
|
gdb_assert (!frame_id_artificial_p (frame_id));
|
|
|
|
b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
|
|
b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
|
|
b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
|
|
b->frame_id = frame_id;
|
|
|
|
b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num;
|
|
|
|
update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
|
|
|
|
return breakpoint_up (b);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Make a momentary breakpoint based on the master breakpoint ORIG.
|
|
The new breakpoint will have type TYPE, use OPS as its
|
|
breakpoint_ops, and will set enabled to LOC_ENABLED. */
|
|
|
|
static struct breakpoint *
|
|
momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
|
|
enum bptype type,
|
|
const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
|
|
int loc_enabled)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *copy;
|
|
|
|
copy = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (orig->gdbarch, type, ops);
|
|
copy->loc = allocate_bp_location (copy);
|
|
set_breakpoint_location_function (copy->loc);
|
|
|
|
copy->loc->gdbarch = orig->loc->gdbarch;
|
|
copy->loc->requested_address = orig->loc->requested_address;
|
|
copy->loc->address = orig->loc->address;
|
|
copy->loc->section = orig->loc->section;
|
|
copy->loc->pspace = orig->loc->pspace;
|
|
copy->loc->probe = orig->loc->probe;
|
|
copy->loc->line_number = orig->loc->line_number;
|
|
copy->loc->symtab = orig->loc->symtab;
|
|
copy->loc->enabled = loc_enabled;
|
|
copy->frame_id = orig->frame_id;
|
|
copy->thread = orig->thread;
|
|
copy->pspace = orig->pspace;
|
|
|
|
copy->enable_state = bp_enabled;
|
|
copy->disposition = disp_donttouch;
|
|
copy->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
|
|
|
|
update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
|
|
return copy;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG. Returns NULL if
|
|
ORIG is NULL. */
|
|
|
|
struct breakpoint *
|
|
clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig)
|
|
{
|
|
/* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing. */
|
|
if (orig == NULL)
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
|
|
return momentary_breakpoint_from_master (orig, orig->type, orig->ops, 0);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
breakpoint_up
|
|
set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc,
|
|
enum bptype type)
|
|
{
|
|
struct symtab_and_line sal;
|
|
|
|
sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
|
|
sal.pc = pc;
|
|
sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
|
|
sal.explicit_pc = 1;
|
|
|
|
return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
mention (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
b->ops->print_mention (b);
|
|
current_uiout->text ("\n");
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
static bool bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc);
|
|
|
|
/* Handle "set breakpoint auto-hw on".
|
|
|
|
If the explicitly specified breakpoint type is not hardware
|
|
breakpoint, check the memory map to see whether the breakpoint
|
|
address is in read-only memory.
|
|
|
|
- location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory is read-only.
|
|
We change the type of the location to hardware breakpoint.
|
|
|
|
- location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is read-write. This
|
|
means we've previously made the location hardware one, but then the
|
|
memory map changed, so we undo.
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
handle_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (bp_location *bl)
|
|
{
|
|
if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints
|
|
&& bl->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint
|
|
&& (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
|
|
|| bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint))
|
|
{
|
|
/* When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will use
|
|
location types we've just set here, the only possible problem
|
|
is that memory map has changed during running program, but
|
|
it's not going to work anyway with current gdb. */
|
|
mem_region *mr = lookup_mem_region (bl->address);
|
|
|
|
if (mr != nullptr)
|
|
{
|
|
enum bp_loc_type new_type;
|
|
|
|
if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
|
|
new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
|
|
else
|
|
new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
|
|
|
|
if (new_type != bl->loc_type)
|
|
{
|
|
static bool said = false;
|
|
|
|
bl->loc_type = new_type;
|
|
if (!said)
|
|
{
|
|
fprintf_filtered (gdb_stdout,
|
|
_("Note: automatically using "
|
|
"hardware breakpoints for "
|
|
"read-only addresses.\n"));
|
|
said = true;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static struct bp_location *
|
|
add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
|
|
const struct symtab_and_line *sal)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
|
|
CORE_ADDR adjusted_address;
|
|
struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
|
|
|
|
if (loc_gdbarch == NULL)
|
|
loc_gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
|
|
|
|
/* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location.
|
|
Once we call allocate_bp_location(), that mostly uninitialized
|
|
location will be placed on the location chain. Adjustment of the
|
|
breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do
|
|
not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and
|
|
location that's only been partially initialized. */
|
|
adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch,
|
|
sal->pc, b->type);
|
|
|
|
/* Sort the locations by their ADDRESS. */
|
|
loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
|
|
for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL && (*tmp)->address <= adjusted_address;
|
|
tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
|
|
;
|
|
loc->next = *tmp;
|
|
*tmp = loc;
|
|
|
|
loc->requested_address = sal->pc;
|
|
loc->address = adjusted_address;
|
|
loc->pspace = sal->pspace;
|
|
loc->probe.prob = sal->prob;
|
|
loc->probe.objfile = sal->objfile;
|
|
gdb_assert (loc->pspace != NULL);
|
|
loc->section = sal->section;
|
|
loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch;
|
|
loc->line_number = sal->line;
|
|
loc->symtab = sal->symtab;
|
|
loc->symbol = sal->symbol;
|
|
loc->msymbol = sal->msymbol;
|
|
loc->objfile = sal->objfile;
|
|
|
|
set_breakpoint_location_function (loc);
|
|
|
|
/* While by definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the
|
|
code, we don't mark the location as inserted. Normally one would expect
|
|
that GDB could rely on that breakpoint instruction to stop the program,
|
|
thus removing the need to insert its own breakpoint, except that executing
|
|
the breakpoint instruction can kill the target instead of reporting a
|
|
SIGTRAP. E.g., on SPARC, when interrupts are disabled, executing the
|
|
instruction resets the CPU, so QEMU 2.0.0 for SPARC correspondingly dies
|
|
with "Trap 0x02 while interrupts disabled, Error state". Letting the
|
|
breakpoint be inserted normally results in QEMU knowing about the GDB
|
|
breakpoint, and thus trap before the breakpoint instruction is executed.
|
|
(If GDB later needs to continue execution past the permanent breakpoint,
|
|
it manually increments the PC, thus avoiding executing the breakpoint
|
|
instruction.) */
|
|
if (bp_loc_is_permanent (loc))
|
|
loc->permanent = 1;
|
|
|
|
return loc;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Return true if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint,
|
|
return false otherwise. */
|
|
|
|
static bool
|
|
bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc)
|
|
{
|
|
gdb_assert (loc != NULL);
|
|
|
|
/* If we have a non-breakpoint-backed catchpoint or a software
|
|
watchpoint, just return 0. We should not attempt to read from
|
|
the addresses the locations of these breakpoint types point to.
|
|
gdbarch_program_breakpoint_here_p, below, will attempt to read
|
|
memory. */
|
|
if (!bl_address_is_meaningful (loc))
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
|
|
switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace);
|
|
return gdbarch_program_breakpoint_here_p (loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Build a command list for the dprintf corresponding to the current
|
|
settings of the dprintf style options. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
update_dprintf_command_list (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
char *dprintf_args = b->extra_string;
|
|
char *printf_line = NULL;
|
|
|
|
if (!dprintf_args)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
|
|
|
|
/* Allow a comma, as it may have terminated a location, but don't
|
|
insist on it. */
|
|
if (*dprintf_args == ',')
|
|
++dprintf_args;
|
|
dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
|
|
|
|
if (*dprintf_args != '"')
|
|
error (_("Bad format string, missing '\"'."));
|
|
|
|
if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_gdb) == 0)
|
|
printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
|
|
else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_call) == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!dprintf_function)
|
|
error (_("No function supplied for dprintf call"));
|
|
|
|
if (dprintf_channel && strlen (dprintf_channel) > 0)
|
|
printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s,%s)",
|
|
dprintf_function,
|
|
dprintf_channel,
|
|
dprintf_args);
|
|
else
|
|
printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s)",
|
|
dprintf_function,
|
|
dprintf_args);
|
|
}
|
|
else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_agent) == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
if (target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
|
|
printf_line = xstrprintf ("agent-printf %s", dprintf_args);
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
warning (_("Target cannot run dprintf commands, falling back to GDB printf"));
|
|
printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
|
|
_("Invalid dprintf style."));
|
|
|
|
gdb_assert (printf_line != NULL);
|
|
|
|
/* Manufacture a printf sequence. */
|
|
struct command_line *printf_cmd_line
|
|
= new struct command_line (simple_control, printf_line);
|
|
breakpoint_set_commands (b, counted_command_line (printf_cmd_line,
|
|
command_lines_deleter ()));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Update all dprintf commands, making their command lists reflect
|
|
current style settings. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
update_dprintf_commands (const char *args, int from_tty,
|
|
struct cmd_list_element *c)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
|
|
{
|
|
if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
|
|
update_dprintf_command_list (b);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Create a breakpoint with SAL as location. Use LOCATION
|
|
as a description of the location, and COND_STRING
|
|
as condition expression. If LOCATION is NULL then create an
|
|
"address location" from the address in the SAL. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
init_breakpoint_sal (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
|
|
gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
|
|
event_location_up &&location,
|
|
gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter,
|
|
gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
|
|
gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
|
|
enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
|
|
int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
|
|
const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
|
|
int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
|
|
int display_canonical)
|
|
{
|
|
int i;
|
|
|
|
if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
|
|
{
|
|
int target_resources_ok;
|
|
|
|
i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
|
|
target_resources_ok =
|
|
target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
|
|
i + 1, 0);
|
|
if (target_resources_ok == 0)
|
|
error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
|
|
else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
|
|
error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
gdb_assert (!sals.empty ());
|
|
|
|
for (const auto &sal : sals)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *loc;
|
|
|
|
if (from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
|
|
if (!loc_gdbarch)
|
|
loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
|
|
|
|
describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
|
|
sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (&sal == &sals[0])
|
|
{
|
|
init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
|
|
b->thread = thread;
|
|
b->task = task;
|
|
|
|
b->cond_string = cond_string.release ();
|
|
b->extra_string = extra_string.release ();
|
|
b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
|
|
b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
|
|
b->disposition = disposition;
|
|
|
|
if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
|
|
b->loc->inserted = 1;
|
|
|
|
if (type == bp_static_tracepoint)
|
|
{
|
|
struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
|
|
struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
|
|
|
|
if (strace_marker_p (b))
|
|
{
|
|
/* We already know the marker exists, otherwise, we
|
|
wouldn't see a sal for it. */
|
|
const char *p
|
|
= &event_location_to_string (b->location.get ())[3];
|
|
const char *endp;
|
|
|
|
p = skip_spaces (p);
|
|
|
|
endp = skip_to_space (p);
|
|
|
|
t->static_trace_marker_id.assign (p, endp - p);
|
|
|
|
printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
|
|
"marker \"%s\"\n"),
|
|
t->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
|
|
}
|
|
else if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (sal.pc, &marker))
|
|
{
|
|
t->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (marker.str_id);
|
|
|
|
printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
|
|
"marker \"%s\"\n"),
|
|
t->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
warning (_("Couldn't determine the static "
|
|
"tracepoint marker to probe"));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
loc = b->loc;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
|
|
if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
|
|
loc->inserted = 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (b->cond_string)
|
|
{
|
|
const char *arg = b->cond_string;
|
|
|
|
loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
|
|
block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
|
|
if (*arg)
|
|
error (_("Garbage '%s' follows condition"), arg);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Dynamic printf requires and uses additional arguments on the
|
|
command line, otherwise it's an error. */
|
|
if (type == bp_dprintf)
|
|
{
|
|
if (b->extra_string)
|
|
update_dprintf_command_list (b);
|
|
else
|
|
error (_("Format string required"));
|
|
}
|
|
else if (b->extra_string)
|
|
error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of command"), b->extra_string);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
b->display_canonical = display_canonical;
|
|
if (location != NULL)
|
|
b->location = std::move (location);
|
|
else
|
|
b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address, NULL, 0);
|
|
b->filter = std::move (filter);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
create_breakpoint_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
|
|
gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
|
|
event_location_up &&location,
|
|
gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter,
|
|
gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
|
|
gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
|
|
enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
|
|
int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
|
|
const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
|
|
int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
|
|
int display_canonical)
|
|
{
|
|
std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (type);
|
|
|
|
init_breakpoint_sal (b.get (), gdbarch,
|
|
sals, std::move (location),
|
|
std::move (filter),
|
|
std::move (cond_string),
|
|
std::move (extra_string),
|
|
type, disposition,
|
|
thread, task, ignore_count,
|
|
ops, from_tty,
|
|
enabled, internal, flags,
|
|
display_canonical);
|
|
|
|
install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (b), 0);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table. For each
|
|
SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i]
|
|
value. COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be
|
|
used for all breakpoints. Essentially the only case where
|
|
SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded
|
|
function. In that case, it's still not possible to specify
|
|
separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so
|
|
we take just a single condition string.
|
|
|
|
NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup
|
|
the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the
|
|
array contents). If the function fails (error() is called), the
|
|
caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING,
|
|
COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
|
|
struct linespec_result *canonical,
|
|
gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
|
|
gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
|
|
enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
|
|
int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
|
|
const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
|
|
int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags)
|
|
{
|
|
if (canonical->pre_expanded)
|
|
gdb_assert (canonical->lsals.size () == 1);
|
|
|
|
for (const auto &lsal : canonical->lsals)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Note that 'location' can be NULL in the case of a plain
|
|
'break', without arguments. */
|
|
event_location_up location
|
|
= (canonical->location != NULL
|
|
? copy_event_location (canonical->location.get ()) : NULL);
|
|
gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter_string
|
|
(lsal.canonical != NULL ? xstrdup (lsal.canonical) : NULL);
|
|
|
|
create_breakpoint_sal (gdbarch, lsal.sals,
|
|
std::move (location),
|
|
std::move (filter_string),
|
|
std::move (cond_string),
|
|
std::move (extra_string),
|
|
type, disposition,
|
|
thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
|
|
from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
|
|
canonical->special_display);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Parse LOCATION which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly
|
|
followed by conditionals. On return, SALS contains an array of SAL
|
|
addresses found. LOCATION points to the end of the SAL (for
|
|
linespec locations).
|
|
|
|
The array and the line spec strings are allocated on the heap, it is
|
|
the caller's responsibility to free them. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
parse_breakpoint_sals (const struct event_location *location,
|
|
struct linespec_result *canonical)
|
|
{
|
|
struct symtab_and_line cursal;
|
|
|
|
if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION)
|
|
{
|
|
const char *spec = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
|
|
|
|
if (spec == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
/* The last displayed codepoint, if it's valid, is our default
|
|
breakpoint address. */
|
|
if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
|
|
{
|
|
/* Set sal's pspace, pc, symtab, and line to the values
|
|
corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info.
|
|
Be sure to reinitialize LINE with NOTCURRENT == 0
|
|
as the breakpoint line number is inappropriate otherwise.
|
|
find_pc_line would adjust PC, re-set it back. */
|
|
symtab_and_line sal = get_last_displayed_sal ();
|
|
CORE_ADDR pc = sal.pc;
|
|
|
|
sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
|
|
|
|
/* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC"
|
|
where PC is the last displayed codepoint's address. So
|
|
make sure to set sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from
|
|
trying to expand the list of sals to include all other
|
|
instances with the same symtab and line. */
|
|
sal.pc = pc;
|
|
sal.explicit_pc = 1;
|
|
|
|
struct linespec_sals lsal;
|
|
lsal.sals = {sal};
|
|
lsal.canonical = NULL;
|
|
|
|
canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
error (_("No default breakpoint address now."));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the
|
|
current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default).
|
|
This should produce the results we want almost all of the
|
|
time while leaving default_breakpoint_* alone.
|
|
|
|
ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which
|
|
may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '['. */
|
|
cursal = get_current_source_symtab_and_line ();
|
|
if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
|
|
{
|
|
const char *spec = NULL;
|
|
|
|
if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION)
|
|
spec = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
|
|
|
|
if (!cursal.symtab
|
|
|| (spec != NULL
|
|
&& strchr ("+-", spec[0]) != NULL
|
|
&& spec[1] != '['))
|
|
{
|
|
decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
|
|
get_last_displayed_symtab (),
|
|
get_last_displayed_line (),
|
|
canonical, NULL, NULL);
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
|
|
cursal.symtab, cursal.line, canonical, NULL, NULL);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Convert each SAL into a real PC. Verify that the PC can be
|
|
inserted as a breakpoint. If it can't throw an error. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
breakpoint_sals_to_pc (std::vector<symtab_and_line> &sals)
|
|
{
|
|
for (auto &sal : sals)
|
|
resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Fast tracepoints may have restrictions on valid locations. For
|
|
instance, a fast tracepoint using a jump instead of a trap will
|
|
likely have to overwrite more bytes than a trap would, and so can
|
|
only be placed where the instruction is longer than the jump, or a
|
|
multi-instruction sequence does not have a jump into the middle of
|
|
it, etc. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
check_fast_tracepoint_sals (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
|
|
gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals)
|
|
{
|
|
for (const auto &sal : sals)
|
|
{
|
|
struct gdbarch *sarch;
|
|
|
|
sarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
|
|
/* We fall back to GDBARCH if there is no architecture
|
|
associated with SAL. */
|
|
if (sarch == NULL)
|
|
sarch = gdbarch;
|
|
std::string msg;
|
|
if (!gdbarch_fast_tracepoint_valid_at (sarch, sal.pc, &msg))
|
|
error (_("May not have a fast tracepoint at %s%s"),
|
|
paddress (sarch, sal.pc), msg.c_str ());
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as
|
|
accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition
|
|
string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD.
|
|
PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed.
|
|
If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL.
|
|
If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
find_condition_and_thread (const char *tok, CORE_ADDR pc,
|
|
char **cond_string, int *thread, int *task,
|
|
char **rest)
|
|
{
|
|
*cond_string = NULL;
|
|
*thread = -1;
|
|
*task = 0;
|
|
*rest = NULL;
|
|
|
|
while (tok && *tok)
|
|
{
|
|
const char *end_tok;
|
|
int toklen;
|
|
const char *cond_start = NULL;
|
|
const char *cond_end = NULL;
|
|
|
|
tok = skip_spaces (tok);
|
|
|
|
if ((*tok == '"' || *tok == ',') && rest)
|
|
{
|
|
*rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
end_tok = skip_to_space (tok);
|
|
|
|
toklen = end_tok - tok;
|
|
|
|
if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
|
|
parse_exp_1 (&tok, pc, block_for_pc (pc), 0);
|
|
cond_end = tok;
|
|
*cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
|
|
}
|
|
else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
const char *tmptok;
|
|
struct thread_info *thr;
|
|
|
|
tok = end_tok + 1;
|
|
thr = parse_thread_id (tok, &tmptok);
|
|
if (tok == tmptok)
|
|
error (_("Junk after thread keyword."));
|
|
*thread = thr->global_num;
|
|
tok = tmptok;
|
|
}
|
|
else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "task", toklen) == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
char *tmptok;
|
|
|
|
tok = end_tok + 1;
|
|
*task = strtol (tok, &tmptok, 0);
|
|
if (tok == tmptok)
|
|
error (_("Junk after task keyword."));
|
|
if (!valid_task_id (*task))
|
|
error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task);
|
|
tok = tmptok;
|
|
}
|
|
else if (rest)
|
|
{
|
|
*rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Decode a static tracepoint marker spec. */
|
|
|
|
static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
|
|
decode_static_tracepoint_spec (const char **arg_p)
|
|
{
|
|
const char *p = &(*arg_p)[3];
|
|
const char *endp;
|
|
|
|
p = skip_spaces (p);
|
|
|
|
endp = skip_to_space (p);
|
|
|
|
std::string marker_str (p, endp - p);
|
|
|
|
std::vector<static_tracepoint_marker> markers
|
|
= target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (marker_str.c_str ());
|
|
if (markers.empty ())
|
|
error (_("No known static tracepoint marker named %s"),
|
|
marker_str.c_str ());
|
|
|
|
std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals;
|
|
sals.reserve (markers.size ());
|
|
|
|
for (const static_tracepoint_marker &marker : markers)
|
|
{
|
|
symtab_and_line sal = find_pc_line (marker.address, 0);
|
|
sal.pc = marker.address;
|
|
sals.push_back (sal);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
*arg_p = endp;
|
|
return sals;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Returns the breakpoint ops appropriate for use with with LOCATION_TYPE and
|
|
according to IS_TRACEPOINT. */
|
|
|
|
static const struct breakpoint_ops *
|
|
breakpoint_ops_for_event_location_type (enum event_location_type location_type,
|
|
bool is_tracepoint)
|
|
{
|
|
if (is_tracepoint)
|
|
{
|
|
if (location_type == PROBE_LOCATION)
|
|
return &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
else
|
|
return &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
if (location_type == PROBE_LOCATION)
|
|
return &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
else
|
|
return &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* See breakpoint.h. */
|
|
|
|
const struct breakpoint_ops *
|
|
breakpoint_ops_for_event_location (const struct event_location *location,
|
|
bool is_tracepoint)
|
|
{
|
|
if (location != nullptr)
|
|
return breakpoint_ops_for_event_location_type
|
|
(event_location_type (location), is_tracepoint);
|
|
return is_tracepoint ? &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops : &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* See breakpoint.h. */
|
|
|
|
int
|
|
create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
|
|
const struct event_location *location,
|
|
const char *cond_string,
|
|
int thread, const char *extra_string,
|
|
int parse_extra,
|
|
int tempflag, enum bptype type_wanted,
|
|
int ignore_count,
|
|
enum auto_boolean pending_break_support,
|
|
const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
|
|
int from_tty, int enabled, int internal,
|
|
unsigned flags)
|
|
{
|
|
struct linespec_result canonical;
|
|
int pending = 0;
|
|
int task = 0;
|
|
int prev_bkpt_count = breakpoint_count;
|
|
|
|
gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
|
|
|
|
/* If extra_string isn't useful, set it to NULL. */
|
|
if (extra_string != NULL && *extra_string == '\0')
|
|
extra_string = NULL;
|
|
|
|
try
|
|
{
|
|
ops->create_sals_from_location (location, &canonical, type_wanted);
|
|
}
|
|
catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
|
|
{
|
|
/* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set
|
|
value. */
|
|
if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
|
|
{
|
|
/* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw
|
|
error. */
|
|
|
|
if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE)
|
|
throw;
|
|
|
|
exception_print (gdb_stderr, e);
|
|
|
|
/* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user
|
|
selects no, then simply return the error code. */
|
|
if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO
|
|
&& !nquery (_("Make %s pending on future shared library load? "),
|
|
bptype_string (type_wanted)))
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
/* At this point, either the user was queried about setting
|
|
a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending
|
|
breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint
|
|
is defaulted on behalf of the user. */
|
|
pending = 1;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
throw;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!pending && canonical.lsals.empty ())
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
/* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses
|
|
are ok for the target. */
|
|
if (!pending)
|
|
{
|
|
for (auto &lsal : canonical.lsals)
|
|
breakpoint_sals_to_pc (lsal.sals);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Fast tracepoints may have additional restrictions on location. */
|
|
if (!pending && type_wanted == bp_fast_tracepoint)
|
|
{
|
|
for (const auto &lsal : canonical.lsals)
|
|
check_fast_tracepoint_sals (gdbarch, lsal.sals);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any
|
|
breakpoints. Allocate a separate condition expression for each
|
|
breakpoint. */
|
|
if (!pending)
|
|
{
|
|
gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string_copy;
|
|
gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string_copy;
|
|
|
|
if (parse_extra)
|
|
{
|
|
char *rest;
|
|
char *cond;
|
|
|
|
const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical.lsals[0];
|
|
|
|
/* Here we only parse 'arg' to separate condition
|
|
from thread number, so parsing in context of first
|
|
sal is OK. When setting the breakpoint we'll
|
|
re-parse it in context of each sal. */
|
|
|
|
find_condition_and_thread (extra_string, lsal.sals[0].pc,
|
|
&cond, &thread, &task, &rest);
|
|
cond_string_copy.reset (cond);
|
|
extra_string_copy.reset (rest);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
if (type_wanted != bp_dprintf
|
|
&& extra_string != NULL && *extra_string != '\0')
|
|
error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of location"), extra_string);
|
|
|
|
/* Create a private copy of condition string. */
|
|
if (cond_string)
|
|
cond_string_copy.reset (xstrdup (cond_string));
|
|
/* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
|
|
if (extra_string)
|
|
extra_string_copy.reset (xstrdup (extra_string));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ops->create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, &canonical,
|
|
std::move (cond_string_copy),
|
|
std::move (extra_string_copy),
|
|
type_wanted,
|
|
tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
|
|
thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
|
|
from_tty, enabled, internal, flags);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
std::unique_ptr <breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (type_wanted);
|
|
|
|
init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, type_wanted, ops);
|
|
b->location = copy_event_location (location);
|
|
|
|
if (parse_extra)
|
|
b->cond_string = NULL;
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* Create a private copy of condition string. */
|
|
b->cond_string = cond_string != NULL ? xstrdup (cond_string) : NULL;
|
|
b->thread = thread;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
|
|
b->extra_string = extra_string != NULL ? xstrdup (extra_string) : NULL;
|
|
b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
|
|
b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
|
|
b->condition_not_parsed = 1;
|
|
b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
|
|
if ((type_wanted != bp_breakpoint
|
|
&& type_wanted != bp_hardware_breakpoint) || thread != -1)
|
|
b->pspace = current_program_space;
|
|
|
|
install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (b), 0);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (canonical.lsals.size () > 1)
|
|
{
|
|
warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\nUse the "
|
|
"\"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."));
|
|
prev_breakpoint_count = prev_bkpt_count;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Set a breakpoint.
|
|
ARG is a string describing breakpoint address,
|
|
condition, and thread.
|
|
FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on,
|
|
and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG
|
|
and BP_TEMPFLAG. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
break_command_1 (const char *arg, int flag, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG;
|
|
enum bptype type_wanted = (flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG
|
|
? bp_hardware_breakpoint
|
|
: bp_breakpoint);
|
|
|
|
event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
|
|
const struct breakpoint_ops *ops = breakpoint_ops_for_event_location
|
|
(location.get (), false /* is_tracepoint */);
|
|
|
|
create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
|
|
location.get (),
|
|
NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
|
|
tempflag, type_wanted,
|
|
0 /* Ignore count */,
|
|
pending_break_support,
|
|
ops,
|
|
from_tty,
|
|
1 /* enabled */,
|
|
0 /* internal */,
|
|
0);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command. */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
|
|
{
|
|
CORE_ADDR pc;
|
|
|
|
if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc))
|
|
error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."),
|
|
sal->line, symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal->symtab));
|
|
sal->pc = pc;
|
|
|
|
/* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a line
|
|
number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
|
|
if (sal->explicit_line)
|
|
skip_prologue_sal (sal);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
const struct blockvector *bv;
|
|
const struct block *b;
|
|
struct symbol *sym;
|
|
|
|
bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b,
|
|
SYMTAB_COMPUNIT (sal->symtab));
|
|
if (bv != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
sym = block_linkage_function (b);
|
|
if (sym != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
fixup_symbol_section (sym, SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal->symtab));
|
|
sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal->symtab),
|
|
sym);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll
|
|
just have to look harder. This case can be executed
|
|
if we have line numbers but no functions (as can
|
|
happen in assembly source). */
|
|
|
|
scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
|
|
switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace);
|
|
|
|
bound_minimal_symbol msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc);
|
|
if (msym.minsym)
|
|
sal->section = MSYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (msym.objfile, msym.minsym);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
break_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
tbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
hbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
thbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
stop_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
printf_filtered (_("Specify the type of breakpoint to set.\n\
|
|
Usage: stop in <function | address>\n\
|
|
stop at <line>\n"));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
stopin_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
int badInput = 0;
|
|
|
|
if (arg == NULL)
|
|
badInput = 1;
|
|
else if (*arg != '*')
|
|
{
|
|
const char *argptr = arg;
|
|
int hasColon = 0;
|
|
|
|
/* Look for a ':'. If this is a line number specification, then
|
|
say it is bad, otherwise, it should be an address or
|
|
function/method name. */
|
|
while (*argptr && !hasColon)
|
|
{
|
|
hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
|
|
argptr++;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (hasColon)
|
|
badInput = (*argptr != ':'); /* Not a class::method */
|
|
else
|
|
badInput = isdigit (*arg); /* a simple line number */
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (badInput)
|
|
printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop in <function | address>\n"));
|
|
else
|
|
break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
stopat_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
int badInput = 0;
|
|
|
|
if (arg == NULL || *arg == '*') /* no line number */
|
|
badInput = 1;
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
const char *argptr = arg;
|
|
int hasColon = 0;
|
|
|
|
/* Look for a ':'. If there is a '::' then get out, otherwise
|
|
it is probably a line number. */
|
|
while (*argptr && !hasColon)
|
|
{
|
|
hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
|
|
argptr++;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (hasColon)
|
|
badInput = (*argptr == ':'); /* we have class::method */
|
|
else
|
|
badInput = !isdigit (*arg); /* not a line number */
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (badInput)
|
|
printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop at LINE\n"));
|
|
else
|
|
break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* The dynamic printf command is mostly like a regular breakpoint, but
|
|
with a prewired command list consisting of a single output command,
|
|
built from extra arguments supplied on the dprintf command
|
|
line. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
dprintf_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
|
|
|
|
/* If non-NULL, ARG should have been advanced past the location;
|
|
the next character must be ','. */
|
|
if (arg != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
if (arg[0] != ',' || arg[1] == '\0')
|
|
error (_("Format string required"));
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* Skip the comma. */
|
|
++arg;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
|
|
location.get (),
|
|
NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
|
|
0, bp_dprintf,
|
|
0 /* Ignore count */,
|
|
pending_break_support,
|
|
&dprintf_breakpoint_ops,
|
|
from_tty,
|
|
1 /* enabled */,
|
|
0 /* internal */,
|
|
0);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
agent_printf_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
error (_("May only run agent-printf on the target"));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for
|
|
ranged breakpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
|
|
const address_space *aspace,
|
|
CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
|
|
const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
|
|
{
|
|
if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
|
|
|| ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
return breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
|
|
bl->length, aspace, bp_addr);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
|
|
ranged breakpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
|
|
{
|
|
return target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
|
|
ranged breakpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static enum print_stop_action
|
|
print_it_ranged_breakpoint (bpstat bs)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
|
|
struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
|
|
struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
|
|
|
|
gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
|
|
|
|
/* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
|
|
gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
|
|
|
|
annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
|
|
|
|
maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
|
|
|
|
if (b->disposition == disp_del)
|
|
uiout->text ("Temporary ranged breakpoint ");
|
|
else
|
|
uiout->text ("Ranged breakpoint ");
|
|
if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
|
|
{
|
|
uiout->field_string ("reason",
|
|
async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
|
|
uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
|
|
}
|
|
uiout->field_signed ("bkptno", b->number);
|
|
uiout->text (", ");
|
|
|
|
return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for
|
|
ranged breakpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
print_one_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
|
|
struct bp_location **last_loc)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
|
|
struct value_print_options opts;
|
|
struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
|
|
|
|
/* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
|
|
gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
|
|
|
|
get_user_print_options (&opts);
|
|
|
|
if (opts.addressprint)
|
|
/* We don't print the address range here, it will be printed later
|
|
by print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint. */
|
|
uiout->field_skip ("addr");
|
|
annotate_field (5);
|
|
print_breakpoint_location (b, bl);
|
|
*last_loc = bl;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
|
|
ranged breakpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
|
|
struct ui_out *uiout)
|
|
{
|
|
CORE_ADDR address_start, address_end;
|
|
struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
|
|
string_file stb;
|
|
|
|
gdb_assert (bl);
|
|
|
|
address_start = bl->address;
|
|
address_end = address_start + bl->length - 1;
|
|
|
|
uiout->text ("\taddress range: ");
|
|
stb.printf ("[%s, %s]",
|
|
print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_start),
|
|
print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_end));
|
|
uiout->field_stream ("addr", stb);
|
|
uiout->text ("\n");
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
|
|
ranged breakpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
print_mention_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
|
|
struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
|
|
|
|
gdb_assert (bl);
|
|
gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
|
|
|
|
uiout->message (_("Hardware assisted ranged breakpoint %d from %s to %s."),
|
|
b->number, paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
|
|
paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address + bl->length - 1));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
|
|
ranged breakpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
|
|
{
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break-range %s, %s",
|
|
event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
|
|
event_location_to_string (b->location_range_end.get ()));
|
|
print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in ranged breakpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static struct breakpoint_ops ranged_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
|
|
/* Find the address where the end of the breakpoint range should be
|
|
placed, given the SAL of the end of the range. This is so that if
|
|
the user provides a line number, the end of the range is set to the
|
|
last instruction of the given line. */
|
|
|
|
static CORE_ADDR
|
|
find_breakpoint_range_end (struct symtab_and_line sal)
|
|
{
|
|
CORE_ADDR end;
|
|
|
|
/* If the user provided a PC value, use it. Otherwise,
|
|
find the address of the end of the given location. */
|
|
if (sal.explicit_pc)
|
|
end = sal.pc;
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
int ret;
|
|
CORE_ADDR start;
|
|
|
|
ret = find_line_pc_range (sal, &start, &end);
|
|
if (!ret)
|
|
error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
|
|
|
|
/* find_line_pc_range returns the start of the next line. */
|
|
end--;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return end;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "break-range" CLI command. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
break_range_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
const char *arg_start;
|
|
struct linespec_result canonical_start, canonical_end;
|
|
int bp_count, can_use_bp, length;
|
|
CORE_ADDR end;
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
|
|
/* We don't support software ranged breakpoints. */
|
|
if (target_ranged_break_num_registers () < 0)
|
|
error (_("This target does not support hardware ranged breakpoints."));
|
|
|
|
bp_count = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
|
|
bp_count += target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
|
|
can_use_bp = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
|
|
bp_count, 0);
|
|
if (can_use_bp < 0)
|
|
error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
|
|
|
|
arg = skip_spaces (arg);
|
|
if (arg == NULL || arg[0] == '\0')
|
|
error(_("No address range specified."));
|
|
|
|
arg_start = arg;
|
|
event_location_up start_location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
|
|
current_language);
|
|
parse_breakpoint_sals (start_location.get (), &canonical_start);
|
|
|
|
if (arg[0] != ',')
|
|
error (_("Too few arguments."));
|
|
else if (canonical_start.lsals.empty ())
|
|
error (_("Could not find location of the beginning of the range."));
|
|
|
|
const linespec_sals &lsal_start = canonical_start.lsals[0];
|
|
|
|
if (canonical_start.lsals.size () > 1
|
|
|| lsal_start.sals.size () != 1)
|
|
error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
|
|
|
|
const symtab_and_line &sal_start = lsal_start.sals[0];
|
|
std::string addr_string_start (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
|
|
|
|
arg++; /* Skip the comma. */
|
|
arg = skip_spaces (arg);
|
|
|
|
/* Parse the end location. */
|
|
|
|
arg_start = arg;
|
|
|
|
/* We call decode_line_full directly here instead of using
|
|
parse_breakpoint_sals because we need to specify the start location's
|
|
symtab and line as the default symtab and line for the end of the
|
|
range. This makes it possible to have ranges like "foo.c:27, +14",
|
|
where +14 means 14 lines from the start location. */
|
|
event_location_up end_location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
|
|
current_language);
|
|
decode_line_full (end_location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
|
|
sal_start.symtab, sal_start.line,
|
|
&canonical_end, NULL, NULL);
|
|
|
|
if (canonical_end.lsals.empty ())
|
|
error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
|
|
|
|
const linespec_sals &lsal_end = canonical_end.lsals[0];
|
|
if (canonical_end.lsals.size () > 1
|
|
|| lsal_end.sals.size () != 1)
|
|
error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
|
|
|
|
const symtab_and_line &sal_end = lsal_end.sals[0];
|
|
|
|
end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sal_end);
|
|
if (sal_start.pc > end)
|
|
error (_("Invalid address range, end precedes start."));
|
|
|
|
length = end - sal_start.pc + 1;
|
|
if (length < 0)
|
|
/* Length overflowed. */
|
|
error (_("Address range too large."));
|
|
else if (length == 1)
|
|
{
|
|
/* This range is simple enough to be handled by
|
|
the `hbreak' command. */
|
|
hbreak_command (&addr_string_start[0], 1);
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Now set up the breakpoint. */
|
|
b = set_raw_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), sal_start,
|
|
bp_hardware_breakpoint, &ranged_breakpoint_ops);
|
|
set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
|
|
b->number = breakpoint_count;
|
|
b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
|
|
b->location = std::move (start_location);
|
|
b->location_range_end = std::move (end_location);
|
|
b->loc->length = length;
|
|
|
|
mention (b);
|
|
gdb::observers::breakpoint_created.notify (b);
|
|
update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Return non-zero if EXP is verified as constant. Returned zero
|
|
means EXP is variable. Also the constant detection may fail for
|
|
some constant expressions and in such case still falsely return
|
|
zero. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
watchpoint_exp_is_const (const struct expression *exp)
|
|
{
|
|
int i = exp->nelts;
|
|
|
|
while (i > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
int oplenp, argsp;
|
|
|
|
/* We are only interested in the descriptor of each element. */
|
|
operator_length (exp, i, &oplenp, &argsp);
|
|
i -= oplenp;
|
|
|
|
switch (exp->elts[i].opcode)
|
|
{
|
|
case BINOP_ADD:
|
|
case BINOP_SUB:
|
|
case BINOP_MUL:
|
|
case BINOP_DIV:
|
|
case BINOP_REM:
|
|
case BINOP_MOD:
|
|
case BINOP_LSH:
|
|
case BINOP_RSH:
|
|
case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
|
|
case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
|
|
case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
|
|
case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
|
|
case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
|
|
case BINOP_EQUAL:
|
|
case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
|
|
case BINOP_LESS:
|
|
case BINOP_GTR:
|
|
case BINOP_LEQ:
|
|
case BINOP_GEQ:
|
|
case BINOP_REPEAT:
|
|
case BINOP_COMMA:
|
|
case BINOP_EXP:
|
|
case BINOP_MIN:
|
|
case BINOP_MAX:
|
|
case BINOP_INTDIV:
|
|
case BINOP_CONCAT:
|
|
case TERNOP_COND:
|
|
case TERNOP_SLICE:
|
|
|
|
case OP_LONG:
|
|
case OP_FLOAT:
|
|
case OP_LAST:
|
|
case OP_COMPLEX:
|
|
case OP_STRING:
|
|
case OP_ARRAY:
|
|
case OP_TYPE:
|
|
case OP_TYPEOF:
|
|
case OP_DECLTYPE:
|
|
case OP_TYPEID:
|
|
case OP_NAME:
|
|
case OP_OBJC_NSSTRING:
|
|
|
|
case UNOP_NEG:
|
|
case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
|
|
case UNOP_COMPLEMENT:
|
|
case UNOP_ADDR:
|
|
case UNOP_HIGH:
|
|
case UNOP_CAST:
|
|
|
|
case UNOP_CAST_TYPE:
|
|
case UNOP_REINTERPRET_CAST:
|
|
case UNOP_DYNAMIC_CAST:
|
|
/* Unary, binary and ternary operators: We have to check
|
|
their operands. If they are constant, then so is the
|
|
result of that operation. For instance, if A and B are
|
|
determined to be constants, then so is "A + B".
|
|
|
|
UNOP_IND is one exception to the rule above, because the
|
|
value of *ADDR is not necessarily a constant, even when
|
|
ADDR is. */
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case OP_VAR_VALUE:
|
|
/* Check whether the associated symbol is a constant.
|
|
|
|
We use SYMBOL_CLASS rather than TYPE_CONST because it's
|
|
possible that a buggy compiler could mark a variable as
|
|
constant even when it is not, and TYPE_CONST would return
|
|
true in this case, while SYMBOL_CLASS wouldn't.
|
|
|
|
We also have to check for function symbols because they
|
|
are always constant. */
|
|
{
|
|
struct symbol *s = exp->elts[i + 2].symbol;
|
|
|
|
if (SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_BLOCK
|
|
&& SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST
|
|
&& SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST_BYTES)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* The default action is to return 0 because we are using
|
|
the optimistic approach here: If we don't know something,
|
|
then it is not a constant. */
|
|
default:
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Watchpoint destructor. */
|
|
|
|
watchpoint::~watchpoint ()
|
|
{
|
|
xfree (this->exp_string);
|
|
xfree (this->exp_string_reparse);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "re_set" breakpoint_ops method for watchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
re_set_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
|
|
|
|
/* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global
|
|
variables, or it can be on local variables.
|
|
|
|
Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even
|
|
persist across program restarts. Since they can use variables
|
|
from shared libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries
|
|
are loaded and unloaded.
|
|
|
|
Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result
|
|
of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local
|
|
and a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint,
|
|
but unloading of a shared library will make the expression
|
|
invalid. This is not a very common use case, but we still
|
|
re-evaluate expression, to avoid surprises to the user.
|
|
|
|
Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if
|
|
watchpoints frame id is still valid. If it's not, it means the
|
|
watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In fact,
|
|
I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case.
|
|
|
|
If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then
|
|
w->exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it.
|
|
|
|
Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will be
|
|
reevaluated again when enabled. */
|
|
update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
insert_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
|
|
{
|
|
struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
|
|
int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
|
|
|
|
return target_insert_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
|
|
w->cond_exp.get ());
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
remove_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
|
|
{
|
|
struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
|
|
int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
|
|
|
|
return target_remove_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
|
|
w->cond_exp.get ());
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
breakpoint_hit_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
|
|
const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
|
|
const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
|
|
struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
|
|
|
|
/* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the
|
|
reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on
|
|
some data address). Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction
|
|
in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has
|
|
been defined. Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger
|
|
(did not match the data address). */
|
|
if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
|
|
&& w->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
check_status_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
|
|
{
|
|
gdb_assert (is_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at));
|
|
|
|
bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
|
|
hardware watchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
resources_needed_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
|
|
{
|
|
struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
|
|
int length = w->exact? 1 : bl->length;
|
|
|
|
return target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (bl->address, length);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
|
|
hardware watchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
works_in_software_mode_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Read and access watchpoints only work with hardware support. */
|
|
return b->type == bp_watchpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static enum print_stop_action
|
|
print_it_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
enum print_stop_action result;
|
|
struct watchpoint *w;
|
|
struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
|
|
|
|
gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
|
|
|
|
b = bs->breakpoint_at;
|
|
w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
|
|
|
|
annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
|
|
maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
|
|
|
|
string_file stb;
|
|
|
|
gdb::optional<ui_out_emit_tuple> tuple_emitter;
|
|
switch (b->type)
|
|
{
|
|
case bp_watchpoint:
|
|
case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
|
|
if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
|
|
uiout->field_string
|
|
("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
|
|
mention (b);
|
|
tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
|
|
uiout->text ("\nOld value = ");
|
|
watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val.get (), &stb);
|
|
uiout->field_stream ("old", stb);
|
|
uiout->text ("\nNew value = ");
|
|
watchpoint_value_print (w->val.get (), &stb);
|
|
uiout->field_stream ("new", stb);
|
|
uiout->text ("\n");
|
|
/* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
|
|
result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case bp_read_watchpoint:
|
|
if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
|
|
uiout->field_string
|
|
("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
|
|
mention (b);
|
|
tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
|
|
uiout->text ("\nValue = ");
|
|
watchpoint_value_print (w->val.get (), &stb);
|
|
uiout->field_stream ("value", stb);
|
|
uiout->text ("\n");
|
|
result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case bp_access_watchpoint:
|
|
if (bs->old_val != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
|
|
uiout->field_string
|
|
("reason",
|
|
async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
|
|
mention (b);
|
|
tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
|
|
uiout->text ("\nOld value = ");
|
|
watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val.get (), &stb);
|
|
uiout->field_stream ("old", stb);
|
|
uiout->text ("\nNew value = ");
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
mention (b);
|
|
if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
|
|
uiout->field_string
|
|
("reason",
|
|
async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
|
|
tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
|
|
uiout->text ("\nValue = ");
|
|
}
|
|
watchpoint_value_print (w->val.get (), &stb);
|
|
uiout->field_stream ("new", stb);
|
|
uiout->text ("\n");
|
|
result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
|
|
break;
|
|
default:
|
|
result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return result;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for hardware
|
|
watchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
print_mention_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
|
|
struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
|
|
const char *tuple_name;
|
|
|
|
switch (b->type)
|
|
{
|
|
case bp_watchpoint:
|
|
uiout->text ("Watchpoint ");
|
|
tuple_name = "wpt";
|
|
break;
|
|
case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
|
|
uiout->text ("Hardware watchpoint ");
|
|
tuple_name = "wpt";
|
|
break;
|
|
case bp_read_watchpoint:
|
|
uiout->text ("Hardware read watchpoint ");
|
|
tuple_name = "hw-rwpt";
|
|
break;
|
|
case bp_access_watchpoint:
|
|
uiout->text ("Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
|
|
tuple_name = "hw-awpt";
|
|
break;
|
|
default:
|
|
internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
|
|
_("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, tuple_name);
|
|
uiout->field_signed ("number", b->number);
|
|
uiout->text (": ");
|
|
uiout->field_string ("exp", w->exp_string);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
|
|
watchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
print_recreate_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
|
|
{
|
|
struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
|
|
|
|
switch (b->type)
|
|
{
|
|
case bp_watchpoint:
|
|
case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
|
|
break;
|
|
case bp_read_watchpoint:
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
|
|
break;
|
|
case bp_access_watchpoint:
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
|
|
break;
|
|
default:
|
|
internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
|
|
_("Invalid watchpoint type."));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", w->exp_string);
|
|
print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "explains_signal" breakpoint_ops method for
|
|
watchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
explains_signal_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
|
|
{
|
|
/* A software watchpoint cannot cause a signal other than
|
|
GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
|
|
if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in hardware watchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static struct breakpoint_ops watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for
|
|
masked hardware watchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
insert_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
|
|
{
|
|
struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
|
|
|
|
return target_insert_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
|
|
bl->watchpoint_type);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for
|
|
masked hardware watchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
remove_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
|
|
{
|
|
struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
|
|
|
|
return target_remove_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
|
|
bl->watchpoint_type);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
|
|
masked hardware watchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
resources_needed_masked_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
|
|
{
|
|
struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
|
|
|
|
return target_masked_watch_num_registers (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
|
|
masked hardware watchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
|
|
masked hardware watchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static enum print_stop_action
|
|
print_it_masked_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
|
|
struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
|
|
|
|
/* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
|
|
gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
|
|
|
|
annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
|
|
maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
|
|
|
|
switch (b->type)
|
|
{
|
|
case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
|
|
if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
|
|
uiout->field_string
|
|
("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case bp_read_watchpoint:
|
|
if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
|
|
uiout->field_string
|
|
("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case bp_access_watchpoint:
|
|
if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
|
|
uiout->field_string
|
|
("reason",
|
|
async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
|
|
break;
|
|
default:
|
|
internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
|
|
_("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
mention (b);
|
|
uiout->text (_("\n\
|
|
Check the underlying instruction at PC for the memory\n\
|
|
address and value which triggered this watchpoint.\n"));
|
|
uiout->text ("\n");
|
|
|
|
/* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
|
|
return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
|
|
masked hardware watchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
|
|
struct ui_out *uiout)
|
|
{
|
|
struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
|
|
|
|
/* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
|
|
gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
|
|
|
|
uiout->text ("\tmask ");
|
|
uiout->field_core_addr ("mask", b->loc->gdbarch, w->hw_wp_mask);
|
|
uiout->text ("\n");
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
|
|
masked hardware watchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
print_mention_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
|
|
struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
|
|
const char *tuple_name;
|
|
|
|
switch (b->type)
|
|
{
|
|
case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
|
|
uiout->text ("Masked hardware watchpoint ");
|
|
tuple_name = "wpt";
|
|
break;
|
|
case bp_read_watchpoint:
|
|
uiout->text ("Masked hardware read watchpoint ");
|
|
tuple_name = "hw-rwpt";
|
|
break;
|
|
case bp_access_watchpoint:
|
|
uiout->text ("Masked hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
|
|
tuple_name = "hw-awpt";
|
|
break;
|
|
default:
|
|
internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
|
|
_("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, tuple_name);
|
|
uiout->field_signed ("number", b->number);
|
|
uiout->text (": ");
|
|
uiout->field_string ("exp", w->exp_string);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
|
|
masked hardware watchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
print_recreate_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
|
|
{
|
|
struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
|
|
|
|
switch (b->type)
|
|
{
|
|
case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
|
|
break;
|
|
case bp_read_watchpoint:
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
|
|
break;
|
|
case bp_access_watchpoint:
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
|
|
break;
|
|
default:
|
|
internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
|
|
_("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s mask 0x%s", w->exp_string,
|
|
phex (w->hw_wp_mask, sizeof (CORE_ADDR)));
|
|
print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in masked hardware watchpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static struct breakpoint_ops masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
|
|
/* Tell whether the given watchpoint is a masked hardware watchpoint. */
|
|
|
|
static bool
|
|
is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
return b->ops == &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* accessflag: hw_write: watch write,
|
|
hw_read: watch read,
|
|
hw_access: watch access (read or write) */
|
|
static void
|
|
watch_command_1 (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty,
|
|
int just_location, int internal)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *scope_breakpoint = NULL;
|
|
const struct block *exp_valid_block = NULL, *cond_exp_valid_block = NULL;
|
|
struct value *result;
|
|
int saved_bitpos = 0, saved_bitsize = 0;
|
|
const char *exp_start = NULL;
|
|
const char *exp_end = NULL;
|
|
const char *tok, *end_tok;
|
|
int toklen = -1;
|
|
const char *cond_start = NULL;
|
|
const char *cond_end = NULL;
|
|
enum bptype bp_type;
|
|
int thread = -1;
|
|
int pc = 0;
|
|
/* Flag to indicate whether we are going to use masks for
|
|
the hardware watchpoint. */
|
|
int use_mask = 0;
|
|
CORE_ADDR mask = 0;
|
|
|
|
/* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse. */
|
|
if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0')
|
|
{
|
|
const char *value_start;
|
|
|
|
exp_end = arg + strlen (arg);
|
|
|
|
/* Look for "parameter value" pairs at the end
|
|
of the arguments string. */
|
|
for (tok = exp_end - 1; tok > arg; tok--)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Skip whitespace at the end of the argument list. */
|
|
while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
|
|
tok--;
|
|
|
|
/* Find the beginning of the last token.
|
|
This is the value of the parameter. */
|
|
while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
|
|
tok--;
|
|
value_start = tok + 1;
|
|
|
|
/* Skip whitespace. */
|
|
while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
|
|
tok--;
|
|
|
|
end_tok = tok;
|
|
|
|
/* Find the beginning of the second to last token.
|
|
This is the parameter itself. */
|
|
while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
|
|
tok--;
|
|
tok++;
|
|
toklen = end_tok - tok + 1;
|
|
|
|
if (toklen == 6 && startswith (tok, "thread"))
|
|
{
|
|
struct thread_info *thr;
|
|
/* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means
|
|
the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers
|
|
only in a specific thread. */
|
|
const char *endp;
|
|
|
|
if (thread != -1)
|
|
error(_("You can specify only one thread."));
|
|
|
|
/* Extract the thread ID from the next token. */
|
|
thr = parse_thread_id (value_start, &endp);
|
|
|
|
/* Check if the user provided a valid thread ID. */
|
|
if (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
|
|
invalid_thread_id_error (value_start);
|
|
|
|
thread = thr->global_num;
|
|
}
|
|
else if (toklen == 4 && startswith (tok, "mask"))
|
|
{
|
|
/* We've found a "mask" token, which means the user wants to
|
|
create a hardware watchpoint that is going to have the mask
|
|
facility. */
|
|
struct value *mask_value, *mark;
|
|
|
|
if (use_mask)
|
|
error(_("You can specify only one mask."));
|
|
|
|
use_mask = just_location = 1;
|
|
|
|
mark = value_mark ();
|
|
mask_value = parse_to_comma_and_eval (&value_start);
|
|
mask = value_as_address (mask_value);
|
|
value_free_to_mark (mark);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
/* We didn't recognize what we found. We should stop here. */
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
/* Truncate the string and get rid of the "parameter value" pair before
|
|
the arguments string is parsed by the parse_exp_1 function. */
|
|
exp_end = tok;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
exp_end = arg;
|
|
|
|
/* Parse the rest of the arguments. From here on out, everything
|
|
is in terms of a newly allocated string instead of the original
|
|
ARG. */
|
|
std::string expression (arg, exp_end - arg);
|
|
exp_start = arg = expression.c_str ();
|
|
innermost_block_tracker tracker;
|
|
expression_up exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0, &tracker);
|
|
exp_end = arg;
|
|
/* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it.
|
|
This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit
|
|
prettier. */
|
|
while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t'))
|
|
--exp_end;
|
|
|
|
/* Checking if the expression is not constant. */
|
|
if (watchpoint_exp_is_const (exp.get ()))
|
|
{
|
|
int len;
|
|
|
|
len = exp_end - exp_start;
|
|
while (len > 0 && isspace (exp_start[len - 1]))
|
|
len--;
|
|
error (_("Cannot watch constant value `%.*s'."), len, exp_start);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
exp_valid_block = tracker.block ();
|
|
struct value *mark = value_mark ();
|
|
struct value *val_as_value = nullptr;
|
|
fetch_subexp_value (exp.get (), &pc, &val_as_value, &result, NULL,
|
|
just_location);
|
|
|
|
if (val_as_value != NULL && just_location)
|
|
{
|
|
saved_bitpos = value_bitpos (val_as_value);
|
|
saved_bitsize = value_bitsize (val_as_value);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
value_ref_ptr val;
|
|
if (just_location)
|
|
{
|
|
int ret;
|
|
|
|
exp_valid_block = NULL;
|
|
val = release_value (value_addr (result));
|
|
value_free_to_mark (mark);
|
|
|
|
if (use_mask)
|
|
{
|
|
ret = target_masked_watch_num_registers (value_as_address (val.get ()),
|
|
mask);
|
|
if (ret == -1)
|
|
error (_("This target does not support masked watchpoints."));
|
|
else if (ret == -2)
|
|
error (_("Invalid mask or memory region."));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else if (val_as_value != NULL)
|
|
val = release_value (val_as_value);
|
|
|
|
tok = skip_spaces (arg);
|
|
end_tok = skip_to_space (tok);
|
|
|
|
toklen = end_tok - tok;
|
|
if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
|
|
innermost_block_tracker if_tracker;
|
|
parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0, 0, &if_tracker);
|
|
|
|
/* The watchpoint expression may not be local, but the condition
|
|
may still be. E.g.: `watch global if local > 0'. */
|
|
cond_exp_valid_block = if_tracker.block ();
|
|
|
|
cond_end = tok;
|
|
}
|
|
if (*tok)
|
|
error (_("Junk at end of command."));
|
|
|
|
frame_info *wp_frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block);
|
|
|
|
/* Save this because create_internal_breakpoint below invalidates
|
|
'wp_frame'. */
|
|
frame_id watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (wp_frame);
|
|
|
|
/* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope"
|
|
breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint
|
|
expression. Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so
|
|
that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status. */
|
|
if (exp_valid_block != NULL && wp_frame != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
frame_id caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (wp_frame);
|
|
|
|
if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id))
|
|
{
|
|
gdbarch *caller_arch = frame_unwind_caller_arch (wp_frame);
|
|
CORE_ADDR caller_pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (wp_frame);
|
|
|
|
scope_breakpoint
|
|
= create_internal_breakpoint (caller_arch, caller_pc,
|
|
bp_watchpoint_scope,
|
|
&momentary_breakpoint_ops);
|
|
|
|
/* create_internal_breakpoint could invalidate WP_FRAME. */
|
|
wp_frame = NULL;
|
|
|
|
scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled;
|
|
|
|
/* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits. */
|
|
scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del;
|
|
|
|
/* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion). */
|
|
scope_breakpoint->frame_id = caller_frame_id;
|
|
|
|
/* Set the address at which we will stop. */
|
|
scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch = caller_arch;
|
|
scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address = caller_pc;
|
|
scope_breakpoint->loc->address
|
|
= adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch,
|
|
scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address,
|
|
scope_breakpoint->type);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Now set up the breakpoint. We create all watchpoints as hardware
|
|
watchpoints here even if hardware watchpoints are turned off, a call
|
|
to update_watchpoint later in this function will cause the type to
|
|
drop back to bp_watchpoint (software watchpoint) if required. */
|
|
|
|
if (accessflag == hw_read)
|
|
bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint;
|
|
else if (accessflag == hw_access)
|
|
bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint;
|
|
else
|
|
bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
|
|
|
|
std::unique_ptr<watchpoint> w (new watchpoint ());
|
|
|
|
if (use_mask)
|
|
init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (w.get (), NULL, bp_type,
|
|
&masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
|
|
else
|
|
init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (w.get (), NULL, bp_type,
|
|
&watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
|
|
w->thread = thread;
|
|
w->disposition = disp_donttouch;
|
|
w->pspace = current_program_space;
|
|
w->exp = std::move (exp);
|
|
w->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block;
|
|
w->cond_exp_valid_block = cond_exp_valid_block;
|
|
if (just_location)
|
|
{
|
|
struct type *t = value_type (val.get ());
|
|
CORE_ADDR addr = value_as_address (val.get ());
|
|
|
|
w->exp_string_reparse
|
|
= current_language->watch_location_expression (t, addr).release ();
|
|
|
|
w->exp_string = xstrprintf ("-location %.*s",
|
|
(int) (exp_end - exp_start), exp_start);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
w->exp_string = savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start);
|
|
|
|
if (use_mask)
|
|
{
|
|
w->hw_wp_mask = mask;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
w->val = val;
|
|
w->val_bitpos = saved_bitpos;
|
|
w->val_bitsize = saved_bitsize;
|
|
w->val_valid = true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (cond_start)
|
|
w->cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
|
|
else
|
|
w->cond_string = 0;
|
|
|
|
if (frame_id_p (watchpoint_frame))
|
|
{
|
|
w->watchpoint_frame = watchpoint_frame;
|
|
w->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
w->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id;
|
|
w->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (scope_breakpoint != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
/* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint. We will
|
|
need to act on them together. */
|
|
w->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint;
|
|
scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = w.get ();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!just_location)
|
|
value_free_to_mark (mark);
|
|
|
|
/* Finally update the new watchpoint. This creates the locations
|
|
that should be inserted. */
|
|
update_watchpoint (w.get (), 1);
|
|
|
|
install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (w), 1);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Return count of debug registers needed to watch the given expression.
|
|
If the watchpoint cannot be handled in hardware return zero. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
can_use_hardware_watchpoint (const std::vector<value_ref_ptr> &vals)
|
|
{
|
|
int found_memory_cnt = 0;
|
|
|
|
/* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */
|
|
if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
gdb_assert (!vals.empty ());
|
|
struct value *head = vals[0].get ();
|
|
|
|
/* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon
|
|
memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB. If we
|
|
find any register references or function calls, we can't use a
|
|
hardware watchpoint.
|
|
|
|
The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series
|
|
of values, one holding the value of every subexpression. (The
|
|
expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and
|
|
a*b+c.) GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish
|
|
the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues,
|
|
register lvalues, computed values, etcetera. So we can evaluate
|
|
the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves
|
|
behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the
|
|
expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints.
|
|
|
|
However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior
|
|
function calls are special in any way. So this function may not
|
|
notice that an expression involving an inferior function call
|
|
can't be watched with hardware watchpoints. FIXME. */
|
|
for (const value_ref_ptr &iter : vals)
|
|
{
|
|
struct value *v = iter.get ();
|
|
|
|
if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory)
|
|
{
|
|
if (v != head && value_lazy (v))
|
|
/* A lazy memory lvalue in the chain is one that GDB never
|
|
needed to fetch; we either just used its address (e.g.,
|
|
`a' in `a.b') or we never needed it at all (e.g., `a'
|
|
in `a,b'). This doesn't apply to HEAD; if that is
|
|
lazy then it was not readable, but watch it anyway. */
|
|
;
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* Ahh, memory we actually used! Check if we can cover
|
|
it with hardware watchpoints. */
|
|
struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
|
|
|
|
/* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it
|
|
explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a
|
|
middle of some value chain. */
|
|
if (v == head
|
|
|| (vtype->code () != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
|
|
&& vtype->code () != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
|
|
{
|
|
CORE_ADDR vaddr = value_address (v);
|
|
int len;
|
|
int num_regs;
|
|
|
|
len = (target_exact_watchpoints
|
|
&& is_scalar_type_recursive (vtype))?
|
|
1 : TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
|
|
|
|
num_regs = target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len);
|
|
if (!num_regs)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
else
|
|
found_memory_cnt += num_regs;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) != not_lval
|
|
&& deprecated_value_modifiable (v) == 0)
|
|
return 0; /* These are values from the history (e.g., $1). */
|
|
else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_register)
|
|
return 0; /* Cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint. */
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware
|
|
watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it. */
|
|
return found_memory_cnt;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
watch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
|
|
{
|
|
watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty, 0, internal);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* A helper function that looks for the "-location" argument and then
|
|
calls watch_command_1. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
watch_maybe_just_location (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
int just_location = 0;
|
|
|
|
if (arg
|
|
&& (check_for_argument (&arg, "-location", sizeof ("-location") - 1)
|
|
|| check_for_argument (&arg, "-l", sizeof ("-l") - 1)))
|
|
just_location = 1;
|
|
|
|
watch_command_1 (arg, accessflag, from_tty, just_location, 0);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
watch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_write, from_tty);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
rwatch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
|
|
{
|
|
watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty, 0, internal);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
rwatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_read, from_tty);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
awatch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
|
|
{
|
|
watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty, 0, internal);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
awatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_access, from_tty);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Data for the FSM that manages the until(location)/advance commands
|
|
in infcmd.c. Here because it uses the mechanisms of
|
|
breakpoints. */
|
|
|
|
struct until_break_fsm : public thread_fsm
|
|
{
|
|
/* The thread that was current when the command was executed. */
|
|
int thread;
|
|
|
|
/* The breakpoint set at the destination location. */
|
|
breakpoint_up location_breakpoint;
|
|
|
|
/* Breakpoint set at the return address in the caller frame. May be
|
|
NULL. */
|
|
breakpoint_up caller_breakpoint;
|
|
|
|
until_break_fsm (struct interp *cmd_interp, int thread,
|
|
breakpoint_up &&location_breakpoint,
|
|
breakpoint_up &&caller_breakpoint)
|
|
: thread_fsm (cmd_interp),
|
|
thread (thread),
|
|
location_breakpoint (std::move (location_breakpoint)),
|
|
caller_breakpoint (std::move (caller_breakpoint))
|
|
{
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void clean_up (struct thread_info *thread) override;
|
|
bool should_stop (struct thread_info *thread) override;
|
|
enum async_reply_reason do_async_reply_reason () override;
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* Implementation of the 'should_stop' FSM method for the
|
|
until(location)/advance commands. */
|
|
|
|
bool
|
|
until_break_fsm::should_stop (struct thread_info *tp)
|
|
{
|
|
if (bpstat_find_breakpoint (tp->control.stop_bpstat,
|
|
location_breakpoint.get ()) != NULL
|
|
|| (caller_breakpoint != NULL
|
|
&& bpstat_find_breakpoint (tp->control.stop_bpstat,
|
|
caller_breakpoint.get ()) != NULL))
|
|
set_finished ();
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implementation of the 'clean_up' FSM method for the
|
|
until(location)/advance commands. */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
until_break_fsm::clean_up (struct thread_info *)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Clean up our temporary breakpoints. */
|
|
location_breakpoint.reset ();
|
|
caller_breakpoint.reset ();
|
|
delete_longjmp_breakpoint (thread);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implementation of the 'async_reply_reason' FSM method for the
|
|
until(location)/advance commands. */
|
|
|
|
enum async_reply_reason
|
|
until_break_fsm::do_async_reply_reason ()
|
|
{
|
|
return EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
until_break_command (const char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere)
|
|
{
|
|
struct frame_info *frame;
|
|
struct gdbarch *frame_gdbarch;
|
|
struct frame_id stack_frame_id;
|
|
struct frame_id caller_frame_id;
|
|
int thread;
|
|
struct thread_info *tp;
|
|
|
|
clear_proceed_status (0);
|
|
|
|
/* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from
|
|
this function. */
|
|
|
|
event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
|
|
|
|
std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals
|
|
= (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ()
|
|
? decode_line_1 (location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
|
|
get_last_displayed_symtab (),
|
|
get_last_displayed_line ())
|
|
: decode_line_1 (location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
|
|
NULL, NULL, 0));
|
|
|
|
if (sals.size () != 1)
|
|
error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line."));
|
|
|
|
symtab_and_line &sal = sals[0];
|
|
|
|
if (*arg)
|
|
error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
|
|
|
|
resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
|
|
|
|
tp = inferior_thread ();
|
|
thread = tp->global_num;
|
|
|
|
/* Note linespec handling above invalidates the frame chain.
|
|
Installing a breakpoint also invalidates the frame chain (as it
|
|
may need to switch threads), so do any frame handling before
|
|
that. */
|
|
|
|
frame = get_selected_frame (NULL);
|
|
frame_gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
|
|
stack_frame_id = get_stack_frame_id (frame);
|
|
caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
|
|
|
|
/* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current
|
|
one. */
|
|
|
|
breakpoint_up caller_breakpoint;
|
|
|
|
gdb::optional<delete_longjmp_breakpoint_cleanup> lj_deleter;
|
|
|
|
if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id))
|
|
{
|
|
struct symtab_and_line sal2;
|
|
struct gdbarch *caller_gdbarch;
|
|
|
|
sal2 = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0);
|
|
sal2.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
|
|
caller_gdbarch = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
|
|
caller_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (caller_gdbarch,
|
|
sal2,
|
|
caller_frame_id,
|
|
bp_until);
|
|
|
|
set_longjmp_breakpoint (tp, caller_frame_id);
|
|
lj_deleter.emplace (thread);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* set_momentary_breakpoint could invalidate FRAME. */
|
|
frame = NULL;
|
|
|
|
breakpoint_up location_breakpoint;
|
|
if (anywhere)
|
|
/* If the user told us to continue until a specified location,
|
|
we don't specify a frame at which we need to stop. */
|
|
location_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
|
|
null_frame_id, bp_until);
|
|
else
|
|
/* Otherwise, specify the selected frame, because we want to stop
|
|
only at the very same frame. */
|
|
location_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
|
|
stack_frame_id, bp_until);
|
|
|
|
tp->thread_fsm = new until_break_fsm (command_interp (), tp->global_num,
|
|
std::move (location_breakpoint),
|
|
std::move (caller_breakpoint));
|
|
|
|
if (lj_deleter)
|
|
lj_deleter->release ();
|
|
|
|
proceed (-1, GDB_SIGNAL_DEFAULT);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* This function attempts to parse an optional "if <cond>" clause
|
|
from the arg string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
|
|
|
|
Else, it returns a pointer to the condition string. (It does not
|
|
attempt to evaluate the string against a particular block.) And,
|
|
it updates arg to point to the first character following the parsed
|
|
if clause in the arg string. */
|
|
|
|
const char *
|
|
ep_parse_optional_if_clause (const char **arg)
|
|
{
|
|
const char *cond_string;
|
|
|
|
if (((*arg)[0] != 'i') || ((*arg)[1] != 'f') || !isspace ((*arg)[2]))
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
|
|
/* Skip the "if" keyword. */
|
|
(*arg) += 2;
|
|
|
|
/* Skip any extra leading whitespace, and record the start of the
|
|
condition string. */
|
|
*arg = skip_spaces (*arg);
|
|
cond_string = *arg;
|
|
|
|
/* Assume that the condition occupies the remainder of the arg
|
|
string. */
|
|
(*arg) += strlen (cond_string);
|
|
|
|
return cond_string;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Commands to deal with catching events, such as signals, exceptions,
|
|
process start/exit, etc. */
|
|
|
|
typedef enum
|
|
{
|
|
catch_fork_temporary, catch_vfork_temporary,
|
|
catch_fork_permanent, catch_vfork_permanent
|
|
}
|
|
catch_fork_kind;
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
catch_fork_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
|
|
struct cmd_list_element *command)
|
|
{
|
|
struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
|
|
const char *cond_string = NULL;
|
|
catch_fork_kind fork_kind;
|
|
int tempflag;
|
|
|
|
fork_kind = (catch_fork_kind) (uintptr_t) get_cmd_context (command);
|
|
tempflag = (fork_kind == catch_fork_temporary
|
|
|| fork_kind == catch_vfork_temporary);
|
|
|
|
if (!arg)
|
|
arg = "";
|
|
arg = skip_spaces (arg);
|
|
|
|
/* The allowed syntax is:
|
|
catch [v]fork
|
|
catch [v]fork if <cond>
|
|
|
|
First, check if there's an if clause. */
|
|
cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
|
|
|
|
if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
|
|
error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
|
|
|
|
/* If this target supports it, create a fork or vfork catchpoint
|
|
and enable reporting of such events. */
|
|
switch (fork_kind)
|
|
{
|
|
case catch_fork_temporary:
|
|
case catch_fork_permanent:
|
|
create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
|
|
&catch_fork_breakpoint_ops);
|
|
break;
|
|
case catch_vfork_temporary:
|
|
case catch_vfork_permanent:
|
|
create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
|
|
&catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops);
|
|
break;
|
|
default:
|
|
error (_("unsupported or unknown fork kind; cannot catch it"));
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
catch_exec_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
|
|
struct cmd_list_element *command)
|
|
{
|
|
struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
|
|
int tempflag;
|
|
const char *cond_string = NULL;
|
|
|
|
tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
|
|
|
|
if (!arg)
|
|
arg = "";
|
|
arg = skip_spaces (arg);
|
|
|
|
/* The allowed syntax is:
|
|
catch exec
|
|
catch exec if <cond>
|
|
|
|
First, check if there's an if clause. */
|
|
cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
|
|
|
|
if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
|
|
error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
|
|
|
|
std::unique_ptr<exec_catchpoint> c (new exec_catchpoint ());
|
|
init_catchpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
|
|
&catch_exec_breakpoint_ops);
|
|
c->exec_pathname = NULL;
|
|
|
|
install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
init_ada_exception_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
|
|
struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
|
|
struct symtab_and_line sal,
|
|
const char *addr_string,
|
|
const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
|
|
int tempflag,
|
|
int enabled,
|
|
int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
if (from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
|
|
if (!loc_gdbarch)
|
|
loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
|
|
|
|
describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
|
|
sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, -1);
|
|
/* FIXME: brobecker/2006-12-28: Actually, re-implement a special
|
|
version for exception catchpoints, because two catchpoints
|
|
used for different exception names will use the same address.
|
|
In this case, a "breakpoint ... also set at..." warning is
|
|
unproductive. Besides, the warning phrasing is also a bit
|
|
inappropriate, we should use the word catchpoint, and tell
|
|
the user what type of catchpoint it is. The above is good
|
|
enough for now, though. */
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint, ops);
|
|
|
|
b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
|
|
b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
|
|
b->location = string_to_event_location (&addr_string,
|
|
language_def (language_ada));
|
|
b->language = language_ada;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Compare two breakpoints and return a strcmp-like result. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
compare_breakpoints (const breakpoint *a, const breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
uintptr_t ua = (uintptr_t) a;
|
|
uintptr_t ub = (uintptr_t) b;
|
|
|
|
if (a->number < b->number)
|
|
return -1;
|
|
else if (a->number > b->number)
|
|
return 1;
|
|
|
|
/* Now sort by address, in case we see, e..g, two breakpoints with
|
|
the number 0. */
|
|
if (ua < ub)
|
|
return -1;
|
|
return ua > ub ? 1 : 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Delete breakpoints by address or line. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
clear_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
int default_match;
|
|
|
|
std::vector<symtab_and_line> decoded_sals;
|
|
symtab_and_line last_sal;
|
|
gdb::array_view<symtab_and_line> sals;
|
|
if (arg)
|
|
{
|
|
decoded_sals
|
|
= decode_line_with_current_source (arg,
|
|
(DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE
|
|
| DECODE_LINE_LIST_MODE));
|
|
default_match = 0;
|
|
sals = decoded_sals;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* Set sal's line, symtab, pc, and pspace to the values
|
|
corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info. If the
|
|
codepoint is not valid, this will set all the fields to 0. */
|
|
last_sal = get_last_displayed_sal ();
|
|
if (last_sal.symtab == 0)
|
|
error (_("No source file specified."));
|
|
|
|
default_match = 1;
|
|
sals = last_sal;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not as bad as it
|
|
seems, because all existing breakpoints typically have both
|
|
file/line and pc set. So, if clear is given file/line, we can
|
|
match this to existing breakpoint without obtaining pc at all.
|
|
|
|
We only support clearing given the address explicitly
|
|
present in breakpoint table. Say, we've set breakpoint
|
|
at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line,
|
|
due to optimization, all in one block.
|
|
|
|
We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another
|
|
PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't
|
|
be cleared. We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but
|
|
since the other PC value is never presented to user, user
|
|
can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important
|
|
to support that. */
|
|
|
|
/* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond to it. Do
|
|
it in two passes, solely to preserve the current behavior that
|
|
from_tty is forced true if we delete more than one
|
|
breakpoint. */
|
|
|
|
std::vector<struct breakpoint *> found;
|
|
for (const auto &sal : sals)
|
|
{
|
|
const char *sal_fullname;
|
|
|
|
/* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc.
|
|
If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line.
|
|
If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line
|
|
or at default pc.
|
|
|
|
defaulting sal.pc != 0 tests to do
|
|
|
|
0 1 pc
|
|
1 1 pc _and_ line
|
|
0 0 line
|
|
1 0 <can't happen> */
|
|
|
|
sal_fullname = (sal.symtab == NULL
|
|
? NULL : symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab));
|
|
|
|
/* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to 'found'. */
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
|
|
{
|
|
int match = 0;
|
|
/* Are we going to delete b? */
|
|
if (b->type != bp_none && !is_watchpoint (b))
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
|
|
for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
|
|
{
|
|
/* If the user specified file:line, don't allow a PC
|
|
match. This matches historical gdb behavior. */
|
|
int pc_match = (!sal.explicit_line
|
|
&& sal.pc
|
|
&& (loc->pspace == sal.pspace)
|
|
&& (loc->address == sal.pc)
|
|
&& (!section_is_overlay (loc->section)
|
|
|| loc->section == sal.section));
|
|
int line_match = 0;
|
|
|
|
if ((default_match || sal.explicit_line)
|
|
&& loc->symtab != NULL
|
|
&& sal_fullname != NULL
|
|
&& sal.pspace == loc->pspace
|
|
&& loc->line_number == sal.line
|
|
&& filename_cmp (symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab),
|
|
sal_fullname) == 0)
|
|
line_match = 1;
|
|
|
|
if (pc_match || line_match)
|
|
{
|
|
match = 1;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (match)
|
|
found.push_back (b);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them. */
|
|
if (found.empty ())
|
|
{
|
|
if (arg)
|
|
error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg);
|
|
else
|
|
error (_("No breakpoint at this line."));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Remove duplicates from the vec. */
|
|
std::sort (found.begin (), found.end (),
|
|
[] (const breakpoint *bp_a, const breakpoint *bp_b)
|
|
{
|
|
return compare_breakpoints (bp_a, bp_b) < 0;
|
|
});
|
|
found.erase (std::unique (found.begin (), found.end (),
|
|
[] (const breakpoint *bp_a, const breakpoint *bp_b)
|
|
{
|
|
return compare_breakpoints (bp_a, bp_b) == 0;
|
|
}),
|
|
found.end ());
|
|
|
|
if (found.size () > 1)
|
|
from_tty = 1; /* Always report if deleted more than one. */
|
|
if (from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
if (found.size () == 1)
|
|
printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoint "));
|
|
else
|
|
printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoints "));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
for (breakpoint *iter : found)
|
|
{
|
|
if (from_tty)
|
|
printf_unfiltered ("%d ", iter->number);
|
|
delete_breakpoint (iter);
|
|
}
|
|
if (from_tty)
|
|
putchar_unfiltered ('\n');
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and
|
|
all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not.
|
|
This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors. */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat bs)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
|
|
|
|
for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
|
|
if (bs->breakpoint_at
|
|
&& bs->breakpoint_at->disposition == disp_del
|
|
&& bs->stop)
|
|
delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at);
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
|
|
{
|
|
if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
|
|
delete_breakpoint (b);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to
|
|
std::sort. Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what
|
|
bl_address_is_meaningful says), secondarily by ordering first
|
|
permanent elements and terciarily just ensuring the array is sorted
|
|
stable way despite std::sort being an unstable algorithm. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
bp_location_is_less_than (const bp_location *a, const bp_location *b)
|
|
{
|
|
if (a->address != b->address)
|
|
return a->address < b->address;
|
|
|
|
/* Sort locations at the same address by their pspace number, keeping
|
|
locations of the same inferior (in a multi-inferior environment)
|
|
grouped. */
|
|
|
|
if (a->pspace->num != b->pspace->num)
|
|
return a->pspace->num < b->pspace->num;
|
|
|
|
/* Sort permanent breakpoints first. */
|
|
if (a->permanent != b->permanent)
|
|
return a->permanent > b->permanent;
|
|
|
|
/* Sort by type in order to make duplicate determination easier.
|
|
See update_global_location_list. This is kept in sync with
|
|
breakpoint_locations_match. */
|
|
if (a->loc_type < b->loc_type)
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
/* Likewise, for range-breakpoints, sort by length. */
|
|
if (a->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
|
|
&& b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
|
|
&& a->length < b->length)
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
/* Make the internal GDB representation stable across GDB runs
|
|
where A and B memory inside GDB can differ. Breakpoint locations of
|
|
the same type at the same address can be sorted in arbitrary order. */
|
|
|
|
if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number)
|
|
return a->owner->number < b->owner->number;
|
|
|
|
return a < b;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Set bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max and
|
|
bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current
|
|
content of the bp_locations array. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
bp_locations_target_extensions_update (void)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
|
|
|
|
bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max = 0;
|
|
bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
|
|
{
|
|
CORE_ADDR start, end, addr;
|
|
|
|
if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
start = bl->target_info.placed_address;
|
|
end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len;
|
|
|
|
gdb_assert (bl->address >= start);
|
|
addr = bl->address - start;
|
|
if (addr > bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max)
|
|
bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max = addr;
|
|
|
|
/* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow. */
|
|
|
|
gdb_assert (bl->address < end);
|
|
addr = end - bl->address;
|
|
if (addr > bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max)
|
|
bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Download tracepoint locations if they haven't been. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
download_tracepoint_locations (void)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
enum tribool can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN;
|
|
|
|
scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
|
|
|
|
ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *bl;
|
|
struct tracepoint *t;
|
|
int bp_location_downloaded = 0;
|
|
|
|
if ((b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint
|
|
? !may_insert_fast_tracepoints
|
|
: !may_insert_tracepoints))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN)
|
|
{
|
|
if (target_can_download_tracepoint ())
|
|
can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_TRUE;
|
|
else
|
|
can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_FALSE)
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
|
|
{
|
|
/* In tracepoint, locations are _never_ duplicated, so
|
|
should_be_inserted is equivalent to
|
|
unduplicated_should_be_inserted. */
|
|
if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || bl->inserted)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
|
|
|
|
target_download_tracepoint (bl);
|
|
|
|
bl->inserted = 1;
|
|
bp_location_downloaded = 1;
|
|
}
|
|
t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
|
|
t->number_on_target = b->number;
|
|
if (bp_location_downloaded)
|
|
gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Swap the insertion/duplication state between two locations. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
swap_insertion (struct bp_location *left, struct bp_location *right)
|
|
{
|
|
const int left_inserted = left->inserted;
|
|
const int left_duplicate = left->duplicate;
|
|
const int left_needs_update = left->needs_update;
|
|
const struct bp_target_info left_target_info = left->target_info;
|
|
|
|
/* Locations of tracepoints can never be duplicated. */
|
|
if (is_tracepoint (left->owner))
|
|
gdb_assert (!left->duplicate);
|
|
if (is_tracepoint (right->owner))
|
|
gdb_assert (!right->duplicate);
|
|
|
|
left->inserted = right->inserted;
|
|
left->duplicate = right->duplicate;
|
|
left->needs_update = right->needs_update;
|
|
left->target_info = right->target_info;
|
|
right->inserted = left_inserted;
|
|
right->duplicate = left_duplicate;
|
|
right->needs_update = left_needs_update;
|
|
right->target_info = left_target_info;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Force the re-insertion of the locations at ADDRESS. This is called
|
|
once a new/deleted/modified duplicate location is found and we are evaluating
|
|
conditions on the target's side. Such conditions need to be updated on
|
|
the target. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
force_breakpoint_reinsertion (struct bp_location *bl)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
|
|
struct bp_location *loc;
|
|
CORE_ADDR address = 0;
|
|
int pspace_num;
|
|
|
|
address = bl->address;
|
|
pspace_num = bl->pspace->num;
|
|
|
|
/* This is only meaningful if the target is
|
|
evaluating conditions and if the user has
|
|
opted for condition evaluation on the target's
|
|
side. */
|
|
if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
|
|
|| !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
/* Flag all breakpoint locations with this address and
|
|
the same program space as the location
|
|
as "its condition has changed". We need to
|
|
update the conditions on the target's side. */
|
|
ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, address)
|
|
{
|
|
loc = *loc2p;
|
|
|
|
if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
|
|
|| pspace_num != loc->pspace->num)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* Flag the location appropriately. We use a different state to
|
|
let everyone know that we already updated the set of locations
|
|
with addr bl->address and program space bl->pspace. This is so
|
|
we don't have to keep calling these functions just to mark locations
|
|
that have already been marked. */
|
|
loc->condition_changed = condition_updated;
|
|
|
|
/* Free the agent expression bytecode as well. We will compute
|
|
it later on. */
|
|
loc->cond_bytecode.reset ();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Called whether new breakpoints are created, or existing breakpoints
|
|
deleted, to update the global location list and recompute which
|
|
locations are duplicate of which.
|
|
|
|
The INSERT_MODE flag determines whether locations may not, may, or
|
|
shall be inserted now. See 'enum ugll_insert_mode' for more
|
|
info. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
|
|
/* Last breakpoint location address that was marked for update. */
|
|
CORE_ADDR last_addr = 0;
|
|
/* Last breakpoint location program space that was marked for update. */
|
|
int last_pspace_num = -1;
|
|
|
|
/* Used in the duplicates detection below. When iterating over all
|
|
bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address.
|
|
Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never
|
|
duplicates of each other. Keep one pointer for each type of
|
|
breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations
|
|
once. */
|
|
struct bp_location *bp_loc_first; /* breakpoint */
|
|
struct bp_location *wp_loc_first; /* hardware watchpoint */
|
|
struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */
|
|
struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */
|
|
|
|
/* Saved former bp_locations array which we compare against the newly
|
|
built bp_locations from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS. */
|
|
struct bp_location **old_locp;
|
|
unsigned old_locations_count;
|
|
gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<struct bp_location *> old_locations (bp_locations);
|
|
|
|
old_locations_count = bp_locations_count;
|
|
bp_locations = NULL;
|
|
bp_locations_count = 0;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
|
|
for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
|
|
bp_locations_count++;
|
|
|
|
bp_locations = XNEWVEC (struct bp_location *, bp_locations_count);
|
|
locp = bp_locations;
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
|
|
for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
|
|
*locp++ = loc;
|
|
|
|
/* See if we need to "upgrade" a software breakpoint to a hardware
|
|
breakpoint. Do this before deciding whether locations are
|
|
duplicates. Also do this before sorting because sorting order
|
|
depends on location type. */
|
|
for (locp = bp_locations;
|
|
locp < bp_locations + bp_locations_count;
|
|
locp++)
|
|
{
|
|
loc = *locp;
|
|
if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
|
|
handle_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (loc);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
std::sort (bp_locations, bp_locations + bp_locations_count,
|
|
bp_location_is_less_than);
|
|
|
|
bp_locations_target_extensions_update ();
|
|
|
|
/* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the
|
|
new list, and therefore should be freed. Note that it's not
|
|
necessary that those locations should be removed from inferior --
|
|
if there's another location at the same address (previously
|
|
marked as duplicate), we don't need to remove/insert the
|
|
location.
|
|
|
|
LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current
|
|
and former bp_location array state respectively. */
|
|
|
|
locp = bp_locations;
|
|
for (old_locp = old_locations.get ();
|
|
old_locp < old_locations.get () + old_locations_count;
|
|
old_locp++)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *old_loc = *old_locp;
|
|
struct bp_location **loc2p;
|
|
|
|
/* Tells if 'old_loc' is found among the new locations. If
|
|
not, we have to free it. */
|
|
int found_object = 0;
|
|
/* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target. */
|
|
int keep_in_target = 0;
|
|
int removed = 0;
|
|
|
|
/* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed.
|
|
Stop either at or being the one matching OLD_LOC. */
|
|
while (locp < bp_locations + bp_locations_count
|
|
&& (*locp)->address < old_loc->address)
|
|
locp++;
|
|
|
|
for (loc2p = locp;
|
|
(loc2p < bp_locations + bp_locations_count
|
|
&& (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
|
|
loc2p++)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Check if this is a new/duplicated location or a duplicated
|
|
location that had its condition modified. If so, we want to send
|
|
its condition to the target if evaluation of conditions is taking
|
|
place there. */
|
|
if ((*loc2p)->condition_changed == condition_modified
|
|
&& (last_addr != old_loc->address
|
|
|| last_pspace_num != old_loc->pspace->num))
|
|
{
|
|
force_breakpoint_reinsertion (*loc2p);
|
|
last_pspace_num = old_loc->pspace->num;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (*loc2p == old_loc)
|
|
found_object = 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* We have already handled this address, update it so that we don't
|
|
have to go through updates again. */
|
|
last_addr = old_loc->address;
|
|
|
|
/* Target-side condition evaluation: Handle deleted locations. */
|
|
if (!found_object)
|
|
force_breakpoint_reinsertion (old_loc);
|
|
|
|
/* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if
|
|
there's maybe a new location at the same address. If so,
|
|
mark that one inserted, and don't remove this one. This is
|
|
needed so that we don't have a time window where a breakpoint
|
|
at certain location is not inserted. */
|
|
|
|
if (old_loc->inserted)
|
|
{
|
|
/* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove
|
|
it. */
|
|
|
|
if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc))
|
|
{
|
|
/* The location is still present in the location list,
|
|
and still should be inserted. Don't do anything. */
|
|
keep_in_target = 1;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* This location still exists, but it won't be kept in the
|
|
target since it may have been disabled. We proceed to
|
|
remove its target-side condition. */
|
|
|
|
/* The location is either no longer present, or got
|
|
disabled. See if there's another location at the
|
|
same address, in which case we don't need to remove
|
|
this one from the target. */
|
|
|
|
/* OLD_LOC comes from existing struct breakpoint. */
|
|
if (bl_address_is_meaningful (old_loc))
|
|
{
|
|
for (loc2p = locp;
|
|
(loc2p < bp_locations + bp_locations_count
|
|
&& (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
|
|
loc2p++)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *loc2 = *loc2p;
|
|
|
|
if (loc2 == old_loc)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc))
|
|
{
|
|
/* Read watchpoint locations are switched to
|
|
access watchpoints, if the former are not
|
|
supported, but the latter are. */
|
|
if (is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
|
|
{
|
|
gdb_assert (is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner));
|
|
loc2->watchpoint_type = old_loc->watchpoint_type;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* loc2 is a duplicated location. We need to check
|
|
if it should be inserted in case it will be
|
|
unduplicated. */
|
|
if (unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc2))
|
|
{
|
|
swap_insertion (old_loc, loc2);
|
|
keep_in_target = 1;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!keep_in_target)
|
|
{
|
|
if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc))
|
|
{
|
|
/* This is just about all we can do. We could keep
|
|
this location on the global list, and try to
|
|
remove it next time, but there's no particular
|
|
reason why we will succeed next time.
|
|
|
|
Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still
|
|
valid, as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint
|
|
only after calling us. */
|
|
printf_filtered (_("warning: Error removing "
|
|
"breakpoint %d\n"),
|
|
old_loc->owner->number);
|
|
}
|
|
removed = 1;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!found_object)
|
|
{
|
|
if (removed && target_is_non_stop_p ()
|
|
&& need_moribund_for_location_type (old_loc))
|
|
{
|
|
/* This location was removed from the target. In
|
|
non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where
|
|
we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that
|
|
breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later.
|
|
We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such
|
|
SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this
|
|
breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it
|
|
after we see some number of events. The theory here
|
|
is that reporting of events should, "on the average",
|
|
be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all
|
|
threads that have anything of interest, and no longer
|
|
need to keep this breakpoint location around. We
|
|
don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of
|
|
mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint
|
|
SIGTRAP.
|
|
|
|
The heuristic failing can be disastrous on
|
|
decr_pc_after_break targets.
|
|
|
|
On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux,
|
|
if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP,
|
|
because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too
|
|
soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report
|
|
a random SIGTRAP to the user. When the user resumes
|
|
the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash
|
|
with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SIGSEGV, or worse, get silently
|
|
corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the
|
|
middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a
|
|
one-byte instruction. This was actually seen happen
|
|
on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on
|
|
targets that do not support new thread events, like
|
|
remote, due to the heuristic depending on
|
|
thread_count.
|
|
|
|
Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap
|
|
causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when
|
|
it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs
|
|
behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble.
|
|
|
|
Since hardware watchpoint traps are always
|
|
distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to
|
|
apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations
|
|
around. We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint
|
|
traps we can no longer explain. */
|
|
|
|
process_stratum_target *proc_target = nullptr;
|
|
for (inferior *inf : all_inferiors ())
|
|
if (inf->pspace == old_loc->pspace)
|
|
{
|
|
proc_target = inf->process_target ();
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
if (proc_target != nullptr)
|
|
old_loc->events_till_retirement
|
|
= 3 * (thread_count (proc_target) + 1);
|
|
else
|
|
old_loc->events_till_retirement = 1;
|
|
old_loc->owner = NULL;
|
|
|
|
moribund_locations.push_back (old_loc);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
old_loc->owner = NULL;
|
|
decref_bp_location (&old_loc);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the
|
|
first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates". This is so
|
|
that the bpt instruction is only inserted once. If we have a
|
|
permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the
|
|
official one, and the rest as duplicates. Permanent breakpoints
|
|
are sorted first for the same address.
|
|
|
|
Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the
|
|
watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length. */
|
|
|
|
bp_loc_first = NULL;
|
|
wp_loc_first = NULL;
|
|
awp_loc_first = NULL;
|
|
rwp_loc_first = NULL;
|
|
ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
|
|
{
|
|
/* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always
|
|
non-NULL. */
|
|
struct bp_location **loc_first_p;
|
|
b = loc->owner;
|
|
|
|
if (!unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc)
|
|
|| !bl_address_is_meaningful (loc)
|
|
/* Don't detect duplicate for tracepoint locations because they are
|
|
never duplicated. See the comments in field `duplicate' of
|
|
`struct bp_location'. */
|
|
|| is_tracepoint (b))
|
|
{
|
|
/* Clear the condition modification flag. */
|
|
loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
|
|
loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first;
|
|
else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
|
|
loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first;
|
|
else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
|
|
loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first;
|
|
else
|
|
loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first;
|
|
|
|
if (*loc_first_p == NULL
|
|
|| (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section)
|
|
|| !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p))
|
|
{
|
|
*loc_first_p = loc;
|
|
loc->duplicate = 0;
|
|
|
|
if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->condition_changed)
|
|
{
|
|
loc->needs_update = 1;
|
|
/* Clear the condition modification flag. */
|
|
loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
|
|
}
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* This and the above ensure the invariant that the first location
|
|
is not duplicated, and is the inserted one.
|
|
All following are marked as duplicated, and are not inserted. */
|
|
if (loc->inserted)
|
|
swap_insertion (loc, *loc_first_p);
|
|
loc->duplicate = 1;
|
|
|
|
/* Clear the condition modification flag. */
|
|
loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (insert_mode == UGLL_INSERT || breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now ())
|
|
{
|
|
if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT)
|
|
insert_breakpoint_locations ();
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* Even though the caller told us to not insert new
|
|
locations, we may still need to update conditions on the
|
|
target's side of breakpoints that were already inserted
|
|
if the target is evaluating breakpoint conditions. We
|
|
only update conditions for locations that are marked
|
|
"needs_update". */
|
|
update_inserted_breakpoint_locations ();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT)
|
|
download_tracepoint_locations ();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
breakpoint_retire_moribund (void)
|
|
{
|
|
for (int ix = 0; ix < moribund_locations.size (); ++ix)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *loc = moribund_locations[ix];
|
|
if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
decref_bp_location (&loc);
|
|
unordered_remove (moribund_locations, ix);
|
|
--ix;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
try
|
|
{
|
|
update_global_location_list (insert_mode);
|
|
}
|
|
catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
|
|
{
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Clear BKP from a BPS. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
bpstat_remove_bp_location (bpstat bps, struct breakpoint *bpt)
|
|
{
|
|
bpstat bs;
|
|
|
|
for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next)
|
|
if (bs->breakpoint_at == bpt)
|
|
{
|
|
bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
|
|
bs->old_val = NULL;
|
|
/* bs->commands will be freed later. */
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Callback for iterate_over_threads. */
|
|
static int
|
|
bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback (struct thread_info *th, void *data)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *bpt = (struct breakpoint *) data;
|
|
|
|
bpstat_remove_bp_location (th->control.stop_bpstat, bpt);
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Helper for breakpoint and tracepoint breakpoint_ops->mention
|
|
callbacks. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
say_where (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
struct value_print_options opts;
|
|
|
|
get_user_print_options (&opts);
|
|
|
|
/* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a
|
|
single string. */
|
|
if (b->loc == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
/* For pending locations, the output differs slightly based
|
|
on b->extra_string. If this is non-NULL, it contains either
|
|
a condition or dprintf arguments. */
|
|
if (b->extra_string == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
printf_filtered (_(" (%s) pending."),
|
|
event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
|
|
}
|
|
else if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
|
|
{
|
|
printf_filtered (_(" (%s,%s) pending."),
|
|
event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
|
|
b->extra_string);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
printf_filtered (_(" (%s %s) pending."),
|
|
event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
|
|
b->extra_string);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
if (opts.addressprint || b->loc->symtab == NULL)
|
|
printf_filtered (" at %ps",
|
|
styled_string (address_style.style (),
|
|
paddress (b->loc->gdbarch,
|
|
b->loc->address)));
|
|
if (b->loc->symtab != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
/* If there is a single location, we can print the location
|
|
more nicely. */
|
|
if (b->loc->next == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
const char *filename
|
|
= symtab_to_filename_for_display (b->loc->symtab);
|
|
printf_filtered (": file %ps, line %d.",
|
|
styled_string (file_name_style.style (),
|
|
filename),
|
|
b->loc->line_number);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
/* This is not ideal, but each location may have a
|
|
different file name, and this at least reflects the
|
|
real situation somewhat. */
|
|
printf_filtered (": %s.",
|
|
event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (b->loc->next)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
|
|
int n = 0;
|
|
for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
|
|
++n;
|
|
printf_filtered (" (%d locations)", n);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bp_location::~bp_location ()
|
|
{
|
|
xfree (function_name);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Destructor for the breakpoint base class. */
|
|
|
|
breakpoint::~breakpoint ()
|
|
{
|
|
xfree (this->cond_string);
|
|
xfree (this->extra_string);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static struct bp_location *
|
|
base_breakpoint_allocate_location (struct breakpoint *self)
|
|
{
|
|
return new bp_location (self);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
base_breakpoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Nothing to re-set. */
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#define internal_error_pure_virtual_called() \
|
|
gdb_assert_not_reached ("pure virtual function called")
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
base_breakpoint_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
|
|
{
|
|
internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
base_breakpoint_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl,
|
|
enum remove_bp_reason reason)
|
|
{
|
|
internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
|
|
const address_space *aspace,
|
|
CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
|
|
const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
|
|
{
|
|
internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
base_breakpoint_check_status (bpstat bs)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Always stop. */
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* A "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
|
|
errors. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode (const struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* A "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
|
|
errors. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
base_breakpoint_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
|
|
{
|
|
internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static enum print_stop_action
|
|
base_breakpoint_print_it (bpstat bs)
|
|
{
|
|
internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
base_breakpoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
|
|
struct ui_out *uiout)
|
|
{
|
|
/* nothing */
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
base_breakpoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
base_breakpoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
|
|
{
|
|
internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location
|
|
(const struct event_location *location,
|
|
struct linespec_result *canonical,
|
|
enum bptype type_wanted)
|
|
{
|
|
internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
|
|
struct linespec_result *c,
|
|
gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
|
|
gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
|
|
enum bptype type_wanted,
|
|
enum bpdisp disposition,
|
|
int thread,
|
|
int task, int ignore_count,
|
|
const struct breakpoint_ops *o,
|
|
int from_tty, int enabled,
|
|
int internal, unsigned flags)
|
|
{
|
|
internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
|
|
base_breakpoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
|
|
const struct event_location *location,
|
|
struct program_space *search_pspace)
|
|
{
|
|
internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* The default 'explains_signal' method. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
base_breakpoint_explains_signal (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
|
|
{
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* The default "after_condition_true" method. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
base_breakpoint_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Nothing to do. */
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
struct breakpoint_ops base_breakpoint_ops =
|
|
{
|
|
base_breakpoint_allocate_location,
|
|
base_breakpoint_re_set,
|
|
base_breakpoint_insert_location,
|
|
base_breakpoint_remove_location,
|
|
base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit,
|
|
base_breakpoint_check_status,
|
|
base_breakpoint_resources_needed,
|
|
base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode,
|
|
base_breakpoint_print_it,
|
|
NULL,
|
|
base_breakpoint_print_one_detail,
|
|
base_breakpoint_print_mention,
|
|
base_breakpoint_print_recreate,
|
|
base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location,
|
|
base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal,
|
|
base_breakpoint_decode_location,
|
|
base_breakpoint_explains_signal,
|
|
base_breakpoint_after_condition_true,
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* Default breakpoint_ops methods. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
/* FIXME: is this still reachable? */
|
|
if (breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (b))
|
|
{
|
|
/* Anything without a location can't be re-set. */
|
|
delete_breakpoint (b);
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
bkpt_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
|
|
{
|
|
CORE_ADDR addr = bl->target_info.reqstd_address;
|
|
|
|
bl->target_info.kind = breakpoint_kind (bl, &addr);
|
|
bl->target_info.placed_address = addr;
|
|
|
|
if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
|
|
return target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
|
|
else
|
|
return target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
bkpt_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
|
|
{
|
|
if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
|
|
return target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
|
|
else
|
|
return target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info, reason);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
bkpt_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
|
|
const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
|
|
const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
|
|
{
|
|
if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
|
|
|| ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
|
|
aspace, bp_addr))
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
|
|
&& section_is_overlay (bl->section)
|
|
&& !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
dprintf_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
|
|
const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
|
|
const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
|
|
{
|
|
if (dprintf_style == dprintf_style_agent
|
|
&& target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
|
|
{
|
|
/* An agent-style dprintf never causes a stop. If we see a trap
|
|
for this address it must be for a breakpoint that happens to
|
|
be set at the same address. */
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return bkpt_breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
bkpt_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
|
|
{
|
|
gdb_assert (bl->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static enum print_stop_action
|
|
bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
const struct bp_location *bl;
|
|
int bp_temp;
|
|
struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
|
|
|
|
gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
|
|
|
|
bl = bs->bp_location_at;
|
|
b = bs->breakpoint_at;
|
|
|
|
bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
|
|
if (bl->address != bl->requested_address)
|
|
breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address,
|
|
bl->address,
|
|
b->number, 1);
|
|
annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
|
|
maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
|
|
|
|
if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
|
|
{
|
|
uiout->field_string ("reason",
|
|
async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
|
|
uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
|
|
}
|
|
if (bp_temp)
|
|
uiout->message ("Temporary breakpoint %pF, ",
|
|
signed_field ("bkptno", b->number));
|
|
else
|
|
uiout->message ("Breakpoint %pF, ",
|
|
signed_field ("bkptno", b->number));
|
|
|
|
return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
switch (b->type)
|
|
{
|
|
case bp_breakpoint:
|
|
case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
|
|
if (b->disposition == disp_del)
|
|
printf_filtered (_("Temporary breakpoint"));
|
|
else
|
|
printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint"));
|
|
printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
|
|
if (b->type == bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver)
|
|
printf_filtered (_(" at gnu-indirect-function resolver"));
|
|
break;
|
|
case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
|
|
printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), b->number);
|
|
break;
|
|
case bp_dprintf:
|
|
printf_filtered (_("Dprintf %d"), b->number);
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
say_where (b);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
bkpt_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
|
|
{
|
|
if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint && tp->disposition == disp_del)
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "tbreak");
|
|
else if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint)
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break");
|
|
else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
|
|
&& tp->disposition == disp_del)
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "thbreak");
|
|
else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "hbreak");
|
|
else
|
|
internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
|
|
_("unhandled breakpoint type %d"), (int) tp->type);
|
|
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s",
|
|
event_location_to_string (tp->location.get ()));
|
|
|
|
/* Print out extra_string if this breakpoint is pending. It might
|
|
contain, for example, conditions that were set by the user. */
|
|
if (tp->loc == NULL && tp->extra_string != NULL)
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", tp->extra_string);
|
|
|
|
print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
bkpt_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
|
|
struct linespec_result *canonical,
|
|
enum bptype type_wanted)
|
|
{
|
|
create_sals_from_location_default (location, canonical, type_wanted);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
|
|
struct linespec_result *canonical,
|
|
gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
|
|
gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
|
|
enum bptype type_wanted,
|
|
enum bpdisp disposition,
|
|
int thread,
|
|
int task, int ignore_count,
|
|
const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
|
|
int from_tty, int enabled,
|
|
int internal, unsigned flags)
|
|
{
|
|
create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
|
|
std::move (cond_string),
|
|
std::move (extra_string),
|
|
type_wanted,
|
|
disposition, thread, task,
|
|
ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
|
|
enabled, internal, flags);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
|
|
bkpt_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
|
|
const struct event_location *location,
|
|
struct program_space *search_pspace)
|
|
{
|
|
return decode_location_default (b, location, search_pspace);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Virtual table for internal breakpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
internal_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
switch (b->type)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they
|
|
will be reset later by breakpoint_re_set. */
|
|
case bp_overlay_event:
|
|
case bp_longjmp_master:
|
|
case bp_std_terminate_master:
|
|
case bp_exception_master:
|
|
delete_breakpoint (b);
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
/* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior
|
|
starts and we really don't want to touch it. */
|
|
case bp_shlib_event:
|
|
|
|
/* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special. Once
|
|
it is set up, we do not want to touch it. */
|
|
case bp_thread_event:
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
internal_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
|
|
{
|
|
if (bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
|
|
{
|
|
/* If requested, stop when the dynamic linker notifies GDB of
|
|
events. This allows the user to get control and place
|
|
breakpoints in initializer routines for dynamically loaded
|
|
objects (among other things). */
|
|
bs->stop = stop_on_solib_events;
|
|
bs->print = stop_on_solib_events;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
bs->stop = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static enum print_stop_action
|
|
internal_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
|
|
b = bs->breakpoint_at;
|
|
|
|
switch (b->type)
|
|
{
|
|
case bp_shlib_event:
|
|
/* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events
|
|
variable? (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due
|
|
to shlib event" message.) */
|
|
print_solib_event (0);
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case bp_thread_event:
|
|
/* Not sure how we will get here.
|
|
GDB should not stop for these breakpoints. */
|
|
printf_filtered (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case bp_overlay_event:
|
|
/* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */
|
|
printf_filtered (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case bp_longjmp_master:
|
|
/* These should never be enabled. */
|
|
printf_filtered (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case bp_std_terminate_master:
|
|
/* These should never be enabled. */
|
|
printf_filtered (_("std::terminate Master Breakpoint: "
|
|
"gdb should not stop!\n"));
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case bp_exception_master:
|
|
/* These should never be enabled. */
|
|
printf_filtered (_("Exception Master Breakpoint: "
|
|
"gdb should not stop!\n"));
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return PRINT_NOTHING;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
internal_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Virtual table for momentary breakpoints */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
momentary_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step
|
|
over a dlopen call and solib_add is resetting the breakpoints.
|
|
Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain
|
|
or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable. */
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
momentary_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Nothing. The point of these breakpoints is causing a stop. */
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static enum print_stop_action
|
|
momentary_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
|
|
{
|
|
return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
momentary_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Ensure INITIATING_FRAME is cleared when no such breakpoint exists.
|
|
|
|
It gets cleared already on the removal of the first one of such placed
|
|
breakpoints. This is OK as they get all removed altogether. */
|
|
|
|
longjmp_breakpoint::~longjmp_breakpoint ()
|
|
{
|
|
thread_info *tp = find_thread_global_id (this->thread);
|
|
|
|
if (tp != NULL)
|
|
tp->initiating_frame = null_frame_id;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Specific methods for probe breakpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
bkpt_probe_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
|
|
{
|
|
int v = bkpt_insert_location (bl);
|
|
|
|
if (v == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
/* The insertion was successful, now let's set the probe's semaphore
|
|
if needed. */
|
|
bl->probe.prob->set_semaphore (bl->probe.objfile, bl->gdbarch);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return v;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
bkpt_probe_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl,
|
|
enum remove_bp_reason reason)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Let's clear the semaphore before removing the location. */
|
|
bl->probe.prob->clear_semaphore (bl->probe.objfile, bl->gdbarch);
|
|
|
|
return bkpt_remove_location (bl, reason);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
|
|
struct linespec_result *canonical,
|
|
enum bptype type_wanted)
|
|
{
|
|
struct linespec_sals lsal;
|
|
|
|
lsal.sals = parse_probes (location, NULL, canonical);
|
|
lsal.canonical
|
|
= xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location.get ()));
|
|
canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
|
|
bkpt_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
|
|
const struct event_location *location,
|
|
struct program_space *search_pspace)
|
|
{
|
|
std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = parse_probes (location, search_pspace, NULL);
|
|
if (sals.empty ())
|
|
error (_("probe not found"));
|
|
return sals;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in tracepoints. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
tracepoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
tracepoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
|
|
const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
|
|
const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
|
|
{
|
|
/* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at
|
|
tracepoints. */
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
tracepoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
|
|
struct ui_out *uiout)
|
|
{
|
|
struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
|
|
if (!tp->static_trace_marker_id.empty ())
|
|
{
|
|
gdb_assert (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint);
|
|
|
|
uiout->message ("\tmarker id is %pF\n",
|
|
string_field ("static-tracepoint-marker-string-id",
|
|
tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ()));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
tracepoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
switch (b->type)
|
|
{
|
|
case bp_tracepoint:
|
|
printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint"));
|
|
printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
|
|
break;
|
|
case bp_fast_tracepoint:
|
|
printf_filtered (_("Fast tracepoint"));
|
|
printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
|
|
break;
|
|
case bp_static_tracepoint:
|
|
printf_filtered (_("Static tracepoint"));
|
|
printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
|
|
break;
|
|
default:
|
|
internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
|
|
_("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) b->type);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
say_where (b);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
tracepoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *self, struct ui_file *fp)
|
|
{
|
|
struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
|
|
|
|
if (self->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "ftrace");
|
|
else if (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "strace");
|
|
else if (self->type == bp_tracepoint)
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "trace");
|
|
else
|
|
internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
|
|
_("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) self->type);
|
|
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s",
|
|
event_location_to_string (self->location.get ()));
|
|
print_recreate_thread (self, fp);
|
|
|
|
if (tp->pass_count)
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " passcount %d\n", tp->pass_count);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
tracepoint_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
|
|
struct linespec_result *canonical,
|
|
enum bptype type_wanted)
|
|
{
|
|
create_sals_from_location_default (location, canonical, type_wanted);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
|
|
struct linespec_result *canonical,
|
|
gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
|
|
gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
|
|
enum bptype type_wanted,
|
|
enum bpdisp disposition,
|
|
int thread,
|
|
int task, int ignore_count,
|
|
const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
|
|
int from_tty, int enabled,
|
|
int internal, unsigned flags)
|
|
{
|
|
create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
|
|
std::move (cond_string),
|
|
std::move (extra_string),
|
|
type_wanted,
|
|
disposition, thread, task,
|
|
ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
|
|
enabled, internal, flags);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
|
|
tracepoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
|
|
const struct event_location *location,
|
|
struct program_space *search_pspace)
|
|
{
|
|
return decode_location_default (b, location, search_pspace);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
|
|
/* Virtual table for tracepoints on static probes. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location
|
|
(const struct event_location *location,
|
|
struct linespec_result *canonical,
|
|
enum bptype type_wanted)
|
|
{
|
|
/* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
|
|
bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (location, canonical, type_wanted);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
|
|
tracepoint_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
|
|
const struct event_location *location,
|
|
struct program_space *search_pspace)
|
|
{
|
|
/* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
|
|
return bkpt_probe_decode_location (b, location, search_pspace);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Dprintf breakpoint_ops methods. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
dprintf_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
|
|
|
|
/* extra_string should never be non-NULL for dprintf. */
|
|
gdb_assert (b->extra_string != NULL);
|
|
|
|
/* 1 - connect to target 1, that can run breakpoint commands.
|
|
2 - create a dprintf, which resolves fine.
|
|
3 - disconnect from target 1
|
|
4 - connect to target 2, that can NOT run breakpoint commands.
|
|
|
|
After steps #3/#4, you'll want the dprintf command list to
|
|
be updated, because target 1 and 2 may well return different
|
|
answers for target_can_run_breakpoint_commands().
|
|
Given absence of finer grained resetting, we get to do
|
|
it all the time. */
|
|
if (b->extra_string != NULL)
|
|
update_dprintf_command_list (b);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for dprintf. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
dprintf_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
|
|
{
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "dprintf %s,%s",
|
|
event_location_to_string (tp->location.get ()),
|
|
tp->extra_string);
|
|
print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Implement the "after_condition_true" breakpoint_ops method for
|
|
dprintf.
|
|
|
|
dprintf's are implemented with regular commands in their command
|
|
list, but we run the commands here instead of before presenting the
|
|
stop to the user, as dprintf's don't actually cause a stop. This
|
|
also makes it so that the commands of multiple dprintfs at the same
|
|
address are all handled. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
dprintf_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bpstats tmp_bs;
|
|
struct bpstats *tmp_bs_p = &tmp_bs;
|
|
|
|
/* dprintf's never cause a stop. This wasn't set in the
|
|
check_status hook instead because that would make the dprintf's
|
|
condition not be evaluated. */
|
|
bs->stop = 0;
|
|
|
|
/* Run the command list here. Take ownership of it instead of
|
|
copying. We never want these commands to run later in
|
|
bpstat_do_actions, if a breakpoint that causes a stop happens to
|
|
be set at same address as this dprintf, or even if running the
|
|
commands here throws. */
|
|
tmp_bs.commands = bs->commands;
|
|
bs->commands = NULL;
|
|
|
|
bpstat_do_actions_1 (&tmp_bs_p);
|
|
|
|
/* 'tmp_bs.commands' will usually be NULL by now, but
|
|
bpstat_do_actions_1 may return early without processing the whole
|
|
list. */
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used on static tracepoints with
|
|
markers (`-m'). */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
strace_marker_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
|
|
struct linespec_result *canonical,
|
|
enum bptype type_wanted)
|
|
{
|
|
struct linespec_sals lsal;
|
|
const char *arg_start, *arg;
|
|
|
|
arg = arg_start = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
|
|
lsal.sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&arg);
|
|
|
|
std::string str (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
|
|
const char *ptr = str.c_str ();
|
|
canonical->location
|
|
= new_linespec_location (&ptr, symbol_name_match_type::FULL);
|
|
|
|
lsal.canonical
|
|
= xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location.get ()));
|
|
canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
|
|
struct linespec_result *canonical,
|
|
gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
|
|
gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
|
|
enum bptype type_wanted,
|
|
enum bpdisp disposition,
|
|
int thread,
|
|
int task, int ignore_count,
|
|
const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
|
|
int from_tty, int enabled,
|
|
int internal, unsigned flags)
|
|
{
|
|
const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical->lsals[0];
|
|
|
|
/* If the user is creating a static tracepoint by marker id
|
|
(strace -m MARKER_ID), then store the sals index, so that
|
|
breakpoint_re_set can try to match up which of the newly
|
|
found markers corresponds to this one, and, don't try to
|
|
expand multiple locations for each sal, given than SALS
|
|
already should contain all sals for MARKER_ID. */
|
|
|
|
for (size_t i = 0; i < lsal.sals.size (); i++)
|
|
{
|
|
event_location_up location
|
|
= copy_event_location (canonical->location.get ());
|
|
|
|
std::unique_ptr<tracepoint> tp (new tracepoint ());
|
|
init_breakpoint_sal (tp.get (), gdbarch, lsal.sals[i],
|
|
std::move (location), NULL,
|
|
std::move (cond_string),
|
|
std::move (extra_string),
|
|
type_wanted, disposition,
|
|
thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
|
|
from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
|
|
canonical->special_display);
|
|
/* Given that its possible to have multiple markers with
|
|
the same string id, if the user is creating a static
|
|
tracepoint by marker id ("strace -m MARKER_ID"), then
|
|
store the sals index, so that breakpoint_re_set can
|
|
try to match up which of the newly found markers
|
|
corresponds to this one */
|
|
tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx = i;
|
|
|
|
install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (tp), 0);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
|
|
strace_marker_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
|
|
const struct event_location *location,
|
|
struct program_space *search_pspace)
|
|
{
|
|
struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
|
|
const char *s = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
|
|
|
|
std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&s);
|
|
if (sals.size () > tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx)
|
|
{
|
|
sals[0] = sals[tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx];
|
|
sals.resize (1);
|
|
return sals;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
error (_("marker %s not found"), tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static struct breakpoint_ops strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
return b->ops == &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data
|
|
structures. */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
|
|
gdb_assert (bpt != NULL);
|
|
|
|
/* Has this bp already been deleted? This can happen because
|
|
multiple lists can hold pointers to bp's. bpstat lists are
|
|
especial culprits.
|
|
|
|
One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp. When
|
|
the scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of
|
|
scope, and delete it. We also delete its scope bp. But the
|
|
scope bp is marked "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat.
|
|
That bpstat is then checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are
|
|
deleted.
|
|
|
|
A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in
|
|
bp's, and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing
|
|
bpstat's, and teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's
|
|
storage when no more references were extent. A cheaper bandaid
|
|
was chosen. */
|
|
if (bpt->type == bp_none)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
/* At least avoid this stale reference until the reference counting
|
|
of breakpoints gets resolved. */
|
|
if (bpt->related_breakpoint != bpt)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *related;
|
|
struct watchpoint *w;
|
|
|
|
if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
|
|
w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt->related_breakpoint;
|
|
else if (bpt->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
|
|
w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
|
|
else
|
|
w = NULL;
|
|
if (w != NULL)
|
|
watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (w);
|
|
|
|
/* Unlink bpt from the bpt->related_breakpoint ring. */
|
|
for (related = bpt; related->related_breakpoint != bpt;
|
|
related = related->related_breakpoint);
|
|
related->related_breakpoint = bpt->related_breakpoint;
|
|
bpt->related_breakpoint = bpt;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* watch_command_1 creates a watchpoint but only sets its number if
|
|
update_watchpoint succeeds in creating its bp_locations. If there's
|
|
a problem in that process, we'll be asked to delete the half-created
|
|
watchpoint. In that case, don't announce the deletion. */
|
|
if (bpt->number)
|
|
gdb::observers::breakpoint_deleted.notify (bpt);
|
|
|
|
if (breakpoint_chain == bpt)
|
|
breakpoint_chain = bpt->next;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
|
|
if (b->next == bpt)
|
|
{
|
|
b->next = bpt->next;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at the breakpoint after it's
|
|
been freed. */
|
|
/* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's? We just check stop_bpstat
|
|
in all threads for now. Note that we cannot just remove bpstats
|
|
pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list entirely, as breakpoint
|
|
commands are associated with the bpstat; if we remove it here,
|
|
then the later call to bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat); in
|
|
event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints with
|
|
commands won't work. */
|
|
|
|
iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback, bpt);
|
|
|
|
/* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint list, update the
|
|
global location list. This will remove locations that used to
|
|
belong to this breakpoint. Do this before freeing the breakpoint
|
|
itself, since remove_breakpoint looks at location's owner. It
|
|
might be better design to have location completely
|
|
self-contained, but it's not the case now. */
|
|
update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
|
|
|
|
/* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this
|
|
same bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */
|
|
bpt->type = bp_none;
|
|
delete bpt;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Iterator function to call a user-provided callback function once
|
|
for each of B and its related breakpoints. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
iterate_over_related_breakpoints (struct breakpoint *b,
|
|
gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *related;
|
|
|
|
related = b;
|
|
do
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *next;
|
|
|
|
/* FUNCTION may delete RELATED. */
|
|
next = related->related_breakpoint;
|
|
|
|
if (next == related)
|
|
{
|
|
/* RELATED is the last ring entry. */
|
|
function (related);
|
|
|
|
/* FUNCTION may have deleted it, so we'd never reach back to
|
|
B. There's nothing left to do anyway, so just break
|
|
out. */
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
function (related);
|
|
|
|
related = next;
|
|
}
|
|
while (related != b);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
delete_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
|
|
|
|
dont_repeat ();
|
|
|
|
if (arg == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
int breaks_to_delete = 0;
|
|
|
|
/* Delete all breakpoints if no argument. Do not delete
|
|
internal breakpoints, these have to be deleted with an
|
|
explicit breakpoint number argument. */
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
|
|
if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
|
|
{
|
|
breaks_to_delete = 1;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
|
|
if (!from_tty
|
|
|| (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all breakpoints? "))))
|
|
{
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
|
|
if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
|
|
delete_breakpoint (b);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
map_breakpoint_numbers
|
|
(arg, [&] (breakpoint *br)
|
|
{
|
|
iterate_over_related_breakpoints (br, delete_breakpoint);
|
|
});
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Return true if all locations of B bound to PSPACE are pending. If
|
|
PSPACE is NULL, all locations of all program spaces are
|
|
considered. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
all_locations_are_pending (struct breakpoint *b, struct program_space *pspace)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *loc;
|
|
|
|
for (loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
|
|
if ((pspace == NULL
|
|
|| loc->pspace == pspace)
|
|
&& !loc->shlib_disabled
|
|
&& !loc->pspace->executing_startup)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it.
|
|
Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name.
|
|
Null names are ignored. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location *loc)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *l;
|
|
htab_t htab = htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string, streq_hash, NULL,
|
|
xcalloc, xfree);
|
|
|
|
for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->next)
|
|
{
|
|
const char **slot;
|
|
const char *name = l->function_name;
|
|
|
|
/* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them. */
|
|
if (name == NULL)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
slot = (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab, (const void *) name,
|
|
INSERT);
|
|
/* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never
|
|
returns NULL. */
|
|
if (*slot != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
htab_delete (htab);
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
*slot = name;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
htab_delete (htab);
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* When symbols change, it probably means the sources changed as well,
|
|
and it might mean the static tracepoint markers are no longer at
|
|
the same address or line numbers they used to be at last we
|
|
checked. Losing your static tracepoints whenever you rebuild is
|
|
undesirable. This function tries to resync/rematch gdb static
|
|
tracepoints with the markers on the target, for static tracepoints
|
|
that have not been set by marker id. Static tracepoint that have
|
|
been set by marker id are reset by marker id in breakpoint_re_set.
|
|
The heuristic is:
|
|
|
|
1) For a tracepoint set at a specific address, look for a marker at
|
|
the old PC. If one is found there, assume to be the same marker.
|
|
If the name / string id of the marker found is different from the
|
|
previous known name, assume that means the user renamed the marker
|
|
in the sources, and output a warning.
|
|
|
|
2) For a tracepoint set at a given line number, look for a marker
|
|
at the new address of the old line number. If one is found there,
|
|
assume to be the same marker. If the name / string id of the
|
|
marker found is different from the previous known name, assume that
|
|
means the user renamed the marker in the sources, and output a
|
|
warning.
|
|
|
|
3) If a marker is no longer found at the same address or line, it
|
|
may mean the marker no longer exists. But it may also just mean
|
|
the code changed a bit. Maybe the user added a few lines of code
|
|
that made the marker move up or down (in line number terms). Ask
|
|
the target for info about the marker with the string id as we knew
|
|
it. If found, update line number and address in the matching
|
|
static tracepoint. This will get confused if there's more than one
|
|
marker with the same ID (possible in UST, although unadvised
|
|
precisely because it confuses tools). */
|
|
|
|
static struct symtab_and_line
|
|
update_static_tracepoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct symtab_and_line sal)
|
|
{
|
|
struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
|
|
struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
|
|
CORE_ADDR pc;
|
|
|
|
pc = sal.pc;
|
|
if (sal.line)
|
|
find_line_pc (sal.symtab, sal.line, &pc);
|
|
|
|
if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (pc, &marker))
|
|
{
|
|
if (tp->static_trace_marker_id != marker.str_id)
|
|
warning (_("static tracepoint %d changed probed marker from %s to %s"),
|
|
b->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str (),
|
|
marker.str_id.c_str ());
|
|
|
|
tp->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (marker.str_id);
|
|
|
|
return sal;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Old marker wasn't found on target at lineno. Try looking it up
|
|
by string ID. */
|
|
if (!sal.explicit_pc
|
|
&& sal.line != 0
|
|
&& sal.symtab != NULL
|
|
&& !tp->static_trace_marker_id.empty ())
|
|
{
|
|
std::vector<static_tracepoint_marker> markers
|
|
= target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid
|
|
(tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
|
|
|
|
if (!markers.empty ())
|
|
{
|
|
struct symbol *sym;
|
|
struct static_tracepoint_marker *tpmarker;
|
|
struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
|
|
struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
|
|
|
|
tpmarker = &markers[0];
|
|
|
|
tp->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (tpmarker->str_id);
|
|
|
|
warning (_("marker for static tracepoint %d (%s) not "
|
|
"found at previous line number"),
|
|
b->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
|
|
|
|
symtab_and_line sal2 = find_pc_line (tpmarker->address, 0);
|
|
sym = find_pc_sect_function (tpmarker->address, NULL);
|
|
uiout->text ("Now in ");
|
|
if (sym)
|
|
{
|
|
uiout->field_string ("func", sym->print_name (),
|
|
function_name_style.style ());
|
|
uiout->text (" at ");
|
|
}
|
|
uiout->field_string ("file",
|
|
symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab),
|
|
file_name_style.style ());
|
|
uiout->text (":");
|
|
|
|
if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
|
|
{
|
|
const char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal2.symtab);
|
|
|
|
uiout->field_string ("fullname", fullname);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
uiout->field_signed ("line", sal2.line);
|
|
uiout->text ("\n");
|
|
|
|
b->loc->line_number = sal2.line;
|
|
b->loc->symtab = sym != NULL ? sal2.symtab : NULL;
|
|
|
|
b->location.reset (NULL);
|
|
initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
|
|
explicit_loc.source_filename
|
|
= ASTRDUP (symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab));
|
|
explicit_loc.line_offset.offset = b->loc->line_number;
|
|
explicit_loc.line_offset.sign = LINE_OFFSET_NONE;
|
|
b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
|
|
|
|
/* Might be nice to check if function changed, and warn if
|
|
so. */
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
return sal;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Returns 1 iff locations A and B are sufficiently same that
|
|
we don't need to report breakpoint as changed. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
locations_are_equal (struct bp_location *a, struct bp_location *b)
|
|
{
|
|
while (a && b)
|
|
{
|
|
if (a->address != b->address)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
if (a->shlib_disabled != b->shlib_disabled)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
if (a->enabled != b->enabled)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
a = a->next;
|
|
b = b->next;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ((a == NULL) != (b == NULL))
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Split all locations of B that are bound to PSPACE out of B's
|
|
location list to a separate list and return that list's head. If
|
|
PSPACE is NULL, hoist out all locations of B. */
|
|
|
|
static struct bp_location *
|
|
hoist_existing_locations (struct breakpoint *b, struct program_space *pspace)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location head;
|
|
struct bp_location *i = b->loc;
|
|
struct bp_location **i_link = &b->loc;
|
|
struct bp_location *hoisted = &head;
|
|
|
|
if (pspace == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
i = b->loc;
|
|
b->loc = NULL;
|
|
return i;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
head.next = NULL;
|
|
|
|
while (i != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
if (i->pspace == pspace)
|
|
{
|
|
*i_link = i->next;
|
|
i->next = NULL;
|
|
hoisted->next = i;
|
|
hoisted = i;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
i_link = &i->next;
|
|
i = *i_link;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return head.next;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Create new breakpoint locations for B (a hardware or software
|
|
breakpoint) based on SALS and SALS_END. If SALS_END.NELTS is not
|
|
zero, then B is a ranged breakpoint. Only recreates locations for
|
|
FILTER_PSPACE. Locations of other program spaces are left
|
|
untouched. */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
update_breakpoint_locations (struct breakpoint *b,
|
|
struct program_space *filter_pspace,
|
|
gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
|
|
gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals_end)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *existing_locations;
|
|
|
|
if (!sals_end.empty () && (sals.size () != 1 || sals_end.size () != 1))
|
|
{
|
|
/* Ranged breakpoints have only one start location and one end
|
|
location. */
|
|
b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
|
|
printf_unfiltered (_("Could not reset ranged breakpoint %d: "
|
|
"multiple locations found\n"),
|
|
b->number);
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations are
|
|
pending, don't do anything. This optimizes the common case where
|
|
all locations are in the same shared library, that was unloaded.
|
|
We'd like to retain the location, so that when the library is
|
|
loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled status of the
|
|
individual locations. */
|
|
if (all_locations_are_pending (b, filter_pspace) && sals.empty ())
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
existing_locations = hoist_existing_locations (b, filter_pspace);
|
|
|
|
for (const auto &sal : sals)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *new_loc;
|
|
|
|
switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal.pspace);
|
|
|
|
new_loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
|
|
|
|
/* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the
|
|
old symtab. */
|
|
if (b->cond_string != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
const char *s;
|
|
|
|
s = b->cond_string;
|
|
try
|
|
{
|
|
new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, sal.pc,
|
|
block_for_pc (sal.pc),
|
|
0);
|
|
}
|
|
catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
|
|
{
|
|
warning (_("failed to reevaluate condition "
|
|
"for breakpoint %d: %s"),
|
|
b->number, e.what ());
|
|
new_loc->enabled = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!sals_end.empty ())
|
|
{
|
|
CORE_ADDR end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sals_end[0]);
|
|
|
|
new_loc->length = end - sals[0].pc + 1;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing
|
|
breakpoints. */
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *e = existing_locations;
|
|
/* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name,
|
|
e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work.
|
|
Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things
|
|
may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer
|
|
often enough until a better solution is found. */
|
|
int have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->loc);
|
|
|
|
for (; e; e = e->next)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!e->enabled && e->function_name)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *l = b->loc;
|
|
if (have_ambiguous_names)
|
|
{
|
|
for (; l; l = l->next)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Ignore software vs hardware location type at
|
|
this point, because with "set breakpoint
|
|
auto-hw", after a re-set, locations that were
|
|
hardware can end up as software, or vice versa.
|
|
As mentioned above, this is an heuristic and in
|
|
practice should give the correct answer often
|
|
enough. */
|
|
if (breakpoint_locations_match (e, l, true))
|
|
{
|
|
l->enabled = 0;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
for (; l; l = l->next)
|
|
if (l->function_name
|
|
&& strcmp (e->function_name, l->function_name) == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
l->enabled = 0;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!locations_are_equal (existing_locations, b->loc))
|
|
gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Find the SaL locations corresponding to the given LOCATION.
|
|
On return, FOUND will be 1 if any SaL was found, zero otherwise. */
|
|
|
|
static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
|
|
location_to_sals (struct breakpoint *b, struct event_location *location,
|
|
struct program_space *search_pspace, int *found)
|
|
{
|
|
struct gdb_exception exception;
|
|
|
|
gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL);
|
|
|
|
std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals;
|
|
|
|
try
|
|
{
|
|
sals = b->ops->decode_location (b, location, search_pspace);
|
|
}
|
|
catch (gdb_exception_error &e)
|
|
{
|
|
int not_found_and_ok = 0;
|
|
|
|
/* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing will
|
|
fail until the right shared library is loaded. User has
|
|
already told to create pending breakpoints and don't need
|
|
extra messages. If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled
|
|
state, then user already saw the message about that
|
|
breakpoint being disabled, and don't want to see more
|
|
errors. */
|
|
if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR
|
|
&& (b->condition_not_parsed
|
|
|| (b->loc != NULL
|
|
&& search_pspace != NULL
|
|
&& b->loc->pspace != search_pspace)
|
|
|| (b->loc && b->loc->shlib_disabled)
|
|
|| (b->loc && b->loc->pspace->executing_startup)
|
|
|| b->enable_state == bp_disabled))
|
|
not_found_and_ok = 1;
|
|
|
|
if (!not_found_and_ok)
|
|
{
|
|
/* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint
|
|
10 times. One solution, implemented here, is disable
|
|
the breakpoint on error. Another solution would be to
|
|
have separate 'warning emitted' flag. Since this
|
|
happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know
|
|
which approach is better. */
|
|
b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
|
|
throw;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
exception = std::move (e);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (exception.reason == 0 || exception.error != NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
|
|
{
|
|
for (auto &sal : sals)
|
|
resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
|
|
if (b->condition_not_parsed && b->extra_string != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
char *cond_string, *extra_string;
|
|
int thread, task;
|
|
|
|
find_condition_and_thread (b->extra_string, sals[0].pc,
|
|
&cond_string, &thread, &task,
|
|
&extra_string);
|
|
gdb_assert (b->cond_string == NULL);
|
|
if (cond_string)
|
|
b->cond_string = cond_string;
|
|
b->thread = thread;
|
|
b->task = task;
|
|
if (extra_string)
|
|
{
|
|
xfree (b->extra_string);
|
|
b->extra_string = extra_string;
|
|
}
|
|
b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint && !strace_marker_p (b))
|
|
sals[0] = update_static_tracepoint (b, sals[0]);
|
|
|
|
*found = 1;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
*found = 0;
|
|
|
|
return sals;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* The default re_set method, for typical hardware or software
|
|
breakpoints. Reevaluate the breakpoint and recreate its
|
|
locations. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
struct program_space *filter_pspace = current_program_space;
|
|
std::vector<symtab_and_line> expanded, expanded_end;
|
|
|
|
int found;
|
|
std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = location_to_sals (b, b->location.get (),
|
|
filter_pspace, &found);
|
|
if (found)
|
|
expanded = std::move (sals);
|
|
|
|
if (b->location_range_end != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals_end
|
|
= location_to_sals (b, b->location_range_end.get (),
|
|
filter_pspace, &found);
|
|
if (found)
|
|
expanded_end = std::move (sals_end);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
update_breakpoint_locations (b, filter_pspace, expanded, expanded_end);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Default method for creating SALs from an address string. It basically
|
|
calls parse_breakpoint_sals. Return 1 for success, zero for failure. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
create_sals_from_location_default (const struct event_location *location,
|
|
struct linespec_result *canonical,
|
|
enum bptype type_wanted)
|
|
{
|
|
parse_breakpoint_sals (location, canonical);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Call create_breakpoints_sal for the given arguments. This is the default
|
|
function for the `create_breakpoints_sal' method of
|
|
breakpoint_ops. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
|
|
struct linespec_result *canonical,
|
|
gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
|
|
gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
|
|
enum bptype type_wanted,
|
|
enum bpdisp disposition,
|
|
int thread,
|
|
int task, int ignore_count,
|
|
const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
|
|
int from_tty, int enabled,
|
|
int internal, unsigned flags)
|
|
{
|
|
create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, canonical,
|
|
std::move (cond_string),
|
|
std::move (extra_string),
|
|
type_wanted, disposition,
|
|
thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
|
|
enabled, internal, flags);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Decode the line represented by S by calling decode_line_full. This is the
|
|
default function for the `decode_location' method of breakpoint_ops. */
|
|
|
|
static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
|
|
decode_location_default (struct breakpoint *b,
|
|
const struct event_location *location,
|
|
struct program_space *search_pspace)
|
|
{
|
|
struct linespec_result canonical;
|
|
|
|
decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, search_pspace,
|
|
NULL, 0, &canonical, multiple_symbols_all,
|
|
b->filter.get ());
|
|
|
|
/* We should get 0 or 1 resulting SALs. */
|
|
gdb_assert (canonical.lsals.size () < 2);
|
|
|
|
if (!canonical.lsals.empty ())
|
|
{
|
|
const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical.lsals[0];
|
|
return std::move (lsal.sals);
|
|
}
|
|
return {};
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Reset a breakpoint. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
breakpoint_re_set_one (breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
input_radix = b->input_radix;
|
|
set_language (b->language);
|
|
|
|
b->ops->re_set (b);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Re-set breakpoint locations for the current program space.
|
|
Locations bound to other program spaces are left untouched. */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
breakpoint_re_set (void)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
scoped_restore_current_language save_language;
|
|
scoped_restore save_input_radix = make_scoped_restore (&input_radix);
|
|
scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
|
|
|
|
/* breakpoint_re_set_one sets the current_language to the language
|
|
of the breakpoint it is resetting (see prepare_re_set_context)
|
|
before re-evaluating the breakpoint's location. This change can
|
|
unfortunately get undone by accident if the language_mode is set
|
|
to auto, and we either switch frames, or more likely in this context,
|
|
we select the current frame.
|
|
|
|
We prevent this by temporarily turning the language_mode to
|
|
language_mode_manual. We restore it once all breakpoints
|
|
have been reset. */
|
|
scoped_restore save_language_mode = make_scoped_restore (&language_mode);
|
|
language_mode = language_mode_manual;
|
|
|
|
/* Note: we must not try to insert locations until after all
|
|
breakpoints have been re-set. Otherwise, e.g., when re-setting
|
|
breakpoint 1, we'd insert the locations of breakpoint 2, which
|
|
hadn't been re-set yet, and thus may have stale locations. */
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
|
|
{
|
|
try
|
|
{
|
|
breakpoint_re_set_one (b);
|
|
}
|
|
catch (const gdb_exception &ex)
|
|
{
|
|
exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
|
|
"Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ",
|
|
b->number);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
jit_breakpoint_re_set ();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
create_overlay_event_breakpoint ();
|
|
create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ();
|
|
create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint ();
|
|
create_exception_master_breakpoint ();
|
|
|
|
/* Now we can insert. */
|
|
update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint:
|
|
|
|
- If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is.
|
|
- Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */
|
|
void
|
|
breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
if (b->thread != -1)
|
|
{
|
|
b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num;
|
|
|
|
/* We're being called after following a fork. The new fork is
|
|
selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a
|
|
different program space from the original thread. Reset that
|
|
as well. */
|
|
b->loc->pspace = current_program_space;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
|
|
If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
|
|
which ends with a period (no newline). */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
|
|
if (count < 0)
|
|
count = 0;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
|
|
if (b->number == bptnum)
|
|
{
|
|
if (is_tracepoint (b))
|
|
{
|
|
if (from_tty && count != 0)
|
|
printf_filtered (_("Ignore count ignored for tracepoint %d."),
|
|
bptnum);
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
b->ignore_count = count;
|
|
if (from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
if (count == 0)
|
|
printf_filtered (_("Will stop next time "
|
|
"breakpoint %d is reached."),
|
|
bptnum);
|
|
else if (count == 1)
|
|
printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."),
|
|
bptnum);
|
|
else
|
|
printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next %d "
|
|
"crossings of breakpoint %d."),
|
|
count, bptnum);
|
|
}
|
|
gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
ignore_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
const char *p = args;
|
|
int num;
|
|
|
|
if (p == 0)
|
|
error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number"));
|
|
|
|
num = get_number (&p);
|
|
if (num == 0)
|
|
error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args);
|
|
if (*p == 0)
|
|
error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing."));
|
|
|
|
set_ignore_count (num,
|
|
longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))),
|
|
from_tty);
|
|
if (from_tty)
|
|
printf_filtered ("\n");
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints with numbers in the range
|
|
defined by BP_NUM_RANGE (an inclusive range). */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
map_breakpoint_number_range (std::pair<int, int> bp_num_range,
|
|
gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
|
|
{
|
|
if (bp_num_range.first == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%d'"),
|
|
bp_num_range.first);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b, *tmp;
|
|
|
|
for (int i = bp_num_range.first; i <= bp_num_range.second; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
bool match = false;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, tmp)
|
|
if (b->number == i)
|
|
{
|
|
match = true;
|
|
function (b);
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
if (!match)
|
|
printf_unfiltered (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), i);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints whose numbers are given in
|
|
ARGS. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *args,
|
|
gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
|
|
{
|
|
if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
|
|
error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers"));
|
|
|
|
number_or_range_parser parser (args);
|
|
|
|
while (!parser.finished ())
|
|
{
|
|
int num = parser.get_number ();
|
|
map_breakpoint_number_range (std::make_pair (num, num), function);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Return the breakpoint location structure corresponding to the
|
|
BP_NUM and LOC_NUM values. */
|
|
|
|
static struct bp_location *
|
|
find_location_by_number (int bp_num, int loc_num)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
|
|
if (b->number == bp_num)
|
|
{
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!b || b->number != bp_num)
|
|
error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%d'"), bp_num);
|
|
|
|
if (loc_num == 0)
|
|
error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%d'"), loc_num);
|
|
|
|
int n = 0;
|
|
for (bp_location *loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
|
|
if (++n == loc_num)
|
|
return loc;
|
|
|
|
error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%d'"), loc_num);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Modes of operation for extract_bp_num. */
|
|
enum class extract_bp_kind
|
|
{
|
|
/* Extracting a breakpoint number. */
|
|
bp,
|
|
|
|
/* Extracting a location number. */
|
|
loc,
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* Extract a breakpoint or location number (as determined by KIND)
|
|
from the string starting at START. TRAILER is a character which
|
|
can be found after the number. If you don't want a trailer, use
|
|
'\0'. If END_OUT is not NULL, it is set to point after the parsed
|
|
string. This always returns a positive integer. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
extract_bp_num (extract_bp_kind kind, const char *start,
|
|
int trailer, const char **end_out = NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
const char *end = start;
|
|
int num = get_number_trailer (&end, trailer);
|
|
if (num < 0)
|
|
error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
|
|
? _("Negative breakpoint number '%.*s'")
|
|
: _("Negative breakpoint location number '%.*s'"),
|
|
int (end - start), start);
|
|
if (num == 0)
|
|
error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
|
|
? _("Bad breakpoint number '%.*s'")
|
|
: _("Bad breakpoint location number '%.*s'"),
|
|
int (end - start), start);
|
|
|
|
if (end_out != NULL)
|
|
*end_out = end;
|
|
return num;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Extract a breakpoint or location range (as determined by KIND) in
|
|
the form NUM1-NUM2 stored at &ARG[arg_offset]. Returns a std::pair
|
|
representing the (inclusive) range. The returned pair's elements
|
|
are always positive integers. */
|
|
|
|
static std::pair<int, int>
|
|
extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind kind,
|
|
const std::string &arg,
|
|
std::string::size_type arg_offset)
|
|
{
|
|
std::pair<int, int> range;
|
|
const char *bp_loc = &arg[arg_offset];
|
|
std::string::size_type dash = arg.find ('-', arg_offset);
|
|
if (dash != std::string::npos)
|
|
{
|
|
/* bp_loc is a range (x-z). */
|
|
if (arg.length () == dash + 1)
|
|
error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
|
|
? _("Bad breakpoint number at or near: '%s'")
|
|
: _("Bad breakpoint location number at or near: '%s'"),
|
|
bp_loc);
|
|
|
|
const char *end;
|
|
const char *start_first = bp_loc;
|
|
const char *start_second = &arg[dash + 1];
|
|
range.first = extract_bp_num (kind, start_first, '-');
|
|
range.second = extract_bp_num (kind, start_second, '\0', &end);
|
|
|
|
if (range.first > range.second)
|
|
error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
|
|
? _("Inverted breakpoint range at '%.*s'")
|
|
: _("Inverted breakpoint location range at '%.*s'"),
|
|
int (end - start_first), start_first);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* bp_loc is a single value. */
|
|
range.first = extract_bp_num (kind, bp_loc, '\0');
|
|
range.second = range.first;
|
|
}
|
|
return range;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Extract the breakpoint/location range specified by ARG. Returns
|
|
the breakpoint range in BP_NUM_RANGE, and the location range in
|
|
BP_LOC_RANGE.
|
|
|
|
ARG may be in any of the following forms:
|
|
|
|
x where 'x' is a breakpoint number.
|
|
x-y where 'x' and 'y' specify a breakpoint numbers range.
|
|
x.y where 'x' is a breakpoint number and 'y' a location number.
|
|
x.y-z where 'x' is a breakpoint number and 'y' and 'z' specify a
|
|
location number range.
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
extract_bp_number_and_location (const std::string &arg,
|
|
std::pair<int, int> &bp_num_range,
|
|
std::pair<int, int> &bp_loc_range)
|
|
{
|
|
std::string::size_type dot = arg.find ('.');
|
|
|
|
if (dot != std::string::npos)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Handle 'x.y' and 'x.y-z' cases. */
|
|
|
|
if (arg.length () == dot + 1 || dot == 0)
|
|
error (_("Bad breakpoint number at or near: '%s'"), arg.c_str ());
|
|
|
|
bp_num_range.first
|
|
= extract_bp_num (extract_bp_kind::bp, arg.c_str (), '.');
|
|
bp_num_range.second = bp_num_range.first;
|
|
|
|
bp_loc_range = extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind::loc,
|
|
arg, dot + 1);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* Handle x and x-y cases. */
|
|
|
|
bp_num_range = extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind::bp, arg, 0);
|
|
bp_loc_range.first = 0;
|
|
bp_loc_range.second = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Enable or disable a breakpoint location BP_NUM.LOC_NUM. ENABLE
|
|
specifies whether to enable or disable. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
enable_disable_bp_num_loc (int bp_num, int loc_num, bool enable)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (bp_num, loc_num);
|
|
if (loc != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
if (loc->enabled != enable)
|
|
{
|
|
loc->enabled = enable;
|
|
mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
|
|
}
|
|
if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
|
|
&& current_trace_status ()->running && loc->owner
|
|
&& is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
|
|
target_disable_tracepoint (loc);
|
|
}
|
|
update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
|
|
|
|
gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (loc->owner);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Enable or disable a range of breakpoint locations. BP_NUM is the
|
|
number of the breakpoint, and BP_LOC_RANGE specifies the
|
|
(inclusive) range of location numbers of that breakpoint to
|
|
enable/disable. ENABLE specifies whether to enable or disable the
|
|
location. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
enable_disable_breakpoint_location_range (int bp_num,
|
|
std::pair<int, int> &bp_loc_range,
|
|
bool enable)
|
|
{
|
|
for (int i = bp_loc_range.first; i <= bp_loc_range.second; i++)
|
|
enable_disable_bp_num_loc (bp_num, i, enable);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
|
|
If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
|
|
which ends with a period (no newline). */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to
|
|
hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the
|
|
watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time. */
|
|
if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled;
|
|
|
|
/* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
|
|
mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
|
|
|
|
if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
|
|
&& current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *location;
|
|
|
|
for (location = bpt->loc; location; location = location->next)
|
|
target_disable_tracepoint (location);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
|
|
|
|
gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (bpt);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Enable or disable the breakpoint(s) or breakpoint location(s)
|
|
specified in ARGS. ARGS may be in any of the formats handled by
|
|
extract_bp_number_and_location. ENABLE specifies whether to enable
|
|
or disable the breakpoints/locations. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
enable_disable_command (const char *args, int from_tty, bool enable)
|
|
{
|
|
if (args == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *bpt;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
|
|
if (user_breakpoint_p (bpt))
|
|
{
|
|
if (enable)
|
|
enable_breakpoint (bpt);
|
|
else
|
|
disable_breakpoint (bpt);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
std::string num = extract_arg (&args);
|
|
|
|
while (!num.empty ())
|
|
{
|
|
std::pair<int, int> bp_num_range, bp_loc_range;
|
|
|
|
extract_bp_number_and_location (num, bp_num_range, bp_loc_range);
|
|
|
|
if (bp_loc_range.first == bp_loc_range.second
|
|
&& bp_loc_range.first == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Handle breakpoint ids with formats 'x' or 'x-z'. */
|
|
map_breakpoint_number_range (bp_num_range,
|
|
enable
|
|
? enable_breakpoint
|
|
: disable_breakpoint);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* Handle breakpoint ids with formats 'x.y' or
|
|
'x.y-z'. */
|
|
enable_disable_breakpoint_location_range
|
|
(bp_num_range.first, bp_loc_range, enable);
|
|
}
|
|
num = extract_arg (&args);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* The disable command disables the specified breakpoints/locations
|
|
(or all defined breakpoints) so they're no longer effective in
|
|
stopping the inferior. ARGS may be in any of the forms defined in
|
|
extract_bp_number_and_location. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
disable_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
enable_disable_command (args, from_tty, false);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition,
|
|
int count)
|
|
{
|
|
int target_resources_ok;
|
|
|
|
if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
|
|
{
|
|
int i;
|
|
i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
|
|
target_resources_ok =
|
|
target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
|
|
i + 1, 0);
|
|
if (target_resources_ok == 0)
|
|
error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
|
|
else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
|
|
error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (is_watchpoint (bpt))
|
|
{
|
|
/* Initialize it just to avoid a GCC false warning. */
|
|
enum enable_state orig_enable_state = bp_disabled;
|
|
|
|
try
|
|
{
|
|
struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
|
|
|
|
orig_enable_state = bpt->enable_state;
|
|
bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
|
|
update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
|
|
}
|
|
catch (const gdb_exception &e)
|
|
{
|
|
bpt->enable_state = orig_enable_state;
|
|
exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "),
|
|
bpt->number);
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
|
|
|
|
/* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
|
|
mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
|
|
|
|
if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
|
|
&& current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *location;
|
|
|
|
for (location = bpt->loc; location; location = location->next)
|
|
target_enable_tracepoint (location);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bpt->disposition = disposition;
|
|
bpt->enable_count = count;
|
|
update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
|
|
|
|
gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (bpt);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
|
|
{
|
|
enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, bpt->disposition, 0);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints/locations (or
|
|
all defined breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to
|
|
be) effective in stopping the inferior. ARGS may be in any of the
|
|
forms defined in extract_bp_number_and_location. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
enable_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
enable_disable_command (args, from_tty, true);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
enable_once_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
map_breakpoint_numbers
|
|
(args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
iterate_over_related_breakpoints
|
|
(b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
|
|
{
|
|
enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_disable, 1);
|
|
});
|
|
});
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
enable_count_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
int count;
|
|
|
|
if (args == NULL)
|
|
error_no_arg (_("hit count"));
|
|
|
|
count = get_number (&args);
|
|
|
|
map_breakpoint_numbers
|
|
(args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
iterate_over_related_breakpoints
|
|
(b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
|
|
{
|
|
enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_disable, count);
|
|
});
|
|
});
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
enable_delete_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
map_breakpoint_numbers
|
|
(args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
iterate_over_related_breakpoints
|
|
(b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
|
|
{
|
|
enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_del, 1);
|
|
});
|
|
});
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if
|
|
the memory which that value represents has been written to by
|
|
GDB itself. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (struct inferior *inferior,
|
|
CORE_ADDR addr, ssize_t len,
|
|
const bfd_byte *data)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *bp;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
|
|
if (bp->enable_state == bp_enabled
|
|
&& bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
|
|
{
|
|
struct watchpoint *wp = (struct watchpoint *) bp;
|
|
|
|
if (wp->val_valid && wp->val != nullptr)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *loc;
|
|
|
|
for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
|
|
if (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
|
|
&& loc->address + loc->length > addr
|
|
&& addr + len > loc->address)
|
|
{
|
|
wp->val = NULL;
|
|
wp->val_valid = false;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step. */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
|
|
const address_space *aspace,
|
|
CORE_ADDR next_pc)
|
|
{
|
|
struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
|
|
struct symtab_and_line sal;
|
|
CORE_ADDR pc = next_pc;
|
|
|
|
if (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
tp->control.single_step_breakpoints
|
|
= new_single_step_breakpoint (tp->global_num, gdbarch);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
|
|
sal.pc = pc;
|
|
sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
|
|
sal.explicit_pc = 1;
|
|
add_location_to_breakpoint (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints, &sal);
|
|
|
|
update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Insert single step breakpoints according to the current state. */
|
|
|
|
int
|
|
insert_single_step_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
|
|
{
|
|
struct regcache *regcache = get_current_regcache ();
|
|
std::vector<CORE_ADDR> next_pcs;
|
|
|
|
next_pcs = gdbarch_software_single_step (gdbarch, regcache);
|
|
|
|
if (!next_pcs.empty ())
|
|
{
|
|
struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
|
|
const address_space *aspace = get_frame_address_space (frame);
|
|
|
|
for (CORE_ADDR pc : next_pcs)
|
|
insert_single_step_breakpoint (gdbarch, aspace, pc);
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* See breakpoint.h. */
|
|
|
|
int
|
|
breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (struct breakpoint *bp,
|
|
const address_space *aspace,
|
|
CORE_ADDR pc)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *loc;
|
|
|
|
for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
|
|
if (loc->inserted
|
|
&& breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
|
|
return 1;
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at
|
|
PC. */
|
|
|
|
int
|
|
single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
|
|
CORE_ADDR pc)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *bpt;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
|
|
{
|
|
if (bpt->type == bp_single_step
|
|
&& breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (bpt, aspace, pc))
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Tracepoint-specific operations. */
|
|
|
|
/* Set tracepoint count to NUM. */
|
|
static void
|
|
set_tracepoint_count (int num)
|
|
{
|
|
tracepoint_count = num;
|
|
set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
trace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
|
|
current_language);
|
|
const struct breakpoint_ops *ops = breakpoint_ops_for_event_location
|
|
(location.get (), true /* is_tracepoint */);
|
|
|
|
create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
|
|
location.get (),
|
|
NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
|
|
0 /* tempflag */,
|
|
bp_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
|
|
0 /* Ignore count */,
|
|
pending_break_support,
|
|
ops,
|
|
from_tty,
|
|
1 /* enabled */,
|
|
0 /* internal */, 0);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
ftrace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
|
|
current_language);
|
|
create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
|
|
location.get (),
|
|
NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
|
|
0 /* tempflag */,
|
|
bp_fast_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
|
|
0 /* Ignore count */,
|
|
pending_break_support,
|
|
&tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
|
|
from_tty,
|
|
1 /* enabled */,
|
|
0 /* internal */, 0);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* strace command implementation. Creates a static tracepoint. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
strace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
|
|
event_location_up location;
|
|
|
|
/* Decide if we are dealing with a static tracepoint marker (`-m'),
|
|
or with a normal static tracepoint. */
|
|
if (arg && startswith (arg, "-m") && isspace (arg[2]))
|
|
{
|
|
ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
location = new_linespec_location (&arg, symbol_name_match_type::FULL);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
|
|
location.get (),
|
|
NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
|
|
0 /* tempflag */,
|
|
bp_static_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
|
|
0 /* Ignore count */,
|
|
pending_break_support,
|
|
ops,
|
|
from_tty,
|
|
1 /* enabled */,
|
|
0 /* internal */, 0);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Set up a fake reader function that gets command lines from a linked
|
|
list that was acquired during tracepoint uploading. */
|
|
|
|
static struct uploaded_tp *this_utp;
|
|
static int next_cmd;
|
|
|
|
static char *
|
|
read_uploaded_action (void)
|
|
{
|
|
char *rslt = nullptr;
|
|
|
|
if (next_cmd < this_utp->cmd_strings.size ())
|
|
{
|
|
rslt = this_utp->cmd_strings[next_cmd].get ();
|
|
next_cmd++;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return rslt;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Given information about a tracepoint as recorded on a target (which
|
|
can be either a live system or a trace file), attempt to create an
|
|
equivalent GDB tracepoint. This is not a reliable process, since
|
|
the target does not necessarily have all the information used when
|
|
the tracepoint was originally defined. */
|
|
|
|
struct tracepoint *
|
|
create_tracepoint_from_upload (struct uploaded_tp *utp)
|
|
{
|
|
const char *addr_str;
|
|
char small_buf[100];
|
|
struct tracepoint *tp;
|
|
|
|
if (utp->at_string)
|
|
addr_str = utp->at_string.get ();
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* In the absence of a source location, fall back to raw
|
|
address. Since there is no way to confirm that the address
|
|
means the same thing as when the trace was started, warn the
|
|
user. */
|
|
warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d has no "
|
|
"source location, using raw address"),
|
|
utp->number);
|
|
xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "*%s", hex_string (utp->addr));
|
|
addr_str = small_buf;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* There's not much we can do with a sequence of bytecodes. */
|
|
if (utp->cond && !utp->cond_string)
|
|
warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d condition "
|
|
"has no source form, ignoring it"),
|
|
utp->number);
|
|
|
|
event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&addr_str,
|
|
current_language);
|
|
if (!create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
|
|
location.get (),
|
|
utp->cond_string.get (), -1, addr_str,
|
|
0 /* parse cond/thread */,
|
|
0 /* tempflag */,
|
|
utp->type /* type_wanted */,
|
|
0 /* Ignore count */,
|
|
pending_break_support,
|
|
&tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
|
|
0 /* from_tty */,
|
|
utp->enabled /* enabled */,
|
|
0 /* internal */,
|
|
CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED))
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
|
|
/* Get the tracepoint we just created. */
|
|
tp = get_tracepoint (tracepoint_count);
|
|
gdb_assert (tp != NULL);
|
|
|
|
if (utp->pass > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "%d %d", utp->pass,
|
|
tp->number);
|
|
|
|
trace_pass_command (small_buf, 0);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If we have uploaded versions of the original commands, set up a
|
|
special-purpose "reader" function and call the usual command line
|
|
reader, then pass the result to the breakpoint command-setting
|
|
function. */
|
|
if (!utp->cmd_strings.empty ())
|
|
{
|
|
counted_command_line cmd_list;
|
|
|
|
this_utp = utp;
|
|
next_cmd = 0;
|
|
|
|
cmd_list = read_command_lines_1 (read_uploaded_action, 1, NULL);
|
|
|
|
breakpoint_set_commands (tp, std::move (cmd_list));
|
|
}
|
|
else if (!utp->actions.empty ()
|
|
|| !utp->step_actions.empty ())
|
|
warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d actions "
|
|
"have no source form, ignoring them"),
|
|
utp->number);
|
|
|
|
/* Copy any status information that might be available. */
|
|
tp->hit_count = utp->hit_count;
|
|
tp->traceframe_usage = utp->traceframe_usage;
|
|
|
|
return tp;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if
|
|
omitted. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
info_tracepoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
|
|
int num_printed;
|
|
|
|
num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, false, is_tracepoint);
|
|
|
|
if (num_printed == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
|
|
uiout->message ("No tracepoints.\n");
|
|
else
|
|
uiout->message ("No tracepoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
default_collect_info ();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints.
|
|
Not supported by all targets. */
|
|
static void
|
|
enable_trace_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
enable_command (args, from_tty);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints.
|
|
Not supported by all targets. */
|
|
static void
|
|
disable_trace_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
disable_command (args, from_tty);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument). */
|
|
static void
|
|
delete_trace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
|
|
|
|
dont_repeat ();
|
|
|
|
if (arg == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
int breaks_to_delete = 0;
|
|
|
|
/* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
|
|
Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
|
|
have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number
|
|
argument. */
|
|
ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
|
|
if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
|
|
{
|
|
breaks_to_delete = 1;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
|
|
if (!from_tty
|
|
|| (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? "))))
|
|
{
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
|
|
if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
|
|
delete_breakpoint (b);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
map_breakpoint_numbers
|
|
(arg, [&] (breakpoint *br)
|
|
{
|
|
iterate_over_related_breakpoints (br, delete_breakpoint);
|
|
});
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Helper function for trace_pass_command. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
trace_pass_set_count (struct tracepoint *tp, int count, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
tp->pass_count = count;
|
|
gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (tp);
|
|
if (from_tty)
|
|
printf_filtered (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"),
|
|
tp->number, count);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Set passcount for tracepoint.
|
|
|
|
First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number.
|
|
If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined.
|
|
Also accepts special argument "all". */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
trace_pass_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
struct tracepoint *t1;
|
|
ULONGEST count;
|
|
|
|
if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
|
|
error (_("passcount command requires an "
|
|
"argument (count + optional TP num)"));
|
|
|
|
count = strtoulst (args, &args, 10); /* Count comes first, then TP num. */
|
|
|
|
args = skip_spaces (args);
|
|
if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
|
|
args += 3; /* Skip special argument "all". */
|
|
if (*args)
|
|
error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
|
|
|
|
ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
|
|
{
|
|
t1 = (struct tracepoint *) b;
|
|
trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else if (*args == '\0')
|
|
{
|
|
t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, NULL);
|
|
if (t1)
|
|
trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
number_or_range_parser parser (args);
|
|
while (!parser.finished ())
|
|
{
|
|
t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, &parser);
|
|
if (t1)
|
|
trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
struct tracepoint *
|
|
get_tracepoint (int num)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *t;
|
|
|
|
ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
|
|
if (t->number == num)
|
|
return (struct tracepoint *) t;
|
|
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Find the tracepoint with the given target-side number (which may be
|
|
different from the tracepoint number after disconnecting and
|
|
reconnecting). */
|
|
|
|
struct tracepoint *
|
|
get_tracepoint_by_number_on_target (int num)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
|
|
ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
|
|
{
|
|
struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
|
|
|
|
if (t->number_on_target == num)
|
|
return t;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list.
|
|
If STATE is not NULL, use, get_number_or_range_state and ignore ARG.
|
|
If the argument is missing, the most recent tracepoint
|
|
(tracepoint_count) is returned. */
|
|
|
|
struct tracepoint *
|
|
get_tracepoint_by_number (const char **arg,
|
|
number_or_range_parser *parser)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *t;
|
|
int tpnum;
|
|
const char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg;
|
|
|
|
if (parser != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
gdb_assert (!parser->finished ());
|
|
tpnum = parser->get_number ();
|
|
}
|
|
else if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg)
|
|
tpnum = tracepoint_count;
|
|
else
|
|
tpnum = get_number (arg);
|
|
|
|
if (tpnum <= 0)
|
|
{
|
|
if (instring && *instring)
|
|
printf_filtered (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"),
|
|
instring);
|
|
else
|
|
printf_filtered (_("No previous tracepoint\n"));
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
|
|
if (t->number == tpnum)
|
|
{
|
|
return (struct tracepoint *) t;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
printf_unfiltered ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum);
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
print_recreate_thread (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
|
|
{
|
|
if (b->thread != -1)
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " thread %d", b->thread);
|
|
|
|
if (b->task != 0)
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " task %d", b->task);
|
|
|
|
fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Save information on user settable breakpoints (watchpoints, etc) to
|
|
a new script file named FILENAME. If FILTER is non-NULL, call it
|
|
on each breakpoint and only include the ones for which it returns
|
|
true. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
save_breakpoints (const char *filename, int from_tty,
|
|
bool (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *tp;
|
|
int any = 0;
|
|
int extra_trace_bits = 0;
|
|
|
|
if (filename == 0 || *filename == 0)
|
|
error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save)"));
|
|
|
|
/* See if we have anything to save. */
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
|
|
if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
|
|
if (filter && !filter (tp))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
any = 1;
|
|
|
|
if (is_tracepoint (tp))
|
|
{
|
|
extra_trace_bits = 1;
|
|
|
|
/* We can stop searching. */
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!any)
|
|
{
|
|
warning (_("Nothing to save."));
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> expanded_filename (tilde_expand (filename));
|
|
|
|
stdio_file fp;
|
|
|
|
if (!fp.open (expanded_filename.get (), "w"))
|
|
error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving (%s)"),
|
|
expanded_filename.get (), safe_strerror (errno));
|
|
|
|
if (extra_trace_bits)
|
|
save_trace_state_variables (&fp);
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
|
|
if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
|
|
if (filter && !filter (tp))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
tp->ops->print_recreate (tp, &fp);
|
|
|
|
/* Note, we can't rely on tp->number for anything, as we can't
|
|
assume the recreated breakpoint numbers will match. Use $bpnum
|
|
instead. */
|
|
|
|
if (tp->cond_string)
|
|
fp.printf (" condition $bpnum %s\n", tp->cond_string);
|
|
|
|
if (tp->ignore_count)
|
|
fp.printf (" ignore $bpnum %d\n", tp->ignore_count);
|
|
|
|
if (tp->type != bp_dprintf && tp->commands)
|
|
{
|
|
fp.puts (" commands\n");
|
|
|
|
current_uiout->redirect (&fp);
|
|
try
|
|
{
|
|
print_command_lines (current_uiout, tp->commands.get (), 2);
|
|
}
|
|
catch (const gdb_exception &ex)
|
|
{
|
|
current_uiout->redirect (NULL);
|
|
throw;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
current_uiout->redirect (NULL);
|
|
fp.puts (" end\n");
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (tp->enable_state == bp_disabled)
|
|
fp.puts ("disable $bpnum\n");
|
|
|
|
/* If this is a multi-location breakpoint, check if the locations
|
|
should be individually disabled. Watchpoint locations are
|
|
special, and not user visible. */
|
|
if (!is_watchpoint (tp) && tp->loc && tp->loc->next)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location *loc;
|
|
int n = 1;
|
|
|
|
for (loc = tp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next, n++)
|
|
if (!loc->enabled)
|
|
fp.printf ("disable $bpnum.%d\n", n);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (extra_trace_bits && *default_collect)
|
|
fp.printf ("set default-collect %s\n", default_collect);
|
|
|
|
if (from_tty)
|
|
printf_filtered (_("Saved to file '%s'.\n"), expanded_filename.get ());
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* The `save breakpoints' command. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
save_breakpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, NULL);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* The `save tracepoints' command. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
save_tracepoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
|
|
{
|
|
save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, is_tracepoint);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Create a vector of all tracepoints. */
|
|
|
|
std::vector<breakpoint *>
|
|
all_tracepoints (void)
|
|
{
|
|
std::vector<breakpoint *> tp_vec;
|
|
struct breakpoint *tp;
|
|
|
|
ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
|
|
{
|
|
tp_vec.push_back (tp);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return tp_vec;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* This help string is used to consolidate all the help string for specifying
|
|
locations used by several commands. */
|
|
|
|
#define LOCATION_HELP_STRING \
|
|
"Linespecs are colon-separated lists of location parameters, such as\n\
|
|
source filename, function name, label name, and line number.\n\
|
|
Example: To specify the start of a label named \"the_top\" in the\n\
|
|
function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use\n\
|
|
\"factorial.c:fact:the_top\".\n\
|
|
\n\
|
|
Address locations begin with \"*\" and specify an exact address in the\n\
|
|
program. Example: To specify the fourth byte past the start function\n\
|
|
\"main\", use \"*main + 4\".\n\
|
|
\n\
|
|
Explicit locations are similar to linespecs but use an option/argument\n\
|
|
syntax to specify location parameters.\n\
|
|
Example: To specify the start of the label named \"the_top\" in the\n\
|
|
function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use \"-source factorial.c\n\
|
|
-function fact -label the_top\".\n\
|
|
\n\
|
|
By default, a specified function is matched against the program's\n\
|
|
functions in all scopes. For C++, this means in all namespaces and\n\
|
|
classes. For Ada, this means in all packages. E.g., in C++,\n\
|
|
\"func()\" matches \"A::func()\", \"A::B::func()\", etc. The\n\
|
|
\"-qualified\" flag overrides this behavior, making GDB interpret the\n\
|
|
specified name as a complete fully-qualified name instead."
|
|
|
|
/* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak
|
|
commands. It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication.
|
|
COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the
|
|
command. */
|
|
|
|
#define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \
|
|
command" [PROBE_MODIFIER] [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM] [if CONDITION]\n\
|
|
PROBE_MODIFIER shall be present if the command is to be placed in a\n\
|
|
probe point. Accepted values are `-probe' (for a generic, automatically\n\
|
|
guessed probe type), `-probe-stap' (for a SystemTap probe) or \n\
|
|
`-probe-dtrace' (for a DTrace probe).\n\
|
|
LOCATION may be a linespec, address, or explicit location as described\n\
|
|
below.\n\
|
|
\n\
|
|
With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected\n\
|
|
stack frame. This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\
|
|
\n\
|
|
THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\
|
|
CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
|
|
\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\n\
|
|
Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
|
|
conditions are different.\n\
|
|
\n\
|
|
Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints."
|
|
|
|
/* List of subcommands for "catch". */
|
|
static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist;
|
|
|
|
/* List of subcommands for "tcatch". */
|
|
static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist;
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
add_catch_command (const char *name, const char *docstring,
|
|
cmd_const_sfunc_ftype *sfunc,
|
|
completer_ftype *completer,
|
|
void *user_data_catch,
|
|
void *user_data_tcatch)
|
|
{
|
|
struct cmd_list_element *command;
|
|
|
|
command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, docstring,
|
|
&catch_cmdlist);
|
|
set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
|
|
set_cmd_context (command, user_data_catch);
|
|
set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
|
|
|
|
command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, docstring,
|
|
&tcatch_cmdlist);
|
|
set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
|
|
set_cmd_context (command, user_data_tcatch);
|
|
set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
struct breakpoint *
|
|
iterate_over_breakpoints (gdb::function_view<bool (breakpoint *)> callback)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
|
|
{
|
|
if (callback (b))
|
|
return b;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Zero if any of the breakpoint's locations could be a location where
|
|
functions have been inlined, nonzero otherwise. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
is_non_inline_function (struct breakpoint *b)
|
|
{
|
|
/* The shared library event breakpoint is set on the address of a
|
|
non-inline function. */
|
|
if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
|
|
return 1;
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Nonzero if the specified PC cannot be a location where functions
|
|
have been inlined. */
|
|
|
|
int
|
|
pc_at_non_inline_function (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
|
|
const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
|
|
{
|
|
struct breakpoint *b;
|
|
struct bp_location *bl;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!is_non_inline_function (b))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!bl->shlib_disabled
|
|
&& bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, pc, ws))
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Remove any references to OBJFILE which is going to be freed. */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
breakpoint_free_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
|
|
|
|
ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
|
|
if (loc->symtab != NULL && SYMTAB_OBJFILE (loc->symtab) == objfile)
|
|
loc->symtab = NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
initialize_breakpoint_ops (void)
|
|
{
|
|
static int initialized = 0;
|
|
|
|
struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
|
|
|
|
if (initialized)
|
|
return;
|
|
initialized = 1;
|
|
|
|
/* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherit by all kinds of
|
|
breakpoints (real breakpoints, i.e., user "break" breakpoints,
|
|
internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
|
|
ops = &bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
*ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
|
|
ops->insert_location = bkpt_insert_location;
|
|
ops->remove_location = bkpt_remove_location;
|
|
ops->breakpoint_hit = bkpt_breakpoint_hit;
|
|
ops->create_sals_from_location = bkpt_create_sals_from_location;
|
|
ops->create_breakpoints_sal = bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal;
|
|
ops->decode_location = bkpt_decode_location;
|
|
|
|
/* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular breakpoints. */
|
|
ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
*ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
|
|
ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
|
|
ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
|
|
ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
|
|
ops->print_recreate = bkpt_print_recreate;
|
|
|
|
/* Ranged breakpoints. */
|
|
ops = &ranged_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
*ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint;
|
|
ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint;
|
|
ops->print_it = print_it_ranged_breakpoint;
|
|
ops->print_one = print_one_ranged_breakpoint;
|
|
ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint;
|
|
ops->print_mention = print_mention_ranged_breakpoint;
|
|
ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint;
|
|
|
|
/* Internal breakpoints. */
|
|
ops = &internal_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
*ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
ops->re_set = internal_bkpt_re_set;
|
|
ops->check_status = internal_bkpt_check_status;
|
|
ops->print_it = internal_bkpt_print_it;
|
|
ops->print_mention = internal_bkpt_print_mention;
|
|
|
|
/* Momentary breakpoints. */
|
|
ops = &momentary_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
*ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
ops->re_set = momentary_bkpt_re_set;
|
|
ops->check_status = momentary_bkpt_check_status;
|
|
ops->print_it = momentary_bkpt_print_it;
|
|
ops->print_mention = momentary_bkpt_print_mention;
|
|
|
|
/* Probe breakpoints. */
|
|
ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
*ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
ops->insert_location = bkpt_probe_insert_location;
|
|
ops->remove_location = bkpt_probe_remove_location;
|
|
ops->create_sals_from_location = bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location;
|
|
ops->decode_location = bkpt_probe_decode_location;
|
|
|
|
/* Watchpoints. */
|
|
ops = &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
*ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
ops->re_set = re_set_watchpoint;
|
|
ops->insert_location = insert_watchpoint;
|
|
ops->remove_location = remove_watchpoint;
|
|
ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_watchpoint;
|
|
ops->check_status = check_status_watchpoint;
|
|
ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_watchpoint;
|
|
ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_watchpoint;
|
|
ops->print_it = print_it_watchpoint;
|
|
ops->print_mention = print_mention_watchpoint;
|
|
ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_watchpoint;
|
|
ops->explains_signal = explains_signal_watchpoint;
|
|
|
|
/* Masked watchpoints. */
|
|
ops = &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
*ops = watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
ops->insert_location = insert_masked_watchpoint;
|
|
ops->remove_location = remove_masked_watchpoint;
|
|
ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_masked_watchpoint;
|
|
ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint;
|
|
ops->print_it = print_it_masked_watchpoint;
|
|
ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint;
|
|
ops->print_mention = print_mention_masked_watchpoint;
|
|
ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_masked_watchpoint;
|
|
|
|
/* Tracepoints. */
|
|
ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
*ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
ops->re_set = tracepoint_re_set;
|
|
ops->breakpoint_hit = tracepoint_breakpoint_hit;
|
|
ops->print_one_detail = tracepoint_print_one_detail;
|
|
ops->print_mention = tracepoint_print_mention;
|
|
ops->print_recreate = tracepoint_print_recreate;
|
|
ops->create_sals_from_location = tracepoint_create_sals_from_location;
|
|
ops->create_breakpoints_sal = tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal;
|
|
ops->decode_location = tracepoint_decode_location;
|
|
|
|
/* Probe tracepoints. */
|
|
ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
*ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
ops->create_sals_from_location = tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location;
|
|
ops->decode_location = tracepoint_probe_decode_location;
|
|
|
|
/* Static tracepoints with marker (`-m'). */
|
|
ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
*ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
ops->create_sals_from_location = strace_marker_create_sals_from_location;
|
|
ops->create_breakpoints_sal = strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal;
|
|
ops->decode_location = strace_marker_decode_location;
|
|
|
|
/* Fork catchpoints. */
|
|
ops = &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
*ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
ops->insert_location = insert_catch_fork;
|
|
ops->remove_location = remove_catch_fork;
|
|
ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_fork;
|
|
ops->print_it = print_it_catch_fork;
|
|
ops->print_one = print_one_catch_fork;
|
|
ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_fork;
|
|
ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_fork;
|
|
|
|
/* Vfork catchpoints. */
|
|
ops = &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
*ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
ops->insert_location = insert_catch_vfork;
|
|
ops->remove_location = remove_catch_vfork;
|
|
ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork;
|
|
ops->print_it = print_it_catch_vfork;
|
|
ops->print_one = print_one_catch_vfork;
|
|
ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_vfork;
|
|
ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_vfork;
|
|
|
|
/* Exec catchpoints. */
|
|
ops = &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
*ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
ops->insert_location = insert_catch_exec;
|
|
ops->remove_location = remove_catch_exec;
|
|
ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_exec;
|
|
ops->print_it = print_it_catch_exec;
|
|
ops->print_one = print_one_catch_exec;
|
|
ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_exec;
|
|
ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_exec;
|
|
|
|
/* Solib-related catchpoints. */
|
|
ops = &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
*ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
ops->insert_location = insert_catch_solib;
|
|
ops->remove_location = remove_catch_solib;
|
|
ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_solib;
|
|
ops->check_status = check_status_catch_solib;
|
|
ops->print_it = print_it_catch_solib;
|
|
ops->print_one = print_one_catch_solib;
|
|
ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_solib;
|
|
ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_solib;
|
|
|
|
ops = &dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
*ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
|
|
ops->re_set = dprintf_re_set;
|
|
ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
|
|
ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
|
|
ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
|
|
ops->print_recreate = dprintf_print_recreate;
|
|
ops->after_condition_true = dprintf_after_condition_true;
|
|
ops->breakpoint_hit = dprintf_breakpoint_hit;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Chain containing all defined "enable breakpoint" subcommands. */
|
|
|
|
static struct cmd_list_element *enablebreaklist = NULL;
|
|
|
|
/* See breakpoint.h. */
|
|
|
|
cmd_list_element *commands_cmd_element = nullptr;
|
|
|
|
void _initialize_breakpoint ();
|
|
void
|
|
_initialize_breakpoint ()
|
|
{
|
|
struct cmd_list_element *c;
|
|
|
|
initialize_breakpoint_ops ();
|
|
|
|
gdb::observers::solib_unloaded.attach (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib);
|
|
gdb::observers::free_objfile.attach (disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile);
|
|
gdb::observers::memory_changed.attach (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change);
|
|
|
|
breakpoint_chain = 0;
|
|
/* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count. $bpnum isn't useful
|
|
before a breakpoint is set. */
|
|
breakpoint_count = 0;
|
|
|
|
tracepoint_count = 0;
|
|
|
|
add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\
|
|
Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\
|
|
Usage is `ignore N COUNT'."));
|
|
|
|
commands_cmd_element = add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint,
|
|
commands_command, _("\
|
|
Set commands to be executed when the given breakpoints are hit.\n\
|
|
Give a space-separated breakpoint list as argument after \"commands\".\n\
|
|
A list element can be a breakpoint number (e.g. `5') or a range of numbers\n\
|
|
(e.g. `5-7').\n\
|
|
With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\
|
|
The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\
|
|
Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\
|
|
Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\
|
|
then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print."));
|
|
|
|
c = add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command, _("\
|
|
Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\
|
|
Usage is `condition N COND', where N is an integer and COND is an\n\
|
|
expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached."));
|
|
set_cmd_completer (c, condition_completer);
|
|
|
|
c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\
|
|
Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\
|
|
Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
|
|
so it will be deleted when hit. Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\
|
|
by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\
|
|
\n"
|
|
BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak")));
|
|
set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
|
|
|
|
c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\
|
|
Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
|
|
Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\
|
|
some target hardware may not have this support.\n\
|
|
\n"
|
|
BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak")));
|
|
set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
|
|
|
|
c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\
|
|
Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
|
|
Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
|
|
so it will be deleted when hit.\n\
|
|
\n"
|
|
BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak")));
|
|
set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
|
|
|
|
add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
|
|
Enable all or some breakpoints.\n\
|
|
Usage: enable [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
|
|
Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
|
|
With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
|
|
This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
|
|
With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."),
|
|
&enablelist, "enable ", 1, &cmdlist);
|
|
|
|
add_com_alias ("en", "enable", class_breakpoint, 1);
|
|
|
|
add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
|
|
Enable all or some breakpoints.\n\
|
|
Usage: enable breakpoints [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
|
|
Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
|
|
This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
|
|
May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\"."),
|
|
&enablebreaklist, "enable breakpoints ", 1, &enablelist);
|
|
|
|
add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
|
|
Enable some breakpoints for one hit.\n\
|
|
Usage: enable breakpoints once BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
|
|
If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
|
|
&enablebreaklist);
|
|
|
|
add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
|
|
Enable some breakpoints and delete when hit.\n\
|
|
Usage: enable breakpoints delete BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
|
|
If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
|
|
&enablebreaklist);
|
|
|
|
add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
|
|
Enable some breakpoints for COUNT hits.\n\
|
|
Usage: enable breakpoints count COUNT BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
|
|
If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
|
|
the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
|
|
&enablebreaklist);
|
|
|
|
add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
|
|
Enable some breakpoints and delete when hit.\n\
|
|
Usage: enable delete BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
|
|
If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
|
|
&enablelist);
|
|
|
|
add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
|
|
Enable some breakpoints for one hit.\n\
|
|
Usage: enable once BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
|
|
If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
|
|
&enablelist);
|
|
|
|
add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
|
|
Enable some breakpoints for COUNT hits.\n\
|
|
Usage: enable count COUNT BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
|
|
If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
|
|
the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
|
|
&enablelist);
|
|
|
|
add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
|
|
Disable all or some breakpoints.\n\
|
|
Usage: disable [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
|
|
Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
|
|
To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
|
|
A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled."),
|
|
&disablelist, "disable ", 1, &cmdlist);
|
|
add_com_alias ("dis", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
|
|
add_com_alias ("disa", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
|
|
|
|
add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
|
|
Disable all or some breakpoints.\n\
|
|
Usage: disable breakpoints [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
|
|
Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
|
|
To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
|
|
A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled.\n\
|
|
This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."),
|
|
&disablelist);
|
|
|
|
add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
|
|
Delete all or some breakpoints.\n\
|
|
Usage: delete [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
|
|
Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
|
|
To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
|
|
\n\
|
|
Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects."),
|
|
&deletelist, "delete ", 1, &cmdlist);
|
|
add_com_alias ("d", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
|
|
add_com_alias ("del", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
|
|
|
|
add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
|
|
Delete all or some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
|
|
Usage: delete breakpoints [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
|
|
Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
|
|
To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
|
|
This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."),
|
|
&deletelist);
|
|
|
|
add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\
|
|
Clear breakpoint at specified location.\n\
|
|
Argument may be a linespec, explicit, or address location as described below.\n\
|
|
\n\
|
|
With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\
|
|
is executing in.\n"
|
|
"\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\n\
|
|
See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number."));
|
|
add_com_alias ("cl", "clear", class_breakpoint, 1);
|
|
|
|
c = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\
|
|
Set breakpoint at specified location.\n"
|
|
BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break")));
|
|
set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
|
|
|
|
add_com_alias ("b", "break", class_run, 1);
|
|
add_com_alias ("br", "break", class_run, 1);
|
|
add_com_alias ("bre", "break", class_run, 1);
|
|
add_com_alias ("brea", "break", class_run, 1);
|
|
|
|
if (dbx_commands)
|
|
{
|
|
add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("stop", class_breakpoint, stop_command, _("\
|
|
Break in function/address or break at a line in the current file."),
|
|
&stoplist, "stop ", 1, &cmdlist);
|
|
add_cmd ("in", class_breakpoint, stopin_command,
|
|
_("Break in function or address."), &stoplist);
|
|
add_cmd ("at", class_breakpoint, stopat_command,
|
|
_("Break at a line in the current file."), &stoplist);
|
|
add_com ("status", class_info, info_breakpoints_command, _("\
|
|
Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
|
|
The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
|
|
\tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
|
|
\twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
|
|
The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
|
|
the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
|
|
breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
|
|
address and file/line number respectively.\n\
|
|
\n\
|
|
Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
|
|
are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
|
|
is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
|
|
Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
|
|
breakpoint set."));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
add_info ("breakpoints", info_breakpoints_command, _("\
|
|
Status of specified breakpoints (all user-settable breakpoints if no argument).\n\
|
|
The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
|
|
\tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
|
|
\twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
|
|
The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
|
|
the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
|
|
breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
|
|
address and file/line number respectively.\n\
|
|
\n\
|
|
Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
|
|
are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
|
|
is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
|
|
Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
|
|
breakpoint set."));
|
|
|
|
add_info_alias ("b", "breakpoints", 1);
|
|
|
|
add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\
|
|
Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
|
|
The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
|
|
\tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
|
|
\twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
|
|
\tlongjmp - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\
|
|
\tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\
|
|
\tuntil - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\
|
|
\tfinish - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\
|
|
The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
|
|
the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
|
|
breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
|
|
address and file/line number respectively.\n\
|
|
\n\
|
|
Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
|
|
are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
|
|
is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
|
|
Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
|
|
breakpoint set."),
|
|
&maintenanceinfolist);
|
|
|
|
add_basic_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, _("\
|
|
Set catchpoints to catch events."),
|
|
&catch_cmdlist, "catch ",
|
|
0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
|
|
|
|
add_basic_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, _("\
|
|
Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."),
|
|
&tcatch_cmdlist, "tcatch ",
|
|
0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
|
|
|
|
add_catch_command ("fork", _("Catch calls to fork."),
|
|
catch_fork_command_1,
|
|
NULL,
|
|
(void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_permanent,
|
|
(void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_temporary);
|
|
add_catch_command ("vfork", _("Catch calls to vfork."),
|
|
catch_fork_command_1,
|
|
NULL,
|
|
(void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_permanent,
|
|
(void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_temporary);
|
|
add_catch_command ("exec", _("Catch calls to exec."),
|
|
catch_exec_command_1,
|
|
NULL,
|
|
CATCH_PERMANENT,
|
|
CATCH_TEMPORARY);
|
|
add_catch_command ("load", _("Catch loads of shared libraries.\n\
|
|
Usage: catch load [REGEX]\n\
|
|
If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
|
|
catch_load_command_1,
|
|
NULL,
|
|
CATCH_PERMANENT,
|
|
CATCH_TEMPORARY);
|
|
add_catch_command ("unload", _("Catch unloads of shared libraries.\n\
|
|
Usage: catch unload [REGEX]\n\
|
|
If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
|
|
catch_unload_command_1,
|
|
NULL,
|
|
CATCH_PERMANENT,
|
|
CATCH_TEMPORARY);
|
|
|
|
c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command, _("\
|
|
Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
|
|
Usage: watch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
|
|
A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
|
|
an expression changes.\n\
|
|
If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
|
|
the memory to which it refers."));
|
|
set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
|
|
|
|
c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command, _("\
|
|
Set a read watchpoint for an expression.\n\
|
|
Usage: rwatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
|
|
A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
|
|
an expression is read.\n\
|
|
If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
|
|
the memory to which it refers."));
|
|
set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
|
|
|
|
c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command, _("\
|
|
Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
|
|
Usage: awatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
|
|
A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
|
|
an expression is either read or written.\n\
|
|
If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
|
|
the memory to which it refers."));
|
|
set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
|
|
|
|
add_info ("watchpoints", info_watchpoints_command, _("\
|
|
Status of specified watchpoints (all watchpoints if no argument)."));
|
|
|
|
/* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should
|
|
respond to changes - contrary to the description. */
|
|
add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support,
|
|
&can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\
|
|
Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
|
|
Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
|
|
If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\
|
|
such is available. (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\
|
|
created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\
|
|
hardware.)"),
|
|
NULL,
|
|
show_can_use_hw_watchpoints,
|
|
&setlist, &showlist);
|
|
|
|
can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1;
|
|
|
|
/* Tracepoint manipulation commands. */
|
|
|
|
c = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\
|
|
Set a tracepoint at specified location.\n\
|
|
\n"
|
|
BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\
|
|
Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
|
|
set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
|
|
|
|
add_com_alias ("tp", "trace", class_breakpoint, 0);
|
|
add_com_alias ("tr", "trace", class_breakpoint, 1);
|
|
add_com_alias ("tra", "trace", class_breakpoint, 1);
|
|
add_com_alias ("trac", "trace", class_breakpoint, 1);
|
|
|
|
c = add_com ("ftrace", class_breakpoint, ftrace_command, _("\
|
|
Set a fast tracepoint at specified location.\n\
|
|
\n"
|
|
BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("ftrace") "\n\
|
|
Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
|
|
set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
|
|
|
|
c = add_com ("strace", class_breakpoint, strace_command, _("\
|
|
Set a static tracepoint at location or marker.\n\
|
|
\n\
|
|
strace [LOCATION] [if CONDITION]\n\
|
|
LOCATION may be a linespec, explicit, or address location (described below) \n\
|
|
or -m MARKER_ID.\n\n\
|
|
If a marker id is specified, probe the marker with that name. With\n\
|
|
no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected stack frame.\n\
|
|
Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action -- ``collect $_sdata''.\n\
|
|
This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point call to the\n\
|
|
tracing library. You can inspect it when analyzing the trace buffer,\n\
|
|
by printing the $_sdata variable like any other convenience variable.\n\
|
|
\n\
|
|
CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
|
|
\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\n\
|
|
Multiple tracepoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
|
|
conditions are different.\n\
|
|
\n\
|
|
Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints.\n\
|
|
Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
|
|
set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
|
|
|
|
add_info ("tracepoints", info_tracepoints_command, _("\
|
|
Status of specified tracepoints (all tracepoints if no argument).\n\
|
|
Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\
|
|
last tracepoint set."));
|
|
|
|
add_info_alias ("tp", "tracepoints", 1);
|
|
|
|
add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\
|
|
Delete specified tracepoints.\n\
|
|
Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
|
|
No argument means delete all tracepoints."),
|
|
&deletelist);
|
|
add_alias_cmd ("tr", "tracepoints", class_trace, 1, &deletelist);
|
|
|
|
c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\
|
|
Disable specified tracepoints.\n\
|
|
Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
|
|
No argument means disable all tracepoints."),
|
|
&disablelist);
|
|
deprecate_cmd (c, "disable");
|
|
|
|
c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\
|
|
Enable specified tracepoints.\n\
|
|
Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
|
|
No argument means enable all tracepoints."),
|
|
&enablelist);
|
|
deprecate_cmd (c, "enable");
|
|
|
|
add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\
|
|
Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\
|
|
The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\
|
|
Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\
|
|
if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined."));
|
|
|
|
add_basic_prefix_cmd ("save", class_breakpoint,
|
|
_("Save breakpoint definitions as a script."),
|
|
&save_cmdlist, "save ",
|
|
0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
|
|
|
|
c = add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, save_breakpoints_command, _("\
|
|
Save current breakpoint definitions as a script.\n\
|
|
This includes all types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints,\n\
|
|
catchpoints, tracepoints). Use the 'source' command in another debug\n\
|
|
session to restore them."),
|
|
&save_cmdlist);
|
|
set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
|
|
|
|
c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, save_tracepoints_command, _("\
|
|
Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\
|
|
Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."),
|
|
&save_cmdlist);
|
|
set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
|
|
|
|
c = add_com_alias ("save-tracepoints", "save tracepoints", class_trace, 0);
|
|
deprecate_cmd (c, "save tracepoints");
|
|
|
|
add_basic_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, _("\
|
|
Breakpoint specific settings.\n\
|
|
Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
|
|
pending breakpoint behavior."),
|
|
&breakpoint_set_cmdlist, "set breakpoint ",
|
|
0/*allow-unknown*/, &setlist);
|
|
add_show_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, _("\
|
|
Breakpoint specific settings.\n\
|
|
Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
|
|
pending breakpoint behavior."),
|
|
&breakpoint_show_cmdlist, "show breakpoint ",
|
|
0/*allow-unknown*/, &showlist);
|
|
|
|
add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class,
|
|
&pending_break_support, _("\
|
|
Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
|
|
Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
|
|
If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\
|
|
pending breakpoint. If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\
|
|
an error. If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\
|
|
user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."),
|
|
NULL,
|
|
show_pending_break_support,
|
|
&breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
|
|
&breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
|
|
|
|
pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO;
|
|
|
|
add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class,
|
|
&automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\
|
|
Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
|
|
Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
|
|
If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\
|
|
breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory. If not set,\n\
|
|
a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."),
|
|
NULL,
|
|
show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints,
|
|
&breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
|
|
&breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
|
|
|
|
add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support,
|
|
&always_inserted_mode, _("\
|
|
Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
|
|
Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
|
|
When this mode is on, breakpoints are inserted immediately as soon as\n\
|
|
they're created, kept inserted even when execution stops, and removed\n\
|
|
only when the user deletes them. When this mode is off (the default),\n\
|
|
breakpoints are inserted only when execution continues, and removed\n\
|
|
when execution stops."),
|
|
NULL,
|
|
&show_always_inserted_mode,
|
|
&breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
|
|
&breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
|
|
|
|
add_setshow_enum_cmd ("condition-evaluation", class_breakpoint,
|
|
condition_evaluation_enums,
|
|
&condition_evaluation_mode_1, _("\
|
|
Set mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
|
|
Show mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
|
|
When this is set to \"host\", breakpoint conditions will be\n\
|
|
evaluated on the host's side by GDB. When it is set to \"target\",\n\
|
|
breakpoint conditions will be downloaded to the target (if the target\n\
|
|
supports such feature) and conditions will be evaluated on the target's side.\n\
|
|
If this is set to \"auto\" (default), this will be automatically set to\n\
|
|
\"target\" if it supports condition evaluation, otherwise it will\n\
|
|
be set to \"gdb\""),
|
|
&set_condition_evaluation_mode,
|
|
&show_condition_evaluation_mode,
|
|
&breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
|
|
&breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
|
|
|
|
add_com ("break-range", class_breakpoint, break_range_command, _("\
|
|
Set a breakpoint for an address range.\n\
|
|
break-range START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION\n\
|
|
where START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION can be one of the following:\n\
|
|
LINENUM, for that line in the current file,\n\
|
|
FILE:LINENUM, for that line in that file,\n\
|
|
+OFFSET, for that number of lines after the current line\n\
|
|
or the start of the range\n\
|
|
FUNCTION, for the first line in that function,\n\
|
|
FILE:FUNCTION, to distinguish among like-named static functions.\n\
|
|
*ADDRESS, for the instruction at that address.\n\
|
|
\n\
|
|
The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it executes\n\
|
|
an instruction at any address within the [START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION]\n\
|
|
range (including START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION)."));
|
|
|
|
c = add_com ("dprintf", class_breakpoint, dprintf_command, _("\
|
|
Set a dynamic printf at specified location.\n\
|
|
dprintf location,format string,arg1,arg2,...\n\
|
|
location may be a linespec, explicit, or address location.\n"
|
|
"\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING));
|
|
set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
|
|
|
|
add_setshow_enum_cmd ("dprintf-style", class_support,
|
|
dprintf_style_enums, &dprintf_style, _("\
|
|
Set the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
|
|
Show the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
|
|
This setting chooses how GDB will do a dynamic printf.\n\
|
|
If the value is \"gdb\", then the printing is done by GDB to its own\n\
|
|
console, as with the \"printf\" command.\n\
|
|
If the value is \"call\", the print is done by calling a function in your\n\
|
|
program; by default printf(), but you can choose a different function or\n\
|
|
output stream by setting dprintf-function and dprintf-channel."),
|
|
update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
|
|
&setlist, &showlist);
|
|
|
|
dprintf_function = xstrdup ("printf");
|
|
add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-function", class_support,
|
|
&dprintf_function, _("\
|
|
Set the function to use for dynamic printf."), _("\
|
|
Show the function to use for dynamic printf."), NULL,
|
|
update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
|
|
&setlist, &showlist);
|
|
|
|
dprintf_channel = xstrdup ("");
|
|
add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-channel", class_support,
|
|
&dprintf_channel, _("\
|
|
Set the channel to use for dynamic printf."), _("\
|
|
Show the channel to use for dynamic printf."), NULL,
|
|
update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
|
|
&setlist, &showlist);
|
|
|
|
add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("disconnected-dprintf", no_class,
|
|
&disconnected_dprintf, _("\
|
|
Set whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
|
|
Show whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
|
|
Use this to let dprintf commands continue to hit and produce output\n\
|
|
even if GDB disconnects or detaches from the target."),
|
|
NULL,
|
|
NULL,
|
|
&setlist, &showlist);
|
|
|
|
add_com ("agent-printf", class_vars, agent_printf_command, _("\
|
|
Target agent only formatted printing, like the C \"printf\" function.\n\
|
|
Usage: agent-printf \"format string\", ARG1, ARG2, ARG3, ..., ARGN\n\
|
|
This supports most C printf format specifications, like %s, %d, etc.\n\
|
|
This is useful for formatted output in user-defined commands."));
|
|
|
|
automatic_hardware_breakpoints = true;
|
|
|
|
gdb::observers::about_to_proceed.attach (breakpoint_about_to_proceed);
|
|
gdb::observers::thread_exit.attach (remove_threaded_breakpoints);
|
|
}
|